// Code generated by private/model/cli/gen-api/main.go. DO NOT EDIT. package redshift import ( "fmt" "time" "github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws" "github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awsutil" "github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/request" "github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/private/protocol" "github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/private/protocol/query" ) const opAcceptReservedNodeExchange = "AcceptReservedNodeExchange" // AcceptReservedNodeExchangeRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the AcceptReservedNodeExchange operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See AcceptReservedNodeExchange for more information on using the AcceptReservedNodeExchange // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the AcceptReservedNodeExchangeRequest method. // req, resp := client.AcceptReservedNodeExchangeRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/AcceptReservedNodeExchange func (c *Redshift) AcceptReservedNodeExchangeRequest(input *AcceptReservedNodeExchangeInput) (req *request.Request, output *AcceptReservedNodeExchangeOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opAcceptReservedNodeExchange, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &AcceptReservedNodeExchangeInput{} } output = &AcceptReservedNodeExchangeOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // AcceptReservedNodeExchange API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Exchanges a DC1 Reserved Node for a DC2 Reserved Node with no changes to // the configuration (term, payment type, or number of nodes) and no additional // costs. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation AcceptReservedNodeExchange for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeReservedNodeNotFoundFault "ReservedNodeNotFound" // The specified reserved compute node not found. // // * ErrCodeInvalidReservedNodeStateFault "InvalidReservedNodeState" // Indicates that the Reserved Node being exchanged is not in an active state. // // * ErrCodeReservedNodeAlreadyMigratedFault "ReservedNodeAlreadyMigrated" // Indicates that the reserved node has already been exchanged. // // * ErrCodeReservedNodeOfferingNotFoundFault "ReservedNodeOfferingNotFound" // Specified offering does not exist. // // * ErrCodeUnsupportedOperationFault "UnsupportedOperation" // The requested operation isn't supported. // // * ErrCodeDependentServiceUnavailableFault "DependentServiceUnavailableFault" // Your request cannot be completed because a dependent internal service is // temporarily unavailable. Wait 30 to 60 seconds and try again. // // * ErrCodeReservedNodeAlreadyExistsFault "ReservedNodeAlreadyExists" // User already has a reservation with the given identifier. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/AcceptReservedNodeExchange func (c *Redshift) AcceptReservedNodeExchange(input *AcceptReservedNodeExchangeInput) (*AcceptReservedNodeExchangeOutput, error) { req, out := c.AcceptReservedNodeExchangeRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // AcceptReservedNodeExchangeWithContext is the same as AcceptReservedNodeExchange with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See AcceptReservedNodeExchange for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) AcceptReservedNodeExchangeWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *AcceptReservedNodeExchangeInput, opts ...request.Option) (*AcceptReservedNodeExchangeOutput, error) { req, out := c.AcceptReservedNodeExchangeRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opAuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngress = "AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngress" // AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngressRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngress operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngress for more information on using the AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngress // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngressRequest method. // req, resp := client.AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngressRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngress func (c *Redshift) AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngressRequest(input *AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngressInput) (req *request.Request, output *AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngressOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opAuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngress, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngressInput{} } output = &AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngressOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngress API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Adds an inbound (ingress) rule to an Amazon Redshift security group. Depending // on whether the application accessing your cluster is running on the Internet // or an Amazon EC2 instance, you can authorize inbound access to either a Classless // Interdomain Routing (CIDR)/Internet Protocol (IP) range or to an Amazon EC2 // security group. You can add as many as 20 ingress rules to an Amazon Redshift // security group. // // If you authorize access to an Amazon EC2 security group, specify EC2SecurityGroupName // and EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId. The Amazon EC2 security group and Amazon Redshift // cluster must be in the same AWS Region. // // If you authorize access to a CIDR/IP address range, specify CIDRIP. For an // overview of CIDR blocks, see the Wikipedia article on Classless Inter-Domain // Routing (http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Classless_Inter-Domain_Routing). // // You must also associate the security group with a cluster so that clients // running on these IP addresses or the EC2 instance are authorized to connect // to the cluster. For information about managing security groups, go to Working // with Security Groups (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-security-groups.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngress for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeClusterSecurityGroupNotFoundFault "ClusterSecurityGroupNotFound" // The cluster security group name does not refer to an existing cluster security // group. // // * ErrCodeInvalidClusterSecurityGroupStateFault "InvalidClusterSecurityGroupState" // The state of the cluster security group is not available. // // * ErrCodeAuthorizationAlreadyExistsFault "AuthorizationAlreadyExists" // The specified CIDR block or EC2 security group is already authorized for // the specified cluster security group. // // * ErrCodeAuthorizationQuotaExceededFault "AuthorizationQuotaExceeded" // The authorization quota for the cluster security group has been reached. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngress func (c *Redshift) AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngress(input *AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngressInput) (*AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngressOutput, error) { req, out := c.AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngressRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngressWithContext is the same as AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngress with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngress for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngressWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngressInput, opts ...request.Option) (*AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngressOutput, error) { req, out := c.AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngressRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opAuthorizeSnapshotAccess = "AuthorizeSnapshotAccess" // AuthorizeSnapshotAccessRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the AuthorizeSnapshotAccess operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See AuthorizeSnapshotAccess for more information on using the AuthorizeSnapshotAccess // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the AuthorizeSnapshotAccessRequest method. // req, resp := client.AuthorizeSnapshotAccessRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/AuthorizeSnapshotAccess func (c *Redshift) AuthorizeSnapshotAccessRequest(input *AuthorizeSnapshotAccessInput) (req *request.Request, output *AuthorizeSnapshotAccessOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opAuthorizeSnapshotAccess, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &AuthorizeSnapshotAccessInput{} } output = &AuthorizeSnapshotAccessOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // AuthorizeSnapshotAccess API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Authorizes the specified AWS customer account to restore the specified snapshot. // // For more information about working with snapshots, go to Amazon Redshift // Snapshots (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-snapshots.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation AuthorizeSnapshotAccess for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault "ClusterSnapshotNotFound" // The snapshot identifier does not refer to an existing cluster snapshot. // // * ErrCodeAuthorizationAlreadyExistsFault "AuthorizationAlreadyExists" // The specified CIDR block or EC2 security group is already authorized for // the specified cluster security group. // // * ErrCodeAuthorizationQuotaExceededFault "AuthorizationQuotaExceeded" // The authorization quota for the cluster security group has been reached. // // * ErrCodeDependentServiceRequestThrottlingFault "DependentServiceRequestThrottlingFault" // The request cannot be completed because a dependent service is throttling // requests made by Amazon Redshift on your behalf. Wait and retry the request. // // * ErrCodeInvalidClusterSnapshotStateFault "InvalidClusterSnapshotState" // The specified cluster snapshot is not in the available state, or other accounts // are authorized to access the snapshot. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededFault "LimitExceededFault" // The encryption key has exceeded its grant limit in AWS KMS. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/AuthorizeSnapshotAccess func (c *Redshift) AuthorizeSnapshotAccess(input *AuthorizeSnapshotAccessInput) (*AuthorizeSnapshotAccessOutput, error) { req, out := c.AuthorizeSnapshotAccessRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // AuthorizeSnapshotAccessWithContext is the same as AuthorizeSnapshotAccess with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See AuthorizeSnapshotAccess for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) AuthorizeSnapshotAccessWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *AuthorizeSnapshotAccessInput, opts ...request.Option) (*AuthorizeSnapshotAccessOutput, error) { req, out := c.AuthorizeSnapshotAccessRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opBatchDeleteClusterSnapshots = "BatchDeleteClusterSnapshots" // BatchDeleteClusterSnapshotsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the BatchDeleteClusterSnapshots operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See BatchDeleteClusterSnapshots for more information on using the BatchDeleteClusterSnapshots // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the BatchDeleteClusterSnapshotsRequest method. // req, resp := client.BatchDeleteClusterSnapshotsRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/BatchDeleteClusterSnapshots func (c *Redshift) BatchDeleteClusterSnapshotsRequest(input *BatchDeleteClusterSnapshotsInput) (req *request.Request, output *BatchDeleteClusterSnapshotsOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opBatchDeleteClusterSnapshots, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &BatchDeleteClusterSnapshotsInput{} } output = &BatchDeleteClusterSnapshotsOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // BatchDeleteClusterSnapshots API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Deletes a set of cluster snapshots. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation BatchDeleteClusterSnapshots for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeBatchDeleteRequestSizeExceededFault "BatchDeleteRequestSizeExceeded" // The maximum number for a batch delete of snapshots has been reached. The // limit is 100. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/BatchDeleteClusterSnapshots func (c *Redshift) BatchDeleteClusterSnapshots(input *BatchDeleteClusterSnapshotsInput) (*BatchDeleteClusterSnapshotsOutput, error) { req, out := c.BatchDeleteClusterSnapshotsRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // BatchDeleteClusterSnapshotsWithContext is the same as BatchDeleteClusterSnapshots with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See BatchDeleteClusterSnapshots for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) BatchDeleteClusterSnapshotsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *BatchDeleteClusterSnapshotsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*BatchDeleteClusterSnapshotsOutput, error) { req, out := c.BatchDeleteClusterSnapshotsRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opBatchModifyClusterSnapshots = "BatchModifyClusterSnapshots" // BatchModifyClusterSnapshotsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the BatchModifyClusterSnapshots operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See BatchModifyClusterSnapshots for more information on using the BatchModifyClusterSnapshots // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the BatchModifyClusterSnapshotsRequest method. // req, resp := client.BatchModifyClusterSnapshotsRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/BatchModifyClusterSnapshots func (c *Redshift) BatchModifyClusterSnapshotsRequest(input *BatchModifyClusterSnapshotsInput) (req *request.Request, output *BatchModifyClusterSnapshotsOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opBatchModifyClusterSnapshots, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &BatchModifyClusterSnapshotsInput{} } output = &BatchModifyClusterSnapshotsOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // BatchModifyClusterSnapshots API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Modifies the settings for a list of snapshots. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation BatchModifyClusterSnapshots for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeInvalidRetentionPeriodFault "InvalidRetentionPeriodFault" // The retention period specified is either in the past or is not a valid value. // // The value must be either -1 or an integer between 1 and 3,653. // // * ErrCodeBatchModifyClusterSnapshotsLimitExceededFault "BatchModifyClusterSnapshotsLimitExceededFault" // The maximum number for snapshot identifiers has been reached. The limit is // 100. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/BatchModifyClusterSnapshots func (c *Redshift) BatchModifyClusterSnapshots(input *BatchModifyClusterSnapshotsInput) (*BatchModifyClusterSnapshotsOutput, error) { req, out := c.BatchModifyClusterSnapshotsRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // BatchModifyClusterSnapshotsWithContext is the same as BatchModifyClusterSnapshots with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See BatchModifyClusterSnapshots for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) BatchModifyClusterSnapshotsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *BatchModifyClusterSnapshotsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*BatchModifyClusterSnapshotsOutput, error) { req, out := c.BatchModifyClusterSnapshotsRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opCancelResize = "CancelResize" // CancelResizeRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the CancelResize operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See CancelResize for more information on using the CancelResize // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the CancelResizeRequest method. // req, resp := client.CancelResizeRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/CancelResize func (c *Redshift) CancelResizeRequest(input *CancelResizeInput) (req *request.Request, output *CancelResizeOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opCancelResize, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &CancelResizeInput{} } output = &CancelResizeOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // CancelResize API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Cancels a resize operation. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation CancelResize for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeClusterNotFoundFault "ClusterNotFound" // The ClusterIdentifier parameter does not refer to an existing cluster. // // * ErrCodeResizeNotFoundFault "ResizeNotFound" // A resize operation for the specified cluster is not found. // // * ErrCodeInvalidClusterStateFault "InvalidClusterState" // The specified cluster is not in the available state. // // * ErrCodeUnsupportedOperationFault "UnsupportedOperation" // The requested operation isn't supported. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/CancelResize func (c *Redshift) CancelResize(input *CancelResizeInput) (*CancelResizeOutput, error) { req, out := c.CancelResizeRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // CancelResizeWithContext is the same as CancelResize with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See CancelResize for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) CancelResizeWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CancelResizeInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CancelResizeOutput, error) { req, out := c.CancelResizeRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opCopyClusterSnapshot = "CopyClusterSnapshot" // CopyClusterSnapshotRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the CopyClusterSnapshot operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See CopyClusterSnapshot for more information on using the CopyClusterSnapshot // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the CopyClusterSnapshotRequest method. // req, resp := client.CopyClusterSnapshotRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/CopyClusterSnapshot func (c *Redshift) CopyClusterSnapshotRequest(input *CopyClusterSnapshotInput) (req *request.Request, output *CopyClusterSnapshotOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opCopyClusterSnapshot, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &CopyClusterSnapshotInput{} } output = &CopyClusterSnapshotOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // CopyClusterSnapshot API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Copies the specified automated cluster snapshot to a new manual cluster snapshot. // The source must be an automated snapshot and it must be in the available // state. // // When you delete a cluster, Amazon Redshift deletes any automated snapshots // of the cluster. Also, when the retention period of the snapshot expires, // Amazon Redshift automatically deletes it. If you want to keep an automated // snapshot for a longer period, you can make a manual copy of the snapshot. // Manual snapshots are retained until you delete them. // // For more information about working with snapshots, go to Amazon Redshift // Snapshots (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-snapshots.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation CopyClusterSnapshot for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeClusterSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault "ClusterSnapshotAlreadyExists" // The value specified as a snapshot identifier is already used by an existing // snapshot. // // * ErrCodeClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault "ClusterSnapshotNotFound" // The snapshot identifier does not refer to an existing cluster snapshot. // // * ErrCodeInvalidClusterSnapshotStateFault "InvalidClusterSnapshotState" // The specified cluster snapshot is not in the available state, or other accounts // are authorized to access the snapshot. // // * ErrCodeClusterSnapshotQuotaExceededFault "ClusterSnapshotQuotaExceeded" // The request would result in the user exceeding the allowed number of cluster // snapshots. // // * ErrCodeInvalidRetentionPeriodFault "InvalidRetentionPeriodFault" // The retention period specified is either in the past or is not a valid value. // // The value must be either -1 or an integer between 1 and 3,653. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/CopyClusterSnapshot func (c *Redshift) CopyClusterSnapshot(input *CopyClusterSnapshotInput) (*CopyClusterSnapshotOutput, error) { req, out := c.CopyClusterSnapshotRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // CopyClusterSnapshotWithContext is the same as CopyClusterSnapshot with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See CopyClusterSnapshot for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) CopyClusterSnapshotWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CopyClusterSnapshotInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CopyClusterSnapshotOutput, error) { req, out := c.CopyClusterSnapshotRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opCreateCluster = "CreateCluster" // CreateClusterRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the CreateCluster operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See CreateCluster for more information on using the CreateCluster // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the CreateClusterRequest method. // req, resp := client.CreateClusterRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/CreateCluster func (c *Redshift) CreateClusterRequest(input *CreateClusterInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateClusterOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opCreateCluster, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &CreateClusterInput{} } output = &CreateClusterOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // CreateCluster API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Creates a new cluster. // // To create a cluster in Virtual Private Cloud (VPC), you must provide a cluster // subnet group name. The cluster subnet group identifies the subnets of your // VPC that Amazon Redshift uses when creating the cluster. For more information // about managing clusters, go to Amazon Redshift Clusters (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-clusters.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation CreateCluster for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeClusterAlreadyExistsFault "ClusterAlreadyExists" // The account already has a cluster with the given identifier. // // * ErrCodeInsufficientClusterCapacityFault "InsufficientClusterCapacity" // The number of nodes specified exceeds the allotted capacity of the cluster. // // * ErrCodeClusterParameterGroupNotFoundFault "ClusterParameterGroupNotFound" // The parameter group name does not refer to an existing parameter group. // // * ErrCodeClusterSecurityGroupNotFoundFault "ClusterSecurityGroupNotFound" // The cluster security group name does not refer to an existing cluster security // group. // // * ErrCodeClusterQuotaExceededFault "ClusterQuotaExceeded" // The request would exceed the allowed number of cluster instances for this // account. For information about increasing your quota, go to Limits in Amazon // Redshift (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/amazon-redshift-limits.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // * ErrCodeNumberOfNodesQuotaExceededFault "NumberOfNodesQuotaExceeded" // The operation would exceed the number of nodes allotted to the account. For // information about increasing your quota, go to Limits in Amazon Redshift // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/amazon-redshift-limits.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // * ErrCodeNumberOfNodesPerClusterLimitExceededFault "NumberOfNodesPerClusterLimitExceeded" // The operation would exceed the number of nodes allowed for a cluster. // // * ErrCodeClusterSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "ClusterSubnetGroupNotFoundFault" // The cluster subnet group name does not refer to an existing cluster subnet // group. // // * ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault "InvalidVPCNetworkStateFault" // The cluster subnet group does not cover all Availability Zones. // // * ErrCodeInvalidClusterSubnetGroupStateFault "InvalidClusterSubnetGroupStateFault" // The cluster subnet group cannot be deleted because it is in use. // // * ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet" // The requested subnet is not valid, or not all of the subnets are in the same // VPC. // // * ErrCodeUnauthorizedOperation "UnauthorizedOperation" // Your account is not authorized to perform the requested operation. // // * ErrCodeHsmClientCertificateNotFoundFault "HsmClientCertificateNotFoundFault" // There is no Amazon Redshift HSM client certificate with the specified identifier. // // * ErrCodeHsmConfigurationNotFoundFault "HsmConfigurationNotFoundFault" // There is no Amazon Redshift HSM configuration with the specified identifier. // // * ErrCodeInvalidElasticIpFault "InvalidElasticIpFault" // The Elastic IP (EIP) is invalid or cannot be found. // // * ErrCodeTagLimitExceededFault "TagLimitExceededFault" // You have exceeded the number of tags allowed. // // * ErrCodeInvalidTagFault "InvalidTagFault" // The tag is invalid. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededFault "LimitExceededFault" // The encryption key has exceeded its grant limit in AWS KMS. // // * ErrCodeDependentServiceRequestThrottlingFault "DependentServiceRequestThrottlingFault" // The request cannot be completed because a dependent service is throttling // requests made by Amazon Redshift on your behalf. Wait and retry the request. // // * ErrCodeInvalidClusterTrackFault "InvalidClusterTrack" // The provided cluster track name is not valid. // // * ErrCodeSnapshotScheduleNotFoundFault "SnapshotScheduleNotFound" // We could not find the specified snapshot schedule. // // * ErrCodeInvalidRetentionPeriodFault "InvalidRetentionPeriodFault" // The retention period specified is either in the past or is not a valid value. // // The value must be either -1 or an integer between 1 and 3,653. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/CreateCluster func (c *Redshift) CreateCluster(input *CreateClusterInput) (*CreateClusterOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateClusterRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // CreateClusterWithContext is the same as CreateCluster with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See CreateCluster for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) CreateClusterWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateClusterInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateClusterOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateClusterRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opCreateClusterParameterGroup = "CreateClusterParameterGroup" // CreateClusterParameterGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the CreateClusterParameterGroup operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See CreateClusterParameterGroup for more information on using the CreateClusterParameterGroup // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the CreateClusterParameterGroupRequest method. // req, resp := client.CreateClusterParameterGroupRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/CreateClusterParameterGroup func (c *Redshift) CreateClusterParameterGroupRequest(input *CreateClusterParameterGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateClusterParameterGroupOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opCreateClusterParameterGroup, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &CreateClusterParameterGroupInput{} } output = &CreateClusterParameterGroupOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // CreateClusterParameterGroup API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Creates an Amazon Redshift parameter group. // // Creating parameter groups is independent of creating clusters. You can associate // a cluster with a parameter group when you create the cluster. You can also // associate an existing cluster with a parameter group after the cluster is // created by using ModifyCluster. // // Parameters in the parameter group define specific behavior that applies to // the databases you create on the cluster. For more information about parameters // and parameter groups, go to Amazon Redshift Parameter Groups (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-parameter-groups.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation CreateClusterParameterGroup for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeClusterParameterGroupQuotaExceededFault "ClusterParameterGroupQuotaExceeded" // The request would result in the user exceeding the allowed number of cluster // parameter groups. For information about increasing your quota, go to Limits // in Amazon Redshift (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/amazon-redshift-limits.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // * ErrCodeClusterParameterGroupAlreadyExistsFault "ClusterParameterGroupAlreadyExists" // A cluster parameter group with the same name already exists. // // * ErrCodeTagLimitExceededFault "TagLimitExceededFault" // You have exceeded the number of tags allowed. // // * ErrCodeInvalidTagFault "InvalidTagFault" // The tag is invalid. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/CreateClusterParameterGroup func (c *Redshift) CreateClusterParameterGroup(input *CreateClusterParameterGroupInput) (*CreateClusterParameterGroupOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateClusterParameterGroupRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // CreateClusterParameterGroupWithContext is the same as CreateClusterParameterGroup with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See CreateClusterParameterGroup for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) CreateClusterParameterGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateClusterParameterGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateClusterParameterGroupOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateClusterParameterGroupRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opCreateClusterSecurityGroup = "CreateClusterSecurityGroup" // CreateClusterSecurityGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the CreateClusterSecurityGroup operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See CreateClusterSecurityGroup for more information on using the CreateClusterSecurityGroup // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the CreateClusterSecurityGroupRequest method. // req, resp := client.CreateClusterSecurityGroupRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/CreateClusterSecurityGroup func (c *Redshift) CreateClusterSecurityGroupRequest(input *CreateClusterSecurityGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateClusterSecurityGroupOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opCreateClusterSecurityGroup, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &CreateClusterSecurityGroupInput{} } output = &CreateClusterSecurityGroupOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // CreateClusterSecurityGroup API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Creates a new Amazon Redshift security group. You use security groups to // control access to non-VPC clusters. // // For information about managing security groups, go to Amazon Redshift Cluster // Security Groups (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-security-groups.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation CreateClusterSecurityGroup for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeClusterSecurityGroupAlreadyExistsFault "ClusterSecurityGroupAlreadyExists" // A cluster security group with the same name already exists. // // * ErrCodeClusterSecurityGroupQuotaExceededFault "QuotaExceeded.ClusterSecurityGroup" // The request would result in the user exceeding the allowed number of cluster // security groups. For information about increasing your quota, go to Limits // in Amazon Redshift (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/amazon-redshift-limits.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // * ErrCodeTagLimitExceededFault "TagLimitExceededFault" // You have exceeded the number of tags allowed. // // * ErrCodeInvalidTagFault "InvalidTagFault" // The tag is invalid. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/CreateClusterSecurityGroup func (c *Redshift) CreateClusterSecurityGroup(input *CreateClusterSecurityGroupInput) (*CreateClusterSecurityGroupOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateClusterSecurityGroupRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // CreateClusterSecurityGroupWithContext is the same as CreateClusterSecurityGroup with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See CreateClusterSecurityGroup for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) CreateClusterSecurityGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateClusterSecurityGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateClusterSecurityGroupOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateClusterSecurityGroupRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opCreateClusterSnapshot = "CreateClusterSnapshot" // CreateClusterSnapshotRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the CreateClusterSnapshot operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See CreateClusterSnapshot for more information on using the CreateClusterSnapshot // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the CreateClusterSnapshotRequest method. // req, resp := client.CreateClusterSnapshotRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/CreateClusterSnapshot func (c *Redshift) CreateClusterSnapshotRequest(input *CreateClusterSnapshotInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateClusterSnapshotOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opCreateClusterSnapshot, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &CreateClusterSnapshotInput{} } output = &CreateClusterSnapshotOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // CreateClusterSnapshot API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Creates a manual snapshot of the specified cluster. The cluster must be in // the available state. // // For more information about working with snapshots, go to Amazon Redshift // Snapshots (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-snapshots.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation CreateClusterSnapshot for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeClusterSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault "ClusterSnapshotAlreadyExists" // The value specified as a snapshot identifier is already used by an existing // snapshot. // // * ErrCodeInvalidClusterStateFault "InvalidClusterState" // The specified cluster is not in the available state. // // * ErrCodeClusterNotFoundFault "ClusterNotFound" // The ClusterIdentifier parameter does not refer to an existing cluster. // // * ErrCodeClusterSnapshotQuotaExceededFault "ClusterSnapshotQuotaExceeded" // The request would result in the user exceeding the allowed number of cluster // snapshots. // // * ErrCodeTagLimitExceededFault "TagLimitExceededFault" // You have exceeded the number of tags allowed. // // * ErrCodeInvalidTagFault "InvalidTagFault" // The tag is invalid. // // * ErrCodeInvalidRetentionPeriodFault "InvalidRetentionPeriodFault" // The retention period specified is either in the past or is not a valid value. // // The value must be either -1 or an integer between 1 and 3,653. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/CreateClusterSnapshot func (c *Redshift) CreateClusterSnapshot(input *CreateClusterSnapshotInput) (*CreateClusterSnapshotOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateClusterSnapshotRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // CreateClusterSnapshotWithContext is the same as CreateClusterSnapshot with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See CreateClusterSnapshot for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) CreateClusterSnapshotWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateClusterSnapshotInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateClusterSnapshotOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateClusterSnapshotRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opCreateClusterSubnetGroup = "CreateClusterSubnetGroup" // CreateClusterSubnetGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the CreateClusterSubnetGroup operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See CreateClusterSubnetGroup for more information on using the CreateClusterSubnetGroup // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the CreateClusterSubnetGroupRequest method. // req, resp := client.CreateClusterSubnetGroupRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/CreateClusterSubnetGroup func (c *Redshift) CreateClusterSubnetGroupRequest(input *CreateClusterSubnetGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateClusterSubnetGroupOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opCreateClusterSubnetGroup, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &CreateClusterSubnetGroupInput{} } output = &CreateClusterSubnetGroupOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // CreateClusterSubnetGroup API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Creates a new Amazon Redshift subnet group. You must provide a list of one // or more subnets in your existing Amazon Virtual Private Cloud (Amazon VPC) // when creating Amazon Redshift subnet group. // // For information about subnet groups, go to Amazon Redshift Cluster Subnet // Groups (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-cluster-subnet-groups.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation CreateClusterSubnetGroup for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeClusterSubnetGroupAlreadyExistsFault "ClusterSubnetGroupAlreadyExists" // A ClusterSubnetGroupName is already used by an existing cluster subnet group. // // * ErrCodeClusterSubnetGroupQuotaExceededFault "ClusterSubnetGroupQuotaExceeded" // The request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of cluster // subnet groups. For information about increasing your quota, go to Limits // in Amazon Redshift (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/amazon-redshift-limits.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // * ErrCodeClusterSubnetQuotaExceededFault "ClusterSubnetQuotaExceededFault" // The request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of subnets // in a cluster subnet groups. For information about increasing your quota, // go to Limits in Amazon Redshift (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/amazon-redshift-limits.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // * ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet" // The requested subnet is not valid, or not all of the subnets are in the same // VPC. // // * ErrCodeUnauthorizedOperation "UnauthorizedOperation" // Your account is not authorized to perform the requested operation. // // * ErrCodeTagLimitExceededFault "TagLimitExceededFault" // You have exceeded the number of tags allowed. // // * ErrCodeInvalidTagFault "InvalidTagFault" // The tag is invalid. // // * ErrCodeDependentServiceRequestThrottlingFault "DependentServiceRequestThrottlingFault" // The request cannot be completed because a dependent service is throttling // requests made by Amazon Redshift on your behalf. Wait and retry the request. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/CreateClusterSubnetGroup func (c *Redshift) CreateClusterSubnetGroup(input *CreateClusterSubnetGroupInput) (*CreateClusterSubnetGroupOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateClusterSubnetGroupRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // CreateClusterSubnetGroupWithContext is the same as CreateClusterSubnetGroup with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See CreateClusterSubnetGroup for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) CreateClusterSubnetGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateClusterSubnetGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateClusterSubnetGroupOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateClusterSubnetGroupRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opCreateEventSubscription = "CreateEventSubscription" // CreateEventSubscriptionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the CreateEventSubscription operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See CreateEventSubscription for more information on using the CreateEventSubscription // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the CreateEventSubscriptionRequest method. // req, resp := client.CreateEventSubscriptionRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/CreateEventSubscription func (c *Redshift) CreateEventSubscriptionRequest(input *CreateEventSubscriptionInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateEventSubscriptionOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opCreateEventSubscription, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &CreateEventSubscriptionInput{} } output = &CreateEventSubscriptionOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // CreateEventSubscription API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Creates an Amazon Redshift event notification subscription. This action requires // an ARN (Amazon Resource Name) of an Amazon SNS topic created by either the // Amazon Redshift console, the Amazon SNS console, or the Amazon SNS API. To // obtain an ARN with Amazon SNS, you must create a topic in Amazon SNS and // subscribe to the topic. The ARN is displayed in the SNS console. // // You can specify the source type, and lists of Amazon Redshift source IDs, // event categories, and event severities. Notifications will be sent for all // events you want that match those criteria. For example, you can specify source // type = cluster, source ID = my-cluster-1 and mycluster2, event categories // = Availability, Backup, and severity = ERROR. The subscription will only // send notifications for those ERROR events in the Availability and Backup // categories for the specified clusters. // // If you specify both the source type and source IDs, such as source type = // cluster and source identifier = my-cluster-1, notifications will be sent // for all the cluster events for my-cluster-1. If you specify a source type // but do not specify a source identifier, you will receive notice of the events // for the objects of that type in your AWS account. If you do not specify either // the SourceType nor the SourceIdentifier, you will be notified of events generated // from all Amazon Redshift sources belonging to your AWS account. You must // specify a source type if you specify a source ID. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation CreateEventSubscription for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeEventSubscriptionQuotaExceededFault "EventSubscriptionQuotaExceeded" // The request would exceed the allowed number of event subscriptions for this // account. For information about increasing your quota, go to Limits in Amazon // Redshift (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/amazon-redshift-limits.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // * ErrCodeSubscriptionAlreadyExistFault "SubscriptionAlreadyExist" // There is already an existing event notification subscription with the specified // name. // // * ErrCodeSNSInvalidTopicFault "SNSInvalidTopic" // Amazon SNS has responded that there is a problem with the specified Amazon // SNS topic. // // * ErrCodeSNSNoAuthorizationFault "SNSNoAuthorization" // You do not have permission to publish to the specified Amazon SNS topic. // // * ErrCodeSNSTopicArnNotFoundFault "SNSTopicArnNotFound" // An Amazon SNS topic with the specified Amazon Resource Name (ARN) does not // exist. // // * ErrCodeSubscriptionEventIdNotFoundFault "SubscriptionEventIdNotFound" // An Amazon Redshift event with the specified event ID does not exist. // // * ErrCodeSubscriptionCategoryNotFoundFault "SubscriptionCategoryNotFound" // The value specified for the event category was not one of the allowed values, // or it specified a category that does not apply to the specified source type. // The allowed values are Configuration, Management, Monitoring, and Security. // // * ErrCodeSubscriptionSeverityNotFoundFault "SubscriptionSeverityNotFound" // The value specified for the event severity was not one of the allowed values, // or it specified a severity that does not apply to the specified source type. // The allowed values are ERROR and INFO. // // * ErrCodeSourceNotFoundFault "SourceNotFound" // The specified Amazon Redshift event source could not be found. // // * ErrCodeTagLimitExceededFault "TagLimitExceededFault" // You have exceeded the number of tags allowed. // // * ErrCodeInvalidTagFault "InvalidTagFault" // The tag is invalid. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/CreateEventSubscription func (c *Redshift) CreateEventSubscription(input *CreateEventSubscriptionInput) (*CreateEventSubscriptionOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateEventSubscriptionRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // CreateEventSubscriptionWithContext is the same as CreateEventSubscription with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See CreateEventSubscription for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) CreateEventSubscriptionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateEventSubscriptionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateEventSubscriptionOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateEventSubscriptionRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opCreateHsmClientCertificate = "CreateHsmClientCertificate" // CreateHsmClientCertificateRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the CreateHsmClientCertificate operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See CreateHsmClientCertificate for more information on using the CreateHsmClientCertificate // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the CreateHsmClientCertificateRequest method. // req, resp := client.CreateHsmClientCertificateRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/CreateHsmClientCertificate func (c *Redshift) CreateHsmClientCertificateRequest(input *CreateHsmClientCertificateInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateHsmClientCertificateOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opCreateHsmClientCertificate, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &CreateHsmClientCertificateInput{} } output = &CreateHsmClientCertificateOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // CreateHsmClientCertificate API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Creates an HSM client certificate that an Amazon Redshift cluster will use // to connect to the client's HSM in order to store and retrieve the keys used // to encrypt the cluster databases. // // The command returns a public key, which you must store in the HSM. In addition // to creating the HSM certificate, you must create an Amazon Redshift HSM configuration // that provides a cluster the information needed to store and use encryption // keys in the HSM. For more information, go to Hardware Security Modules (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-HSM.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation CreateHsmClientCertificate for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeHsmClientCertificateAlreadyExistsFault "HsmClientCertificateAlreadyExistsFault" // There is already an existing Amazon Redshift HSM client certificate with // the specified identifier. // // * ErrCodeHsmClientCertificateQuotaExceededFault "HsmClientCertificateQuotaExceededFault" // The quota for HSM client certificates has been reached. For information about // increasing your quota, go to Limits in Amazon Redshift (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/amazon-redshift-limits.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // * ErrCodeTagLimitExceededFault "TagLimitExceededFault" // You have exceeded the number of tags allowed. // // * ErrCodeInvalidTagFault "InvalidTagFault" // The tag is invalid. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/CreateHsmClientCertificate func (c *Redshift) CreateHsmClientCertificate(input *CreateHsmClientCertificateInput) (*CreateHsmClientCertificateOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateHsmClientCertificateRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // CreateHsmClientCertificateWithContext is the same as CreateHsmClientCertificate with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See CreateHsmClientCertificate for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) CreateHsmClientCertificateWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateHsmClientCertificateInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateHsmClientCertificateOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateHsmClientCertificateRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opCreateHsmConfiguration = "CreateHsmConfiguration" // CreateHsmConfigurationRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the CreateHsmConfiguration operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See CreateHsmConfiguration for more information on using the CreateHsmConfiguration // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the CreateHsmConfigurationRequest method. // req, resp := client.CreateHsmConfigurationRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/CreateHsmConfiguration func (c *Redshift) CreateHsmConfigurationRequest(input *CreateHsmConfigurationInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateHsmConfigurationOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opCreateHsmConfiguration, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &CreateHsmConfigurationInput{} } output = &CreateHsmConfigurationOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // CreateHsmConfiguration API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Creates an HSM configuration that contains the information required by an // Amazon Redshift cluster to store and use database encryption keys in a Hardware // Security Module (HSM). After creating the HSM configuration, you can specify // it as a parameter when creating a cluster. The cluster will then store its // encryption keys in the HSM. // // In addition to creating an HSM configuration, you must also create an HSM // client certificate. For more information, go to Hardware Security Modules // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-HSM.html) in // the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation CreateHsmConfiguration for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeHsmConfigurationAlreadyExistsFault "HsmConfigurationAlreadyExistsFault" // There is already an existing Amazon Redshift HSM configuration with the specified // identifier. // // * ErrCodeHsmConfigurationQuotaExceededFault "HsmConfigurationQuotaExceededFault" // The quota for HSM configurations has been reached. For information about // increasing your quota, go to Limits in Amazon Redshift (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/amazon-redshift-limits.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // * ErrCodeTagLimitExceededFault "TagLimitExceededFault" // You have exceeded the number of tags allowed. // // * ErrCodeInvalidTagFault "InvalidTagFault" // The tag is invalid. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/CreateHsmConfiguration func (c *Redshift) CreateHsmConfiguration(input *CreateHsmConfigurationInput) (*CreateHsmConfigurationOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateHsmConfigurationRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // CreateHsmConfigurationWithContext is the same as CreateHsmConfiguration with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See CreateHsmConfiguration for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) CreateHsmConfigurationWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateHsmConfigurationInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateHsmConfigurationOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateHsmConfigurationRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opCreateSnapshotCopyGrant = "CreateSnapshotCopyGrant" // CreateSnapshotCopyGrantRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the CreateSnapshotCopyGrant operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See CreateSnapshotCopyGrant for more information on using the CreateSnapshotCopyGrant // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the CreateSnapshotCopyGrantRequest method. // req, resp := client.CreateSnapshotCopyGrantRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/CreateSnapshotCopyGrant func (c *Redshift) CreateSnapshotCopyGrantRequest(input *CreateSnapshotCopyGrantInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateSnapshotCopyGrantOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opCreateSnapshotCopyGrant, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &CreateSnapshotCopyGrantInput{} } output = &CreateSnapshotCopyGrantOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // CreateSnapshotCopyGrant API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Creates a snapshot copy grant that permits Amazon Redshift to use a customer // master key (CMK) from AWS Key Management Service (AWS KMS) to encrypt copied // snapshots in a destination region. // // For more information about managing snapshot copy grants, go to Amazon Redshift // Database Encryption (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-db-encryption.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation CreateSnapshotCopyGrant for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeSnapshotCopyGrantAlreadyExistsFault "SnapshotCopyGrantAlreadyExistsFault" // The snapshot copy grant can't be created because a grant with the same name // already exists. // // * ErrCodeSnapshotCopyGrantQuotaExceededFault "SnapshotCopyGrantQuotaExceededFault" // The AWS account has exceeded the maximum number of snapshot copy grants in // this region. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededFault "LimitExceededFault" // The encryption key has exceeded its grant limit in AWS KMS. // // * ErrCodeTagLimitExceededFault "TagLimitExceededFault" // You have exceeded the number of tags allowed. // // * ErrCodeInvalidTagFault "InvalidTagFault" // The tag is invalid. // // * ErrCodeDependentServiceRequestThrottlingFault "DependentServiceRequestThrottlingFault" // The request cannot be completed because a dependent service is throttling // requests made by Amazon Redshift on your behalf. Wait and retry the request. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/CreateSnapshotCopyGrant func (c *Redshift) CreateSnapshotCopyGrant(input *CreateSnapshotCopyGrantInput) (*CreateSnapshotCopyGrantOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateSnapshotCopyGrantRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // CreateSnapshotCopyGrantWithContext is the same as CreateSnapshotCopyGrant with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See CreateSnapshotCopyGrant for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) CreateSnapshotCopyGrantWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateSnapshotCopyGrantInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateSnapshotCopyGrantOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateSnapshotCopyGrantRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opCreateSnapshotSchedule = "CreateSnapshotSchedule" // CreateSnapshotScheduleRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the CreateSnapshotSchedule operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See CreateSnapshotSchedule for more information on using the CreateSnapshotSchedule // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the CreateSnapshotScheduleRequest method. // req, resp := client.CreateSnapshotScheduleRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/CreateSnapshotSchedule func (c *Redshift) CreateSnapshotScheduleRequest(input *CreateSnapshotScheduleInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateSnapshotScheduleOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opCreateSnapshotSchedule, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &CreateSnapshotScheduleInput{} } output = &CreateSnapshotScheduleOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // CreateSnapshotSchedule API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Creates a new snapshot schedule. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation CreateSnapshotSchedule for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeSnapshotScheduleAlreadyExistsFault "SnapshotScheduleAlreadyExists" // The specified snapshot schedule already exists. // // * ErrCodeInvalidScheduleFault "InvalidSchedule" // The schedule you submitted isn't valid. // // * ErrCodeSnapshotScheduleQuotaExceededFault "SnapshotScheduleQuotaExceeded" // You have exceeded the quota of snapshot schedules. // // * ErrCodeTagLimitExceededFault "TagLimitExceededFault" // You have exceeded the number of tags allowed. // // * ErrCodeScheduleDefinitionTypeUnsupportedFault "ScheduleDefinitionTypeUnsupported" // The definition you submitted is not supported. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/CreateSnapshotSchedule func (c *Redshift) CreateSnapshotSchedule(input *CreateSnapshotScheduleInput) (*CreateSnapshotScheduleOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateSnapshotScheduleRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // CreateSnapshotScheduleWithContext is the same as CreateSnapshotSchedule with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See CreateSnapshotSchedule for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) CreateSnapshotScheduleWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateSnapshotScheduleInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateSnapshotScheduleOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateSnapshotScheduleRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opCreateTags = "CreateTags" // CreateTagsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the CreateTags operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See CreateTags for more information on using the CreateTags // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the CreateTagsRequest method. // req, resp := client.CreateTagsRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/CreateTags func (c *Redshift) CreateTagsRequest(input *CreateTagsInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateTagsOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opCreateTags, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &CreateTagsInput{} } output = &CreateTagsOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(query.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // CreateTags API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Adds one or more tags to a specified resource. // // A resource can have up to 50 tags. If you try to create more than 50 tags // for a resource, you will receive an error and the attempt will fail. // // If you specify a key that already exists for the resource, the value for // that key will be updated with the new value. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation CreateTags for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeTagLimitExceededFault "TagLimitExceededFault" // You have exceeded the number of tags allowed. // // * ErrCodeResourceNotFoundFault "ResourceNotFoundFault" // The resource could not be found. // // * ErrCodeInvalidTagFault "InvalidTagFault" // The tag is invalid. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/CreateTags func (c *Redshift) CreateTags(input *CreateTagsInput) (*CreateTagsOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateTagsRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // CreateTagsWithContext is the same as CreateTags with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See CreateTags for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) CreateTagsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateTagsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateTagsOutput, error) { req, out := c.CreateTagsRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDeleteCluster = "DeleteCluster" // DeleteClusterRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DeleteCluster operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DeleteCluster for more information on using the DeleteCluster // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DeleteClusterRequest method. // req, resp := client.DeleteClusterRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DeleteCluster func (c *Redshift) DeleteClusterRequest(input *DeleteClusterInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteClusterOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDeleteCluster, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DeleteClusterInput{} } output = &DeleteClusterOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // DeleteCluster API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Deletes a previously provisioned cluster. A successful response from the // web service indicates that the request was received correctly. Use DescribeClusters // to monitor the status of the deletion. The delete operation cannot be canceled // or reverted once submitted. For more information about managing clusters, // go to Amazon Redshift Clusters (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-clusters.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // If you want to shut down the cluster and retain it for future use, set SkipFinalClusterSnapshot // to false and specify a name for FinalClusterSnapshotIdentifier. You can later // restore this snapshot to resume using the cluster. If a final cluster snapshot // is requested, the status of the cluster will be "final-snapshot" while the // snapshot is being taken, then it's "deleting" once Amazon Redshift begins // deleting the cluster. // // For more information about managing clusters, go to Amazon Redshift Clusters // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-clusters.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation DeleteCluster for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeClusterNotFoundFault "ClusterNotFound" // The ClusterIdentifier parameter does not refer to an existing cluster. // // * ErrCodeInvalidClusterStateFault "InvalidClusterState" // The specified cluster is not in the available state. // // * ErrCodeClusterSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault "ClusterSnapshotAlreadyExists" // The value specified as a snapshot identifier is already used by an existing // snapshot. // // * ErrCodeClusterSnapshotQuotaExceededFault "ClusterSnapshotQuotaExceeded" // The request would result in the user exceeding the allowed number of cluster // snapshots. // // * ErrCodeInvalidRetentionPeriodFault "InvalidRetentionPeriodFault" // The retention period specified is either in the past or is not a valid value. // // The value must be either -1 or an integer between 1 and 3,653. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DeleteCluster func (c *Redshift) DeleteCluster(input *DeleteClusterInput) (*DeleteClusterOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteClusterRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DeleteClusterWithContext is the same as DeleteCluster with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DeleteCluster for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DeleteClusterWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteClusterInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteClusterOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteClusterRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDeleteClusterParameterGroup = "DeleteClusterParameterGroup" // DeleteClusterParameterGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DeleteClusterParameterGroup operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DeleteClusterParameterGroup for more information on using the DeleteClusterParameterGroup // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DeleteClusterParameterGroupRequest method. // req, resp := client.DeleteClusterParameterGroupRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DeleteClusterParameterGroup func (c *Redshift) DeleteClusterParameterGroupRequest(input *DeleteClusterParameterGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteClusterParameterGroupOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDeleteClusterParameterGroup, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DeleteClusterParameterGroupInput{} } output = &DeleteClusterParameterGroupOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(query.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // DeleteClusterParameterGroup API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Deletes a specified Amazon Redshift parameter group. // // You cannot delete a parameter group if it is associated with a cluster. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation DeleteClusterParameterGroup for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeInvalidClusterParameterGroupStateFault "InvalidClusterParameterGroupState" // The cluster parameter group action can not be completed because another task // is in progress that involves the parameter group. Wait a few moments and // try the operation again. // // * ErrCodeClusterParameterGroupNotFoundFault "ClusterParameterGroupNotFound" // The parameter group name does not refer to an existing parameter group. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DeleteClusterParameterGroup func (c *Redshift) DeleteClusterParameterGroup(input *DeleteClusterParameterGroupInput) (*DeleteClusterParameterGroupOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteClusterParameterGroupRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DeleteClusterParameterGroupWithContext is the same as DeleteClusterParameterGroup with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DeleteClusterParameterGroup for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DeleteClusterParameterGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteClusterParameterGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteClusterParameterGroupOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteClusterParameterGroupRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDeleteClusterSecurityGroup = "DeleteClusterSecurityGroup" // DeleteClusterSecurityGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DeleteClusterSecurityGroup operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DeleteClusterSecurityGroup for more information on using the DeleteClusterSecurityGroup // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DeleteClusterSecurityGroupRequest method. // req, resp := client.DeleteClusterSecurityGroupRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DeleteClusterSecurityGroup func (c *Redshift) DeleteClusterSecurityGroupRequest(input *DeleteClusterSecurityGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteClusterSecurityGroupOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDeleteClusterSecurityGroup, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DeleteClusterSecurityGroupInput{} } output = &DeleteClusterSecurityGroupOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(query.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // DeleteClusterSecurityGroup API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Deletes an Amazon Redshift security group. // // You cannot delete a security group that is associated with any clusters. // You cannot delete the default security group. // // For information about managing security groups, go to Amazon Redshift Cluster // Security Groups (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-security-groups.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation DeleteClusterSecurityGroup for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeInvalidClusterSecurityGroupStateFault "InvalidClusterSecurityGroupState" // The state of the cluster security group is not available. // // * ErrCodeClusterSecurityGroupNotFoundFault "ClusterSecurityGroupNotFound" // The cluster security group name does not refer to an existing cluster security // group. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DeleteClusterSecurityGroup func (c *Redshift) DeleteClusterSecurityGroup(input *DeleteClusterSecurityGroupInput) (*DeleteClusterSecurityGroupOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteClusterSecurityGroupRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DeleteClusterSecurityGroupWithContext is the same as DeleteClusterSecurityGroup with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DeleteClusterSecurityGroup for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DeleteClusterSecurityGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteClusterSecurityGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteClusterSecurityGroupOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteClusterSecurityGroupRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDeleteClusterSnapshot = "DeleteClusterSnapshot" // DeleteClusterSnapshotRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DeleteClusterSnapshot operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DeleteClusterSnapshot for more information on using the DeleteClusterSnapshot // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DeleteClusterSnapshotRequest method. // req, resp := client.DeleteClusterSnapshotRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DeleteClusterSnapshot func (c *Redshift) DeleteClusterSnapshotRequest(input *DeleteClusterSnapshotInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteClusterSnapshotOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDeleteClusterSnapshot, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DeleteClusterSnapshotInput{} } output = &DeleteClusterSnapshotOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // DeleteClusterSnapshot API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Deletes the specified manual snapshot. The snapshot must be in the available // state, with no other users authorized to access the snapshot. // // Unlike automated snapshots, manual snapshots are retained even after you // delete your cluster. Amazon Redshift does not delete your manual snapshots. // You must delete manual snapshot explicitly to avoid getting charged. If other // accounts are authorized to access the snapshot, you must revoke all of the // authorizations before you can delete the snapshot. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation DeleteClusterSnapshot for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeInvalidClusterSnapshotStateFault "InvalidClusterSnapshotState" // The specified cluster snapshot is not in the available state, or other accounts // are authorized to access the snapshot. // // * ErrCodeClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault "ClusterSnapshotNotFound" // The snapshot identifier does not refer to an existing cluster snapshot. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DeleteClusterSnapshot func (c *Redshift) DeleteClusterSnapshot(input *DeleteClusterSnapshotInput) (*DeleteClusterSnapshotOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteClusterSnapshotRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DeleteClusterSnapshotWithContext is the same as DeleteClusterSnapshot with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DeleteClusterSnapshot for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DeleteClusterSnapshotWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteClusterSnapshotInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteClusterSnapshotOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteClusterSnapshotRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDeleteClusterSubnetGroup = "DeleteClusterSubnetGroup" // DeleteClusterSubnetGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DeleteClusterSubnetGroup operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DeleteClusterSubnetGroup for more information on using the DeleteClusterSubnetGroup // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DeleteClusterSubnetGroupRequest method. // req, resp := client.DeleteClusterSubnetGroupRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DeleteClusterSubnetGroup func (c *Redshift) DeleteClusterSubnetGroupRequest(input *DeleteClusterSubnetGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteClusterSubnetGroupOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDeleteClusterSubnetGroup, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DeleteClusterSubnetGroupInput{} } output = &DeleteClusterSubnetGroupOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(query.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // DeleteClusterSubnetGroup API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Deletes the specified cluster subnet group. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation DeleteClusterSubnetGroup for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeInvalidClusterSubnetGroupStateFault "InvalidClusterSubnetGroupStateFault" // The cluster subnet group cannot be deleted because it is in use. // // * ErrCodeInvalidClusterSubnetStateFault "InvalidClusterSubnetStateFault" // The state of the subnet is invalid. // // * ErrCodeClusterSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "ClusterSubnetGroupNotFoundFault" // The cluster subnet group name does not refer to an existing cluster subnet // group. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DeleteClusterSubnetGroup func (c *Redshift) DeleteClusterSubnetGroup(input *DeleteClusterSubnetGroupInput) (*DeleteClusterSubnetGroupOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteClusterSubnetGroupRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DeleteClusterSubnetGroupWithContext is the same as DeleteClusterSubnetGroup with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DeleteClusterSubnetGroup for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DeleteClusterSubnetGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteClusterSubnetGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteClusterSubnetGroupOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteClusterSubnetGroupRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDeleteEventSubscription = "DeleteEventSubscription" // DeleteEventSubscriptionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DeleteEventSubscription operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DeleteEventSubscription for more information on using the DeleteEventSubscription // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DeleteEventSubscriptionRequest method. // req, resp := client.DeleteEventSubscriptionRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DeleteEventSubscription func (c *Redshift) DeleteEventSubscriptionRequest(input *DeleteEventSubscriptionInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteEventSubscriptionOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDeleteEventSubscription, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DeleteEventSubscriptionInput{} } output = &DeleteEventSubscriptionOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(query.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // DeleteEventSubscription API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Deletes an Amazon Redshift event notification subscription. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation DeleteEventSubscription for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeSubscriptionNotFoundFault "SubscriptionNotFound" // An Amazon Redshift event notification subscription with the specified name // does not exist. // // * ErrCodeInvalidSubscriptionStateFault "InvalidSubscriptionStateFault" // The subscription request is invalid because it is a duplicate request. This // subscription request is already in progress. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DeleteEventSubscription func (c *Redshift) DeleteEventSubscription(input *DeleteEventSubscriptionInput) (*DeleteEventSubscriptionOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteEventSubscriptionRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DeleteEventSubscriptionWithContext is the same as DeleteEventSubscription with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DeleteEventSubscription for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DeleteEventSubscriptionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteEventSubscriptionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteEventSubscriptionOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteEventSubscriptionRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDeleteHsmClientCertificate = "DeleteHsmClientCertificate" // DeleteHsmClientCertificateRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DeleteHsmClientCertificate operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DeleteHsmClientCertificate for more information on using the DeleteHsmClientCertificate // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DeleteHsmClientCertificateRequest method. // req, resp := client.DeleteHsmClientCertificateRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DeleteHsmClientCertificate func (c *Redshift) DeleteHsmClientCertificateRequest(input *DeleteHsmClientCertificateInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteHsmClientCertificateOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDeleteHsmClientCertificate, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DeleteHsmClientCertificateInput{} } output = &DeleteHsmClientCertificateOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(query.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // DeleteHsmClientCertificate API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Deletes the specified HSM client certificate. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation DeleteHsmClientCertificate for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeInvalidHsmClientCertificateStateFault "InvalidHsmClientCertificateStateFault" // The specified HSM client certificate is not in the available state, or it // is still in use by one or more Amazon Redshift clusters. // // * ErrCodeHsmClientCertificateNotFoundFault "HsmClientCertificateNotFoundFault" // There is no Amazon Redshift HSM client certificate with the specified identifier. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DeleteHsmClientCertificate func (c *Redshift) DeleteHsmClientCertificate(input *DeleteHsmClientCertificateInput) (*DeleteHsmClientCertificateOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteHsmClientCertificateRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DeleteHsmClientCertificateWithContext is the same as DeleteHsmClientCertificate with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DeleteHsmClientCertificate for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DeleteHsmClientCertificateWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteHsmClientCertificateInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteHsmClientCertificateOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteHsmClientCertificateRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDeleteHsmConfiguration = "DeleteHsmConfiguration" // DeleteHsmConfigurationRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DeleteHsmConfiguration operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DeleteHsmConfiguration for more information on using the DeleteHsmConfiguration // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DeleteHsmConfigurationRequest method. // req, resp := client.DeleteHsmConfigurationRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DeleteHsmConfiguration func (c *Redshift) DeleteHsmConfigurationRequest(input *DeleteHsmConfigurationInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteHsmConfigurationOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDeleteHsmConfiguration, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DeleteHsmConfigurationInput{} } output = &DeleteHsmConfigurationOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(query.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // DeleteHsmConfiguration API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Deletes the specified Amazon Redshift HSM configuration. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation DeleteHsmConfiguration for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeInvalidHsmConfigurationStateFault "InvalidHsmConfigurationStateFault" // The specified HSM configuration is not in the available state, or it is still // in use by one or more Amazon Redshift clusters. // // * ErrCodeHsmConfigurationNotFoundFault "HsmConfigurationNotFoundFault" // There is no Amazon Redshift HSM configuration with the specified identifier. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DeleteHsmConfiguration func (c *Redshift) DeleteHsmConfiguration(input *DeleteHsmConfigurationInput) (*DeleteHsmConfigurationOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteHsmConfigurationRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DeleteHsmConfigurationWithContext is the same as DeleteHsmConfiguration with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DeleteHsmConfiguration for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DeleteHsmConfigurationWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteHsmConfigurationInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteHsmConfigurationOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteHsmConfigurationRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDeleteSnapshotCopyGrant = "DeleteSnapshotCopyGrant" // DeleteSnapshotCopyGrantRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DeleteSnapshotCopyGrant operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DeleteSnapshotCopyGrant for more information on using the DeleteSnapshotCopyGrant // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DeleteSnapshotCopyGrantRequest method. // req, resp := client.DeleteSnapshotCopyGrantRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DeleteSnapshotCopyGrant func (c *Redshift) DeleteSnapshotCopyGrantRequest(input *DeleteSnapshotCopyGrantInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteSnapshotCopyGrantOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDeleteSnapshotCopyGrant, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DeleteSnapshotCopyGrantInput{} } output = &DeleteSnapshotCopyGrantOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(query.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // DeleteSnapshotCopyGrant API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Deletes the specified snapshot copy grant. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation DeleteSnapshotCopyGrant for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeInvalidSnapshotCopyGrantStateFault "InvalidSnapshotCopyGrantStateFault" // The snapshot copy grant can't be deleted because it is used by one or more // clusters. // // * ErrCodeSnapshotCopyGrantNotFoundFault "SnapshotCopyGrantNotFoundFault" // The specified snapshot copy grant can't be found. Make sure that the name // is typed correctly and that the grant exists in the destination region. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DeleteSnapshotCopyGrant func (c *Redshift) DeleteSnapshotCopyGrant(input *DeleteSnapshotCopyGrantInput) (*DeleteSnapshotCopyGrantOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteSnapshotCopyGrantRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DeleteSnapshotCopyGrantWithContext is the same as DeleteSnapshotCopyGrant with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DeleteSnapshotCopyGrant for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DeleteSnapshotCopyGrantWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteSnapshotCopyGrantInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteSnapshotCopyGrantOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteSnapshotCopyGrantRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDeleteSnapshotSchedule = "DeleteSnapshotSchedule" // DeleteSnapshotScheduleRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DeleteSnapshotSchedule operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DeleteSnapshotSchedule for more information on using the DeleteSnapshotSchedule // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DeleteSnapshotScheduleRequest method. // req, resp := client.DeleteSnapshotScheduleRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DeleteSnapshotSchedule func (c *Redshift) DeleteSnapshotScheduleRequest(input *DeleteSnapshotScheduleInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteSnapshotScheduleOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDeleteSnapshotSchedule, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DeleteSnapshotScheduleInput{} } output = &DeleteSnapshotScheduleOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(query.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // DeleteSnapshotSchedule API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Deletes a snapshot schedule. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation DeleteSnapshotSchedule for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeInvalidClusterSnapshotScheduleStateFault "InvalidClusterSnapshotScheduleState" // The cluster snapshot schedule state is not valid. // // * ErrCodeSnapshotScheduleNotFoundFault "SnapshotScheduleNotFound" // We could not find the specified snapshot schedule. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DeleteSnapshotSchedule func (c *Redshift) DeleteSnapshotSchedule(input *DeleteSnapshotScheduleInput) (*DeleteSnapshotScheduleOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteSnapshotScheduleRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DeleteSnapshotScheduleWithContext is the same as DeleteSnapshotSchedule with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DeleteSnapshotSchedule for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DeleteSnapshotScheduleWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteSnapshotScheduleInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteSnapshotScheduleOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteSnapshotScheduleRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDeleteTags = "DeleteTags" // DeleteTagsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DeleteTags operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DeleteTags for more information on using the DeleteTags // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DeleteTagsRequest method. // req, resp := client.DeleteTagsRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DeleteTags func (c *Redshift) DeleteTagsRequest(input *DeleteTagsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteTagsOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDeleteTags, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DeleteTagsInput{} } output = &DeleteTagsOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(query.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // DeleteTags API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Deletes a tag or tags from a resource. You must provide the ARN of the resource // from which you want to delete the tag or tags. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation DeleteTags for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeResourceNotFoundFault "ResourceNotFoundFault" // The resource could not be found. // // * ErrCodeInvalidTagFault "InvalidTagFault" // The tag is invalid. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DeleteTags func (c *Redshift) DeleteTags(input *DeleteTagsInput) (*DeleteTagsOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteTagsRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DeleteTagsWithContext is the same as DeleteTags with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DeleteTags for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DeleteTagsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteTagsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteTagsOutput, error) { req, out := c.DeleteTagsRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDescribeAccountAttributes = "DescribeAccountAttributes" // DescribeAccountAttributesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DescribeAccountAttributes operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DescribeAccountAttributes for more information on using the DescribeAccountAttributes // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DescribeAccountAttributesRequest method. // req, resp := client.DescribeAccountAttributesRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeAccountAttributes func (c *Redshift) DescribeAccountAttributesRequest(input *DescribeAccountAttributesInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeAccountAttributesOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDescribeAccountAttributes, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DescribeAccountAttributesInput{} } output = &DescribeAccountAttributesOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // DescribeAccountAttributes API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Returns a list of attributes attached to an account // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation DescribeAccountAttributes for usage and error information. // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeAccountAttributes func (c *Redshift) DescribeAccountAttributes(input *DescribeAccountAttributesInput) (*DescribeAccountAttributesOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeAccountAttributesRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeAccountAttributesWithContext is the same as DescribeAccountAttributes with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DescribeAccountAttributes for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeAccountAttributesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeAccountAttributesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeAccountAttributesOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeAccountAttributesRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDescribeClusterDbRevisions = "DescribeClusterDbRevisions" // DescribeClusterDbRevisionsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DescribeClusterDbRevisions operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DescribeClusterDbRevisions for more information on using the DescribeClusterDbRevisions // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DescribeClusterDbRevisionsRequest method. // req, resp := client.DescribeClusterDbRevisionsRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeClusterDbRevisions func (c *Redshift) DescribeClusterDbRevisionsRequest(input *DescribeClusterDbRevisionsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeClusterDbRevisionsOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDescribeClusterDbRevisions, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DescribeClusterDbRevisionsInput{} } output = &DescribeClusterDbRevisionsOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // DescribeClusterDbRevisions API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Returns an array of ClusterDbRevision objects. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation DescribeClusterDbRevisions for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeClusterNotFoundFault "ClusterNotFound" // The ClusterIdentifier parameter does not refer to an existing cluster. // // * ErrCodeInvalidClusterStateFault "InvalidClusterState" // The specified cluster is not in the available state. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeClusterDbRevisions func (c *Redshift) DescribeClusterDbRevisions(input *DescribeClusterDbRevisionsInput) (*DescribeClusterDbRevisionsOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeClusterDbRevisionsRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeClusterDbRevisionsWithContext is the same as DescribeClusterDbRevisions with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DescribeClusterDbRevisions for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeClusterDbRevisionsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeClusterDbRevisionsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeClusterDbRevisionsOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeClusterDbRevisionsRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDescribeClusterParameterGroups = "DescribeClusterParameterGroups" // DescribeClusterParameterGroupsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DescribeClusterParameterGroups operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DescribeClusterParameterGroups for more information on using the DescribeClusterParameterGroups // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DescribeClusterParameterGroupsRequest method. // req, resp := client.DescribeClusterParameterGroupsRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeClusterParameterGroups func (c *Redshift) DescribeClusterParameterGroupsRequest(input *DescribeClusterParameterGroupsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeClusterParameterGroupsOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDescribeClusterParameterGroups, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxRecords", TruncationToken: "", }, } if input == nil { input = &DescribeClusterParameterGroupsInput{} } output = &DescribeClusterParameterGroupsOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // DescribeClusterParameterGroups API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Returns a list of Amazon Redshift parameter groups, including parameter groups // you created and the default parameter group. For each parameter group, the // response includes the parameter group name, description, and parameter group // family name. You can optionally specify a name to retrieve the description // of a specific parameter group. // // For more information about parameters and parameter groups, go to Amazon // Redshift Parameter Groups (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-parameter-groups.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // If you specify both tag keys and tag values in the same request, Amazon Redshift // returns all parameter groups that match any combination of the specified // keys and values. For example, if you have owner and environment for tag keys, // and admin and test for tag values, all parameter groups that have any combination // of those values are returned. // // If both tag keys and values are omitted from the request, parameter groups // are returned regardless of whether they have tag keys or values associated // with them. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation DescribeClusterParameterGroups for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeClusterParameterGroupNotFoundFault "ClusterParameterGroupNotFound" // The parameter group name does not refer to an existing parameter group. // // * ErrCodeInvalidTagFault "InvalidTagFault" // The tag is invalid. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeClusterParameterGroups func (c *Redshift) DescribeClusterParameterGroups(input *DescribeClusterParameterGroupsInput) (*DescribeClusterParameterGroupsOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeClusterParameterGroupsRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeClusterParameterGroupsWithContext is the same as DescribeClusterParameterGroups with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DescribeClusterParameterGroups for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeClusterParameterGroupsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeClusterParameterGroupsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeClusterParameterGroupsOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeClusterParameterGroupsRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeClusterParameterGroupsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeClusterParameterGroups operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See DescribeClusterParameterGroups method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeClusterParameterGroups operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.DescribeClusterParameterGroupsPages(params, // func(page *DescribeClusterParameterGroupsOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *Redshift) DescribeClusterParameterGroupsPages(input *DescribeClusterParameterGroupsInput, fn func(*DescribeClusterParameterGroupsOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.DescribeClusterParameterGroupsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // DescribeClusterParameterGroupsPagesWithContext same as DescribeClusterParameterGroupsPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeClusterParameterGroupsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeClusterParameterGroupsInput, fn func(*DescribeClusterParameterGroupsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *DescribeClusterParameterGroupsInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.DescribeClusterParameterGroupsRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeClusterParameterGroupsOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opDescribeClusterParameters = "DescribeClusterParameters" // DescribeClusterParametersRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DescribeClusterParameters operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DescribeClusterParameters for more information on using the DescribeClusterParameters // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DescribeClusterParametersRequest method. // req, resp := client.DescribeClusterParametersRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeClusterParameters func (c *Redshift) DescribeClusterParametersRequest(input *DescribeClusterParametersInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeClusterParametersOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDescribeClusterParameters, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxRecords", TruncationToken: "", }, } if input == nil { input = &DescribeClusterParametersInput{} } output = &DescribeClusterParametersOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // DescribeClusterParameters API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Returns a detailed list of parameters contained within the specified Amazon // Redshift parameter group. For each parameter the response includes information // such as parameter name, description, data type, value, whether the parameter // value is modifiable, and so on. // // You can specify source filter to retrieve parameters of only specific type. // For example, to retrieve parameters that were modified by a user action such // as from ModifyClusterParameterGroup, you can specify source equal to user. // // For more information about parameters and parameter groups, go to Amazon // Redshift Parameter Groups (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-parameter-groups.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation DescribeClusterParameters for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeClusterParameterGroupNotFoundFault "ClusterParameterGroupNotFound" // The parameter group name does not refer to an existing parameter group. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeClusterParameters func (c *Redshift) DescribeClusterParameters(input *DescribeClusterParametersInput) (*DescribeClusterParametersOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeClusterParametersRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeClusterParametersWithContext is the same as DescribeClusterParameters with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DescribeClusterParameters for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeClusterParametersWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeClusterParametersInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeClusterParametersOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeClusterParametersRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeClusterParametersPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeClusterParameters operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See DescribeClusterParameters method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeClusterParameters operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.DescribeClusterParametersPages(params, // func(page *DescribeClusterParametersOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *Redshift) DescribeClusterParametersPages(input *DescribeClusterParametersInput, fn func(*DescribeClusterParametersOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.DescribeClusterParametersPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // DescribeClusterParametersPagesWithContext same as DescribeClusterParametersPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeClusterParametersPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeClusterParametersInput, fn func(*DescribeClusterParametersOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *DescribeClusterParametersInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.DescribeClusterParametersRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeClusterParametersOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opDescribeClusterSecurityGroups = "DescribeClusterSecurityGroups" // DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DescribeClusterSecurityGroups operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DescribeClusterSecurityGroups for more information on using the DescribeClusterSecurityGroups // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsRequest method. // req, resp := client.DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeClusterSecurityGroups func (c *Redshift) DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsRequest(input *DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDescribeClusterSecurityGroups, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxRecords", TruncationToken: "", }, } if input == nil { input = &DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsInput{} } output = &DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // DescribeClusterSecurityGroups API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Returns information about Amazon Redshift security groups. If the name of // a security group is specified, the response will contain only information // about only that security group. // // For information about managing security groups, go to Amazon Redshift Cluster // Security Groups (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-security-groups.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // If you specify both tag keys and tag values in the same request, Amazon Redshift // returns all security groups that match any combination of the specified keys // and values. For example, if you have owner and environment for tag keys, // and admin and test for tag values, all security groups that have any combination // of those values are returned. // // If both tag keys and values are omitted from the request, security groups // are returned regardless of whether they have tag keys or values associated // with them. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation DescribeClusterSecurityGroups for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeClusterSecurityGroupNotFoundFault "ClusterSecurityGroupNotFound" // The cluster security group name does not refer to an existing cluster security // group. // // * ErrCodeInvalidTagFault "InvalidTagFault" // The tag is invalid. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeClusterSecurityGroups func (c *Redshift) DescribeClusterSecurityGroups(input *DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsInput) (*DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsWithContext is the same as DescribeClusterSecurityGroups with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DescribeClusterSecurityGroups for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeClusterSecurityGroups operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See DescribeClusterSecurityGroups method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeClusterSecurityGroups operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsPages(params, // func(page *DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *Redshift) DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsPages(input *DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsInput, fn func(*DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsPagesWithContext same as DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsInput, fn func(*DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opDescribeClusterSnapshots = "DescribeClusterSnapshots" // DescribeClusterSnapshotsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DescribeClusterSnapshots operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DescribeClusterSnapshots for more information on using the DescribeClusterSnapshots // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DescribeClusterSnapshotsRequest method. // req, resp := client.DescribeClusterSnapshotsRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeClusterSnapshots func (c *Redshift) DescribeClusterSnapshotsRequest(input *DescribeClusterSnapshotsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeClusterSnapshotsOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDescribeClusterSnapshots, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxRecords", TruncationToken: "", }, } if input == nil { input = &DescribeClusterSnapshotsInput{} } output = &DescribeClusterSnapshotsOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // DescribeClusterSnapshots API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Returns one or more snapshot objects, which contain metadata about your cluster // snapshots. By default, this operation returns information about all snapshots // of all clusters that are owned by you AWS customer account. No information // is returned for snapshots owned by inactive AWS customer accounts. // // If you specify both tag keys and tag values in the same request, Amazon Redshift // returns all snapshots that match any combination of the specified keys and // values. For example, if you have owner and environment for tag keys, and // admin and test for tag values, all snapshots that have any combination of // those values are returned. Only snapshots that you own are returned in the // response; shared snapshots are not returned with the tag key and tag value // request parameters. // // If both tag keys and values are omitted from the request, snapshots are returned // regardless of whether they have tag keys or values associated with them. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation DescribeClusterSnapshots for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeClusterNotFoundFault "ClusterNotFound" // The ClusterIdentifier parameter does not refer to an existing cluster. // // * ErrCodeClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault "ClusterSnapshotNotFound" // The snapshot identifier does not refer to an existing cluster snapshot. // // * ErrCodeInvalidTagFault "InvalidTagFault" // The tag is invalid. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeClusterSnapshots func (c *Redshift) DescribeClusterSnapshots(input *DescribeClusterSnapshotsInput) (*DescribeClusterSnapshotsOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeClusterSnapshotsRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeClusterSnapshotsWithContext is the same as DescribeClusterSnapshots with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DescribeClusterSnapshots for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeClusterSnapshotsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeClusterSnapshotsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeClusterSnapshotsOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeClusterSnapshotsRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeClusterSnapshotsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeClusterSnapshots operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See DescribeClusterSnapshots method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeClusterSnapshots operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.DescribeClusterSnapshotsPages(params, // func(page *DescribeClusterSnapshotsOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *Redshift) DescribeClusterSnapshotsPages(input *DescribeClusterSnapshotsInput, fn func(*DescribeClusterSnapshotsOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.DescribeClusterSnapshotsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // DescribeClusterSnapshotsPagesWithContext same as DescribeClusterSnapshotsPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeClusterSnapshotsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeClusterSnapshotsInput, fn func(*DescribeClusterSnapshotsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *DescribeClusterSnapshotsInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.DescribeClusterSnapshotsRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeClusterSnapshotsOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opDescribeClusterSubnetGroups = "DescribeClusterSubnetGroups" // DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DescribeClusterSubnetGroups operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DescribeClusterSubnetGroups for more information on using the DescribeClusterSubnetGroups // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsRequest method. // req, resp := client.DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeClusterSubnetGroups func (c *Redshift) DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsRequest(input *DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDescribeClusterSubnetGroups, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxRecords", TruncationToken: "", }, } if input == nil { input = &DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsInput{} } output = &DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // DescribeClusterSubnetGroups API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Returns one or more cluster subnet group objects, which contain metadata // about your cluster subnet groups. By default, this operation returns information // about all cluster subnet groups that are defined in you AWS account. // // If you specify both tag keys and tag values in the same request, Amazon Redshift // returns all subnet groups that match any combination of the specified keys // and values. For example, if you have owner and environment for tag keys, // and admin and test for tag values, all subnet groups that have any combination // of those values are returned. // // If both tag keys and values are omitted from the request, subnet groups are // returned regardless of whether they have tag keys or values associated with // them. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation DescribeClusterSubnetGroups for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeClusterSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "ClusterSubnetGroupNotFoundFault" // The cluster subnet group name does not refer to an existing cluster subnet // group. // // * ErrCodeInvalidTagFault "InvalidTagFault" // The tag is invalid. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeClusterSubnetGroups func (c *Redshift) DescribeClusterSubnetGroups(input *DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsInput) (*DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsWithContext is the same as DescribeClusterSubnetGroups with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DescribeClusterSubnetGroups for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeClusterSubnetGroups operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See DescribeClusterSubnetGroups method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeClusterSubnetGroups operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsPages(params, // func(page *DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *Redshift) DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsPages(input *DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsInput, fn func(*DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsPagesWithContext same as DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsInput, fn func(*DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opDescribeClusterTracks = "DescribeClusterTracks" // DescribeClusterTracksRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DescribeClusterTracks operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DescribeClusterTracks for more information on using the DescribeClusterTracks // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DescribeClusterTracksRequest method. // req, resp := client.DescribeClusterTracksRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeClusterTracks func (c *Redshift) DescribeClusterTracksRequest(input *DescribeClusterTracksInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeClusterTracksOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDescribeClusterTracks, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DescribeClusterTracksInput{} } output = &DescribeClusterTracksOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // DescribeClusterTracks API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Returns a list of all the available maintenance tracks. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation DescribeClusterTracks for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeInvalidClusterTrackFault "InvalidClusterTrack" // The provided cluster track name is not valid. // // * ErrCodeUnauthorizedOperation "UnauthorizedOperation" // Your account is not authorized to perform the requested operation. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeClusterTracks func (c *Redshift) DescribeClusterTracks(input *DescribeClusterTracksInput) (*DescribeClusterTracksOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeClusterTracksRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeClusterTracksWithContext is the same as DescribeClusterTracks with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DescribeClusterTracks for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeClusterTracksWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeClusterTracksInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeClusterTracksOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeClusterTracksRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDescribeClusterVersions = "DescribeClusterVersions" // DescribeClusterVersionsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DescribeClusterVersions operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DescribeClusterVersions for more information on using the DescribeClusterVersions // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DescribeClusterVersionsRequest method. // req, resp := client.DescribeClusterVersionsRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeClusterVersions func (c *Redshift) DescribeClusterVersionsRequest(input *DescribeClusterVersionsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeClusterVersionsOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDescribeClusterVersions, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxRecords", TruncationToken: "", }, } if input == nil { input = &DescribeClusterVersionsInput{} } output = &DescribeClusterVersionsOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // DescribeClusterVersions API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Returns descriptions of the available Amazon Redshift cluster versions. You // can call this operation even before creating any clusters to learn more about // the Amazon Redshift versions. For more information about managing clusters, // go to Amazon Redshift Clusters (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-clusters.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation DescribeClusterVersions for usage and error information. // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeClusterVersions func (c *Redshift) DescribeClusterVersions(input *DescribeClusterVersionsInput) (*DescribeClusterVersionsOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeClusterVersionsRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeClusterVersionsWithContext is the same as DescribeClusterVersions with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DescribeClusterVersions for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeClusterVersionsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeClusterVersionsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeClusterVersionsOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeClusterVersionsRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeClusterVersionsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeClusterVersions operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See DescribeClusterVersions method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeClusterVersions operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.DescribeClusterVersionsPages(params, // func(page *DescribeClusterVersionsOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *Redshift) DescribeClusterVersionsPages(input *DescribeClusterVersionsInput, fn func(*DescribeClusterVersionsOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.DescribeClusterVersionsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // DescribeClusterVersionsPagesWithContext same as DescribeClusterVersionsPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeClusterVersionsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeClusterVersionsInput, fn func(*DescribeClusterVersionsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *DescribeClusterVersionsInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.DescribeClusterVersionsRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeClusterVersionsOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opDescribeClusters = "DescribeClusters" // DescribeClustersRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DescribeClusters operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DescribeClusters for more information on using the DescribeClusters // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DescribeClustersRequest method. // req, resp := client.DescribeClustersRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeClusters func (c *Redshift) DescribeClustersRequest(input *DescribeClustersInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeClustersOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDescribeClusters, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxRecords", TruncationToken: "", }, } if input == nil { input = &DescribeClustersInput{} } output = &DescribeClustersOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // DescribeClusters API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Returns properties of provisioned clusters including general cluster properties, // cluster database properties, maintenance and backup properties, and security // and access properties. This operation supports pagination. For more information // about managing clusters, go to Amazon Redshift Clusters (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-clusters.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // If you specify both tag keys and tag values in the same request, Amazon Redshift // returns all clusters that match any combination of the specified keys and // values. For example, if you have owner and environment for tag keys, and // admin and test for tag values, all clusters that have any combination of // those values are returned. // // If both tag keys and values are omitted from the request, clusters are returned // regardless of whether they have tag keys or values associated with them. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation DescribeClusters for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeClusterNotFoundFault "ClusterNotFound" // The ClusterIdentifier parameter does not refer to an existing cluster. // // * ErrCodeInvalidTagFault "InvalidTagFault" // The tag is invalid. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeClusters func (c *Redshift) DescribeClusters(input *DescribeClustersInput) (*DescribeClustersOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeClustersRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeClustersWithContext is the same as DescribeClusters with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DescribeClusters for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeClustersWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeClustersInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeClustersOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeClustersRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeClustersPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeClusters operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See DescribeClusters method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeClusters operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.DescribeClustersPages(params, // func(page *DescribeClustersOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *Redshift) DescribeClustersPages(input *DescribeClustersInput, fn func(*DescribeClustersOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.DescribeClustersPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // DescribeClustersPagesWithContext same as DescribeClustersPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeClustersPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeClustersInput, fn func(*DescribeClustersOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *DescribeClustersInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.DescribeClustersRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeClustersOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opDescribeDefaultClusterParameters = "DescribeDefaultClusterParameters" // DescribeDefaultClusterParametersRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DescribeDefaultClusterParameters operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DescribeDefaultClusterParameters for more information on using the DescribeDefaultClusterParameters // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DescribeDefaultClusterParametersRequest method. // req, resp := client.DescribeDefaultClusterParametersRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeDefaultClusterParameters func (c *Redshift) DescribeDefaultClusterParametersRequest(input *DescribeDefaultClusterParametersInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDefaultClusterParametersOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDescribeDefaultClusterParameters, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"DefaultClusterParameters.Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxRecords", TruncationToken: "", }, } if input == nil { input = &DescribeDefaultClusterParametersInput{} } output = &DescribeDefaultClusterParametersOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // DescribeDefaultClusterParameters API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Returns a list of parameter settings for the specified parameter group family. // // For more information about parameters and parameter groups, go to Amazon // Redshift Parameter Groups (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-parameter-groups.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation DescribeDefaultClusterParameters for usage and error information. // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeDefaultClusterParameters func (c *Redshift) DescribeDefaultClusterParameters(input *DescribeDefaultClusterParametersInput) (*DescribeDefaultClusterParametersOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeDefaultClusterParametersRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeDefaultClusterParametersWithContext is the same as DescribeDefaultClusterParameters with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DescribeDefaultClusterParameters for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeDefaultClusterParametersWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDefaultClusterParametersInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDefaultClusterParametersOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeDefaultClusterParametersRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeDefaultClusterParametersPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeDefaultClusterParameters operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See DescribeDefaultClusterParameters method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeDefaultClusterParameters operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.DescribeDefaultClusterParametersPages(params, // func(page *DescribeDefaultClusterParametersOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *Redshift) DescribeDefaultClusterParametersPages(input *DescribeDefaultClusterParametersInput, fn func(*DescribeDefaultClusterParametersOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.DescribeDefaultClusterParametersPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // DescribeDefaultClusterParametersPagesWithContext same as DescribeDefaultClusterParametersPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeDefaultClusterParametersPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDefaultClusterParametersInput, fn func(*DescribeDefaultClusterParametersOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *DescribeDefaultClusterParametersInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.DescribeDefaultClusterParametersRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeDefaultClusterParametersOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opDescribeEventCategories = "DescribeEventCategories" // DescribeEventCategoriesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DescribeEventCategories operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DescribeEventCategories for more information on using the DescribeEventCategories // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DescribeEventCategoriesRequest method. // req, resp := client.DescribeEventCategoriesRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeEventCategories func (c *Redshift) DescribeEventCategoriesRequest(input *DescribeEventCategoriesInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeEventCategoriesOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDescribeEventCategories, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DescribeEventCategoriesInput{} } output = &DescribeEventCategoriesOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // DescribeEventCategories API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Displays a list of event categories for all event source types, or for a // specified source type. For a list of the event categories and source types, // go to Amazon Redshift Event Notifications (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-event-notifications.html). // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation DescribeEventCategories for usage and error information. // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeEventCategories func (c *Redshift) DescribeEventCategories(input *DescribeEventCategoriesInput) (*DescribeEventCategoriesOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeEventCategoriesRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeEventCategoriesWithContext is the same as DescribeEventCategories with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DescribeEventCategories for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeEventCategoriesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeEventCategoriesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeEventCategoriesOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeEventCategoriesRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDescribeEventSubscriptions = "DescribeEventSubscriptions" // DescribeEventSubscriptionsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DescribeEventSubscriptions operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DescribeEventSubscriptions for more information on using the DescribeEventSubscriptions // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DescribeEventSubscriptionsRequest method. // req, resp := client.DescribeEventSubscriptionsRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeEventSubscriptions func (c *Redshift) DescribeEventSubscriptionsRequest(input *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDescribeEventSubscriptions, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxRecords", TruncationToken: "", }, } if input == nil { input = &DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput{} } output = &DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // DescribeEventSubscriptions API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Lists descriptions of all the Amazon Redshift event notification subscriptions // for a customer account. If you specify a subscription name, lists the description // for that subscription. // // If you specify both tag keys and tag values in the same request, Amazon Redshift // returns all event notification subscriptions that match any combination of // the specified keys and values. For example, if you have owner and environment // for tag keys, and admin and test for tag values, all subscriptions that have // any combination of those values are returned. // // If both tag keys and values are omitted from the request, subscriptions are // returned regardless of whether they have tag keys or values associated with // them. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation DescribeEventSubscriptions for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeSubscriptionNotFoundFault "SubscriptionNotFound" // An Amazon Redshift event notification subscription with the specified name // does not exist. // // * ErrCodeInvalidTagFault "InvalidTagFault" // The tag is invalid. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeEventSubscriptions func (c *Redshift) DescribeEventSubscriptions(input *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput) (*DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeEventSubscriptionsRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeEventSubscriptionsWithContext is the same as DescribeEventSubscriptions with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DescribeEventSubscriptions for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeEventSubscriptionsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeEventSubscriptionsRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeEventSubscriptionsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeEventSubscriptions operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See DescribeEventSubscriptions method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeEventSubscriptions operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.DescribeEventSubscriptionsPages(params, // func(page *DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *Redshift) DescribeEventSubscriptionsPages(input *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput, fn func(*DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.DescribeEventSubscriptionsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // DescribeEventSubscriptionsPagesWithContext same as DescribeEventSubscriptionsPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeEventSubscriptionsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput, fn func(*DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.DescribeEventSubscriptionsRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opDescribeEvents = "DescribeEvents" // DescribeEventsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DescribeEvents operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DescribeEvents for more information on using the DescribeEvents // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DescribeEventsRequest method. // req, resp := client.DescribeEventsRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeEvents func (c *Redshift) DescribeEventsRequest(input *DescribeEventsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeEventsOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDescribeEvents, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxRecords", TruncationToken: "", }, } if input == nil { input = &DescribeEventsInput{} } output = &DescribeEventsOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // DescribeEvents API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Returns events related to clusters, security groups, snapshots, and parameter // groups for the past 14 days. Events specific to a particular cluster, security // group, snapshot or parameter group can be obtained by providing the name // as a parameter. By default, the past hour of events are returned. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation DescribeEvents for usage and error information. // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeEvents func (c *Redshift) DescribeEvents(input *DescribeEventsInput) (*DescribeEventsOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeEventsRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeEventsWithContext is the same as DescribeEvents with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DescribeEvents for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeEventsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeEventsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeEventsOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeEventsRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeEventsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeEvents operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See DescribeEvents method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeEvents operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.DescribeEventsPages(params, // func(page *DescribeEventsOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *Redshift) DescribeEventsPages(input *DescribeEventsInput, fn func(*DescribeEventsOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.DescribeEventsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // DescribeEventsPagesWithContext same as DescribeEventsPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeEventsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeEventsInput, fn func(*DescribeEventsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *DescribeEventsInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.DescribeEventsRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeEventsOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opDescribeHsmClientCertificates = "DescribeHsmClientCertificates" // DescribeHsmClientCertificatesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DescribeHsmClientCertificates operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DescribeHsmClientCertificates for more information on using the DescribeHsmClientCertificates // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DescribeHsmClientCertificatesRequest method. // req, resp := client.DescribeHsmClientCertificatesRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeHsmClientCertificates func (c *Redshift) DescribeHsmClientCertificatesRequest(input *DescribeHsmClientCertificatesInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeHsmClientCertificatesOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDescribeHsmClientCertificates, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxRecords", TruncationToken: "", }, } if input == nil { input = &DescribeHsmClientCertificatesInput{} } output = &DescribeHsmClientCertificatesOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // DescribeHsmClientCertificates API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Returns information about the specified HSM client certificate. If no certificate // ID is specified, returns information about all the HSM certificates owned // by your AWS customer account. // // If you specify both tag keys and tag values in the same request, Amazon Redshift // returns all HSM client certificates that match any combination of the specified // keys and values. For example, if you have owner and environment for tag keys, // and admin and test for tag values, all HSM client certificates that have // any combination of those values are returned. // // If both tag keys and values are omitted from the request, HSM client certificates // are returned regardless of whether they have tag keys or values associated // with them. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation DescribeHsmClientCertificates for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeHsmClientCertificateNotFoundFault "HsmClientCertificateNotFoundFault" // There is no Amazon Redshift HSM client certificate with the specified identifier. // // * ErrCodeInvalidTagFault "InvalidTagFault" // The tag is invalid. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeHsmClientCertificates func (c *Redshift) DescribeHsmClientCertificates(input *DescribeHsmClientCertificatesInput) (*DescribeHsmClientCertificatesOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeHsmClientCertificatesRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeHsmClientCertificatesWithContext is the same as DescribeHsmClientCertificates with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DescribeHsmClientCertificates for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeHsmClientCertificatesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeHsmClientCertificatesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeHsmClientCertificatesOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeHsmClientCertificatesRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeHsmClientCertificatesPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeHsmClientCertificates operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See DescribeHsmClientCertificates method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeHsmClientCertificates operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.DescribeHsmClientCertificatesPages(params, // func(page *DescribeHsmClientCertificatesOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *Redshift) DescribeHsmClientCertificatesPages(input *DescribeHsmClientCertificatesInput, fn func(*DescribeHsmClientCertificatesOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.DescribeHsmClientCertificatesPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // DescribeHsmClientCertificatesPagesWithContext same as DescribeHsmClientCertificatesPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeHsmClientCertificatesPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeHsmClientCertificatesInput, fn func(*DescribeHsmClientCertificatesOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *DescribeHsmClientCertificatesInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.DescribeHsmClientCertificatesRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeHsmClientCertificatesOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opDescribeHsmConfigurations = "DescribeHsmConfigurations" // DescribeHsmConfigurationsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DescribeHsmConfigurations operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DescribeHsmConfigurations for more information on using the DescribeHsmConfigurations // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DescribeHsmConfigurationsRequest method. // req, resp := client.DescribeHsmConfigurationsRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeHsmConfigurations func (c *Redshift) DescribeHsmConfigurationsRequest(input *DescribeHsmConfigurationsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeHsmConfigurationsOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDescribeHsmConfigurations, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxRecords", TruncationToken: "", }, } if input == nil { input = &DescribeHsmConfigurationsInput{} } output = &DescribeHsmConfigurationsOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // DescribeHsmConfigurations API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Returns information about the specified Amazon Redshift HSM configuration. // If no configuration ID is specified, returns information about all the HSM // configurations owned by your AWS customer account. // // If you specify both tag keys and tag values in the same request, Amazon Redshift // returns all HSM connections that match any combination of the specified keys // and values. For example, if you have owner and environment for tag keys, // and admin and test for tag values, all HSM connections that have any combination // of those values are returned. // // If both tag keys and values are omitted from the request, HSM connections // are returned regardless of whether they have tag keys or values associated // with them. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation DescribeHsmConfigurations for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeHsmConfigurationNotFoundFault "HsmConfigurationNotFoundFault" // There is no Amazon Redshift HSM configuration with the specified identifier. // // * ErrCodeInvalidTagFault "InvalidTagFault" // The tag is invalid. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeHsmConfigurations func (c *Redshift) DescribeHsmConfigurations(input *DescribeHsmConfigurationsInput) (*DescribeHsmConfigurationsOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeHsmConfigurationsRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeHsmConfigurationsWithContext is the same as DescribeHsmConfigurations with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DescribeHsmConfigurations for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeHsmConfigurationsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeHsmConfigurationsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeHsmConfigurationsOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeHsmConfigurationsRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeHsmConfigurationsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeHsmConfigurations operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See DescribeHsmConfigurations method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeHsmConfigurations operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.DescribeHsmConfigurationsPages(params, // func(page *DescribeHsmConfigurationsOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *Redshift) DescribeHsmConfigurationsPages(input *DescribeHsmConfigurationsInput, fn func(*DescribeHsmConfigurationsOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.DescribeHsmConfigurationsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // DescribeHsmConfigurationsPagesWithContext same as DescribeHsmConfigurationsPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeHsmConfigurationsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeHsmConfigurationsInput, fn func(*DescribeHsmConfigurationsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *DescribeHsmConfigurationsInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.DescribeHsmConfigurationsRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeHsmConfigurationsOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opDescribeLoggingStatus = "DescribeLoggingStatus" // DescribeLoggingStatusRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DescribeLoggingStatus operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DescribeLoggingStatus for more information on using the DescribeLoggingStatus // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DescribeLoggingStatusRequest method. // req, resp := client.DescribeLoggingStatusRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeLoggingStatus func (c *Redshift) DescribeLoggingStatusRequest(input *DescribeLoggingStatusInput) (req *request.Request, output *LoggingStatus) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDescribeLoggingStatus, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DescribeLoggingStatusInput{} } output = &LoggingStatus{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // DescribeLoggingStatus API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Describes whether information, such as queries and connection attempts, is // being logged for the specified Amazon Redshift cluster. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation DescribeLoggingStatus for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeClusterNotFoundFault "ClusterNotFound" // The ClusterIdentifier parameter does not refer to an existing cluster. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeLoggingStatus func (c *Redshift) DescribeLoggingStatus(input *DescribeLoggingStatusInput) (*LoggingStatus, error) { req, out := c.DescribeLoggingStatusRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeLoggingStatusWithContext is the same as DescribeLoggingStatus with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DescribeLoggingStatus for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeLoggingStatusWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeLoggingStatusInput, opts ...request.Option) (*LoggingStatus, error) { req, out := c.DescribeLoggingStatusRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDescribeOrderableClusterOptions = "DescribeOrderableClusterOptions" // DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DescribeOrderableClusterOptions operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DescribeOrderableClusterOptions for more information on using the DescribeOrderableClusterOptions // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsRequest method. // req, resp := client.DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeOrderableClusterOptions func (c *Redshift) DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsRequest(input *DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDescribeOrderableClusterOptions, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxRecords", TruncationToken: "", }, } if input == nil { input = &DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsInput{} } output = &DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // DescribeOrderableClusterOptions API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Returns a list of orderable cluster options. Before you create a new cluster // you can use this operation to find what options are available, such as the // EC2 Availability Zones (AZ) in the specific AWS Region that you can specify, // and the node types you can request. The node types differ by available storage, // memory, CPU and price. With the cost involved you might want to obtain a // list of cluster options in the specific region and specify values when creating // a cluster. For more information about managing clusters, go to Amazon Redshift // Clusters (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-clusters.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation DescribeOrderableClusterOptions for usage and error information. // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeOrderableClusterOptions func (c *Redshift) DescribeOrderableClusterOptions(input *DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsInput) (*DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsWithContext is the same as DescribeOrderableClusterOptions with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DescribeOrderableClusterOptions for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeOrderableClusterOptions operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See DescribeOrderableClusterOptions method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeOrderableClusterOptions operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsPages(params, // func(page *DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *Redshift) DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsPages(input *DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsInput, fn func(*DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsPagesWithContext same as DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsInput, fn func(*DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opDescribeReservedNodeOfferings = "DescribeReservedNodeOfferings" // DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DescribeReservedNodeOfferings operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DescribeReservedNodeOfferings for more information on using the DescribeReservedNodeOfferings // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsRequest method. // req, resp := client.DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeReservedNodeOfferings func (c *Redshift) DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsRequest(input *DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDescribeReservedNodeOfferings, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxRecords", TruncationToken: "", }, } if input == nil { input = &DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsInput{} } output = &DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // DescribeReservedNodeOfferings API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Returns a list of the available reserved node offerings by Amazon Redshift // with their descriptions including the node type, the fixed and recurring // costs of reserving the node and duration the node will be reserved for you. // These descriptions help you determine which reserve node offering you want // to purchase. You then use the unique offering ID in you call to PurchaseReservedNodeOffering // to reserve one or more nodes for your Amazon Redshift cluster. // // For more information about reserved node offerings, go to Purchasing Reserved // Nodes (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/purchase-reserved-node-instance.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation DescribeReservedNodeOfferings for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeReservedNodeOfferingNotFoundFault "ReservedNodeOfferingNotFound" // Specified offering does not exist. // // * ErrCodeUnsupportedOperationFault "UnsupportedOperation" // The requested operation isn't supported. // // * ErrCodeDependentServiceUnavailableFault "DependentServiceUnavailableFault" // Your request cannot be completed because a dependent internal service is // temporarily unavailable. Wait 30 to 60 seconds and try again. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeReservedNodeOfferings func (c *Redshift) DescribeReservedNodeOfferings(input *DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsInput) (*DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsWithContext is the same as DescribeReservedNodeOfferings with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DescribeReservedNodeOfferings for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeReservedNodeOfferings operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See DescribeReservedNodeOfferings method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeReservedNodeOfferings operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsPages(params, // func(page *DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *Redshift) DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsPages(input *DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsInput, fn func(*DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsPagesWithContext same as DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsInput, fn func(*DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opDescribeReservedNodes = "DescribeReservedNodes" // DescribeReservedNodesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DescribeReservedNodes operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DescribeReservedNodes for more information on using the DescribeReservedNodes // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DescribeReservedNodesRequest method. // req, resp := client.DescribeReservedNodesRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeReservedNodes func (c *Redshift) DescribeReservedNodesRequest(input *DescribeReservedNodesInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeReservedNodesOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDescribeReservedNodes, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", Paginator: &request.Paginator{ InputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, OutputTokens: []string{"Marker"}, LimitToken: "MaxRecords", TruncationToken: "", }, } if input == nil { input = &DescribeReservedNodesInput{} } output = &DescribeReservedNodesOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // DescribeReservedNodes API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Returns the descriptions of the reserved nodes. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation DescribeReservedNodes for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeReservedNodeNotFoundFault "ReservedNodeNotFound" // The specified reserved compute node not found. // // * ErrCodeDependentServiceUnavailableFault "DependentServiceUnavailableFault" // Your request cannot be completed because a dependent internal service is // temporarily unavailable. Wait 30 to 60 seconds and try again. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeReservedNodes func (c *Redshift) DescribeReservedNodes(input *DescribeReservedNodesInput) (*DescribeReservedNodesOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeReservedNodesRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeReservedNodesWithContext is the same as DescribeReservedNodes with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DescribeReservedNodes for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeReservedNodesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeReservedNodesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeReservedNodesOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeReservedNodesRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeReservedNodesPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeReservedNodes operation, // calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop // iterating, return false from the fn function. // // See DescribeReservedNodes method for more information on how to use this operation. // // Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service. // // // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeReservedNodes operation. // pageNum := 0 // err := client.DescribeReservedNodesPages(params, // func(page *DescribeReservedNodesOutput, lastPage bool) bool { // pageNum++ // fmt.Println(page) // return pageNum <= 3 // }) // func (c *Redshift) DescribeReservedNodesPages(input *DescribeReservedNodesInput, fn func(*DescribeReservedNodesOutput, bool) bool) error { return c.DescribeReservedNodesPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn) } // DescribeReservedNodesPagesWithContext same as DescribeReservedNodesPages except // it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeReservedNodesPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeReservedNodesInput, fn func(*DescribeReservedNodesOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error { p := request.Pagination{ NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) { var inCpy *DescribeReservedNodesInput if input != nil { tmp := *input inCpy = &tmp } req, _ := c.DescribeReservedNodesRequest(inCpy) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return req, nil }, } cont := true for p.Next() && cont { cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeReservedNodesOutput), !p.HasNextPage()) } return p.Err() } const opDescribeResize = "DescribeResize" // DescribeResizeRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DescribeResize operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DescribeResize for more information on using the DescribeResize // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DescribeResizeRequest method. // req, resp := client.DescribeResizeRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeResize func (c *Redshift) DescribeResizeRequest(input *DescribeResizeInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeResizeOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDescribeResize, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DescribeResizeInput{} } output = &DescribeResizeOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // DescribeResize API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Returns information about the last resize operation for the specified cluster. // If no resize operation has ever been initiated for the specified cluster, // a HTTP 404 error is returned. If a resize operation was initiated and completed, // the status of the resize remains as SUCCEEDED until the next resize. // // A resize operation can be requested using ModifyCluster and specifying a // different number or type of nodes for the cluster. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation DescribeResize for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeClusterNotFoundFault "ClusterNotFound" // The ClusterIdentifier parameter does not refer to an existing cluster. // // * ErrCodeResizeNotFoundFault "ResizeNotFound" // A resize operation for the specified cluster is not found. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeResize func (c *Redshift) DescribeResize(input *DescribeResizeInput) (*DescribeResizeOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeResizeRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeResizeWithContext is the same as DescribeResize with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DescribeResize for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeResizeWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeResizeInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeResizeOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeResizeRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDescribeSnapshotCopyGrants = "DescribeSnapshotCopyGrants" // DescribeSnapshotCopyGrantsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DescribeSnapshotCopyGrants operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DescribeSnapshotCopyGrants for more information on using the DescribeSnapshotCopyGrants // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DescribeSnapshotCopyGrantsRequest method. // req, resp := client.DescribeSnapshotCopyGrantsRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeSnapshotCopyGrants func (c *Redshift) DescribeSnapshotCopyGrantsRequest(input *DescribeSnapshotCopyGrantsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeSnapshotCopyGrantsOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDescribeSnapshotCopyGrants, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DescribeSnapshotCopyGrantsInput{} } output = &DescribeSnapshotCopyGrantsOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // DescribeSnapshotCopyGrants API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Returns a list of snapshot copy grants owned by the AWS account in the destination // region. // // For more information about managing snapshot copy grants, go to Amazon Redshift // Database Encryption (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-db-encryption.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation DescribeSnapshotCopyGrants for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeSnapshotCopyGrantNotFoundFault "SnapshotCopyGrantNotFoundFault" // The specified snapshot copy grant can't be found. Make sure that the name // is typed correctly and that the grant exists in the destination region. // // * ErrCodeInvalidTagFault "InvalidTagFault" // The tag is invalid. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeSnapshotCopyGrants func (c *Redshift) DescribeSnapshotCopyGrants(input *DescribeSnapshotCopyGrantsInput) (*DescribeSnapshotCopyGrantsOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeSnapshotCopyGrantsRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeSnapshotCopyGrantsWithContext is the same as DescribeSnapshotCopyGrants with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DescribeSnapshotCopyGrants for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeSnapshotCopyGrantsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeSnapshotCopyGrantsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeSnapshotCopyGrantsOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeSnapshotCopyGrantsRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDescribeSnapshotSchedules = "DescribeSnapshotSchedules" // DescribeSnapshotSchedulesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DescribeSnapshotSchedules operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DescribeSnapshotSchedules for more information on using the DescribeSnapshotSchedules // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DescribeSnapshotSchedulesRequest method. // req, resp := client.DescribeSnapshotSchedulesRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeSnapshotSchedules func (c *Redshift) DescribeSnapshotSchedulesRequest(input *DescribeSnapshotSchedulesInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeSnapshotSchedulesOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDescribeSnapshotSchedules, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DescribeSnapshotSchedulesInput{} } output = &DescribeSnapshotSchedulesOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // DescribeSnapshotSchedules API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Returns a list of snapshot schedules. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation DescribeSnapshotSchedules for usage and error information. // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeSnapshotSchedules func (c *Redshift) DescribeSnapshotSchedules(input *DescribeSnapshotSchedulesInput) (*DescribeSnapshotSchedulesOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeSnapshotSchedulesRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeSnapshotSchedulesWithContext is the same as DescribeSnapshotSchedules with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DescribeSnapshotSchedules for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeSnapshotSchedulesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeSnapshotSchedulesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeSnapshotSchedulesOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeSnapshotSchedulesRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDescribeStorage = "DescribeStorage" // DescribeStorageRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DescribeStorage operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DescribeStorage for more information on using the DescribeStorage // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DescribeStorageRequest method. // req, resp := client.DescribeStorageRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeStorage func (c *Redshift) DescribeStorageRequest(input *DescribeStorageInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeStorageOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDescribeStorage, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DescribeStorageInput{} } output = &DescribeStorageOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // DescribeStorage API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Returns the total amount of snapshot usage and provisioned storage for a // user in megabytes. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation DescribeStorage for usage and error information. // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeStorage func (c *Redshift) DescribeStorage(input *DescribeStorageInput) (*DescribeStorageOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeStorageRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeStorageWithContext is the same as DescribeStorage with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DescribeStorage for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeStorageWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeStorageInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeStorageOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeStorageRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDescribeTableRestoreStatus = "DescribeTableRestoreStatus" // DescribeTableRestoreStatusRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DescribeTableRestoreStatus operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DescribeTableRestoreStatus for more information on using the DescribeTableRestoreStatus // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DescribeTableRestoreStatusRequest method. // req, resp := client.DescribeTableRestoreStatusRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeTableRestoreStatus func (c *Redshift) DescribeTableRestoreStatusRequest(input *DescribeTableRestoreStatusInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeTableRestoreStatusOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDescribeTableRestoreStatus, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DescribeTableRestoreStatusInput{} } output = &DescribeTableRestoreStatusOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // DescribeTableRestoreStatus API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Lists the status of one or more table restore requests made using the RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshot // API action. If you don't specify a value for the TableRestoreRequestId parameter, // then DescribeTableRestoreStatus returns the status of all table restore requests // ordered by the date and time of the request in ascending order. Otherwise // DescribeTableRestoreStatus returns the status of the table specified by TableRestoreRequestId. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation DescribeTableRestoreStatus for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeTableRestoreNotFoundFault "TableRestoreNotFoundFault" // The specified TableRestoreRequestId value was not found. // // * ErrCodeClusterNotFoundFault "ClusterNotFound" // The ClusterIdentifier parameter does not refer to an existing cluster. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeTableRestoreStatus func (c *Redshift) DescribeTableRestoreStatus(input *DescribeTableRestoreStatusInput) (*DescribeTableRestoreStatusOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeTableRestoreStatusRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeTableRestoreStatusWithContext is the same as DescribeTableRestoreStatus with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DescribeTableRestoreStatus for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeTableRestoreStatusWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeTableRestoreStatusInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeTableRestoreStatusOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeTableRestoreStatusRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDescribeTags = "DescribeTags" // DescribeTagsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DescribeTags operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DescribeTags for more information on using the DescribeTags // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DescribeTagsRequest method. // req, resp := client.DescribeTagsRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeTags func (c *Redshift) DescribeTagsRequest(input *DescribeTagsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeTagsOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDescribeTags, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DescribeTagsInput{} } output = &DescribeTagsOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // DescribeTags API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Returns a list of tags. You can return tags from a specific resource by specifying // an ARN, or you can return all tags for a given type of resource, such as // clusters, snapshots, and so on. // // The following are limitations for DescribeTags: // // * You cannot specify an ARN and a resource-type value together in the // same request. // // * You cannot use the MaxRecords and Marker parameters together with the // ARN parameter. // // * The MaxRecords parameter can be a range from 10 to 50 results to return // in a request. // // If you specify both tag keys and tag values in the same request, Amazon Redshift // returns all resources that match any combination of the specified keys and // values. For example, if you have owner and environment for tag keys, and // admin and test for tag values, all resources that have any combination of // those values are returned. // // If both tag keys and values are omitted from the request, resources are returned // regardless of whether they have tag keys or values associated with them. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation DescribeTags for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeResourceNotFoundFault "ResourceNotFoundFault" // The resource could not be found. // // * ErrCodeInvalidTagFault "InvalidTagFault" // The tag is invalid. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DescribeTags func (c *Redshift) DescribeTags(input *DescribeTagsInput) (*DescribeTagsOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeTagsRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DescribeTagsWithContext is the same as DescribeTags with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DescribeTags for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DescribeTagsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeTagsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeTagsOutput, error) { req, out := c.DescribeTagsRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDisableLogging = "DisableLogging" // DisableLoggingRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DisableLogging operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DisableLogging for more information on using the DisableLogging // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DisableLoggingRequest method. // req, resp := client.DisableLoggingRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DisableLogging func (c *Redshift) DisableLoggingRequest(input *DisableLoggingInput) (req *request.Request, output *LoggingStatus) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDisableLogging, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DisableLoggingInput{} } output = &LoggingStatus{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // DisableLogging API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Stops logging information, such as queries and connection attempts, for the // specified Amazon Redshift cluster. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation DisableLogging for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeClusterNotFoundFault "ClusterNotFound" // The ClusterIdentifier parameter does not refer to an existing cluster. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DisableLogging func (c *Redshift) DisableLogging(input *DisableLoggingInput) (*LoggingStatus, error) { req, out := c.DisableLoggingRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DisableLoggingWithContext is the same as DisableLogging with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DisableLogging for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DisableLoggingWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DisableLoggingInput, opts ...request.Option) (*LoggingStatus, error) { req, out := c.DisableLoggingRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opDisableSnapshotCopy = "DisableSnapshotCopy" // DisableSnapshotCopyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the DisableSnapshotCopy operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See DisableSnapshotCopy for more information on using the DisableSnapshotCopy // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the DisableSnapshotCopyRequest method. // req, resp := client.DisableSnapshotCopyRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DisableSnapshotCopy func (c *Redshift) DisableSnapshotCopyRequest(input *DisableSnapshotCopyInput) (req *request.Request, output *DisableSnapshotCopyOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opDisableSnapshotCopy, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &DisableSnapshotCopyInput{} } output = &DisableSnapshotCopyOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // DisableSnapshotCopy API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Disables the automatic copying of snapshots from one region to another region // for a specified cluster. // // If your cluster and its snapshots are encrypted using a customer master key // (CMK) from AWS KMS, use DeleteSnapshotCopyGrant to delete the grant that // grants Amazon Redshift permission to the CMK in the destination region. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation DisableSnapshotCopy for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeClusterNotFoundFault "ClusterNotFound" // The ClusterIdentifier parameter does not refer to an existing cluster. // // * ErrCodeSnapshotCopyAlreadyDisabledFault "SnapshotCopyAlreadyDisabledFault" // The cluster already has cross-region snapshot copy disabled. // // * ErrCodeInvalidClusterStateFault "InvalidClusterState" // The specified cluster is not in the available state. // // * ErrCodeUnauthorizedOperation "UnauthorizedOperation" // Your account is not authorized to perform the requested operation. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/DisableSnapshotCopy func (c *Redshift) DisableSnapshotCopy(input *DisableSnapshotCopyInput) (*DisableSnapshotCopyOutput, error) { req, out := c.DisableSnapshotCopyRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // DisableSnapshotCopyWithContext is the same as DisableSnapshotCopy with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See DisableSnapshotCopy for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) DisableSnapshotCopyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DisableSnapshotCopyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DisableSnapshotCopyOutput, error) { req, out := c.DisableSnapshotCopyRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opEnableLogging = "EnableLogging" // EnableLoggingRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the EnableLogging operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See EnableLogging for more information on using the EnableLogging // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the EnableLoggingRequest method. // req, resp := client.EnableLoggingRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/EnableLogging func (c *Redshift) EnableLoggingRequest(input *EnableLoggingInput) (req *request.Request, output *LoggingStatus) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opEnableLogging, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &EnableLoggingInput{} } output = &LoggingStatus{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // EnableLogging API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Starts logging information, such as queries and connection attempts, for // the specified Amazon Redshift cluster. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation EnableLogging for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeClusterNotFoundFault "ClusterNotFound" // The ClusterIdentifier parameter does not refer to an existing cluster. // // * ErrCodeBucketNotFoundFault "BucketNotFoundFault" // Could not find the specified S3 bucket. // // * ErrCodeInsufficientS3BucketPolicyFault "InsufficientS3BucketPolicyFault" // The cluster does not have read bucket or put object permissions on the S3 // bucket specified when enabling logging. // // * ErrCodeInvalidS3KeyPrefixFault "InvalidS3KeyPrefixFault" // The string specified for the logging S3 key prefix does not comply with the // documented constraints. // // * ErrCodeInvalidS3BucketNameFault "InvalidS3BucketNameFault" // The S3 bucket name is invalid. For more information about naming rules, go // to Bucket Restrictions and Limitations (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/BucketRestrictions.html) // in the Amazon Simple Storage Service (S3) Developer Guide. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/EnableLogging func (c *Redshift) EnableLogging(input *EnableLoggingInput) (*LoggingStatus, error) { req, out := c.EnableLoggingRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // EnableLoggingWithContext is the same as EnableLogging with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See EnableLogging for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) EnableLoggingWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *EnableLoggingInput, opts ...request.Option) (*LoggingStatus, error) { req, out := c.EnableLoggingRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opEnableSnapshotCopy = "EnableSnapshotCopy" // EnableSnapshotCopyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the EnableSnapshotCopy operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See EnableSnapshotCopy for more information on using the EnableSnapshotCopy // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the EnableSnapshotCopyRequest method. // req, resp := client.EnableSnapshotCopyRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/EnableSnapshotCopy func (c *Redshift) EnableSnapshotCopyRequest(input *EnableSnapshotCopyInput) (req *request.Request, output *EnableSnapshotCopyOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opEnableSnapshotCopy, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &EnableSnapshotCopyInput{} } output = &EnableSnapshotCopyOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // EnableSnapshotCopy API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Enables the automatic copy of snapshots from one region to another region // for a specified cluster. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation EnableSnapshotCopy for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeIncompatibleOrderableOptions "IncompatibleOrderableOptions" // The specified options are incompatible. // // * ErrCodeInvalidClusterStateFault "InvalidClusterState" // The specified cluster is not in the available state. // // * ErrCodeClusterNotFoundFault "ClusterNotFound" // The ClusterIdentifier parameter does not refer to an existing cluster. // // * ErrCodeCopyToRegionDisabledFault "CopyToRegionDisabledFault" // Cross-region snapshot copy was temporarily disabled. Try your request again. // // * ErrCodeSnapshotCopyAlreadyEnabledFault "SnapshotCopyAlreadyEnabledFault" // The cluster already has cross-region snapshot copy enabled. // // * ErrCodeUnknownSnapshotCopyRegionFault "UnknownSnapshotCopyRegionFault" // The specified region is incorrect or does not exist. // // * ErrCodeUnauthorizedOperation "UnauthorizedOperation" // Your account is not authorized to perform the requested operation. // // * ErrCodeSnapshotCopyGrantNotFoundFault "SnapshotCopyGrantNotFoundFault" // The specified snapshot copy grant can't be found. Make sure that the name // is typed correctly and that the grant exists in the destination region. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededFault "LimitExceededFault" // The encryption key has exceeded its grant limit in AWS KMS. // // * ErrCodeDependentServiceRequestThrottlingFault "DependentServiceRequestThrottlingFault" // The request cannot be completed because a dependent service is throttling // requests made by Amazon Redshift on your behalf. Wait and retry the request. // // * ErrCodeInvalidRetentionPeriodFault "InvalidRetentionPeriodFault" // The retention period specified is either in the past or is not a valid value. // // The value must be either -1 or an integer between 1 and 3,653. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/EnableSnapshotCopy func (c *Redshift) EnableSnapshotCopy(input *EnableSnapshotCopyInput) (*EnableSnapshotCopyOutput, error) { req, out := c.EnableSnapshotCopyRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // EnableSnapshotCopyWithContext is the same as EnableSnapshotCopy with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See EnableSnapshotCopy for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) EnableSnapshotCopyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *EnableSnapshotCopyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*EnableSnapshotCopyOutput, error) { req, out := c.EnableSnapshotCopyRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opGetClusterCredentials = "GetClusterCredentials" // GetClusterCredentialsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the GetClusterCredentials operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See GetClusterCredentials for more information on using the GetClusterCredentials // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the GetClusterCredentialsRequest method. // req, resp := client.GetClusterCredentialsRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/GetClusterCredentials func (c *Redshift) GetClusterCredentialsRequest(input *GetClusterCredentialsInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetClusterCredentialsOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opGetClusterCredentials, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &GetClusterCredentialsInput{} } output = &GetClusterCredentialsOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // GetClusterCredentials API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Returns a database user name and temporary password with temporary authorization // to log on to an Amazon Redshift database. The action returns the database // user name prefixed with IAM: if AutoCreate is False or IAMA: if AutoCreate // is True. You can optionally specify one or more database user groups that // the user will join at log on. By default, the temporary credentials expire // in 900 seconds. You can optionally specify a duration between 900 seconds // (15 minutes) and 3600 seconds (60 minutes). For more information, see Using // IAM Authentication to Generate Database User Credentials (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/generating-user-credentials.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // The AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM)user or role that executes GetClusterCredentials // must have an IAM policy attached that allows access to all necessary actions // and resources. For more information about permissions, see Resource Policies // for GetClusterCredentials (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/redshift-iam-access-control-identity-based.html#redshift-policy-resources.getclustercredentials-resources) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // If the DbGroups parameter is specified, the IAM policy must allow the redshift:JoinGroup // action with access to the listed dbgroups. // // In addition, if the AutoCreate parameter is set to True, then the policy // must include the redshift:CreateClusterUser privilege. // // If the DbName parameter is specified, the IAM policy must allow access to // the resource dbname for the specified database name. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation GetClusterCredentials for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeClusterNotFoundFault "ClusterNotFound" // The ClusterIdentifier parameter does not refer to an existing cluster. // // * ErrCodeUnsupportedOperationFault "UnsupportedOperation" // The requested operation isn't supported. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/GetClusterCredentials func (c *Redshift) GetClusterCredentials(input *GetClusterCredentialsInput) (*GetClusterCredentialsOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetClusterCredentialsRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // GetClusterCredentialsWithContext is the same as GetClusterCredentials with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See GetClusterCredentials for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) GetClusterCredentialsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetClusterCredentialsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetClusterCredentialsOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetClusterCredentialsRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opGetReservedNodeExchangeOfferings = "GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferings" // GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferingsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferings operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferings for more information on using the GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferings // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferingsRequest method. // req, resp := client.GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferingsRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferings func (c *Redshift) GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferingsRequest(input *GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferingsInput) (req *request.Request, output *GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferingsOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opGetReservedNodeExchangeOfferings, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferingsInput{} } output = &GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferingsOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferings API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Returns an array of DC2 ReservedNodeOfferings that matches the payment type, // term, and usage price of the given DC1 reserved node. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferings for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeReservedNodeNotFoundFault "ReservedNodeNotFound" // The specified reserved compute node not found. // // * ErrCodeInvalidReservedNodeStateFault "InvalidReservedNodeState" // Indicates that the Reserved Node being exchanged is not in an active state. // // * ErrCodeReservedNodeAlreadyMigratedFault "ReservedNodeAlreadyMigrated" // Indicates that the reserved node has already been exchanged. // // * ErrCodeReservedNodeOfferingNotFoundFault "ReservedNodeOfferingNotFound" // Specified offering does not exist. // // * ErrCodeUnsupportedOperationFault "UnsupportedOperation" // The requested operation isn't supported. // // * ErrCodeDependentServiceUnavailableFault "DependentServiceUnavailableFault" // Your request cannot be completed because a dependent internal service is // temporarily unavailable. Wait 30 to 60 seconds and try again. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferings func (c *Redshift) GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferings(input *GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferingsInput) (*GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferingsOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferingsRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferingsWithContext is the same as GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferings with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferings for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferingsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferingsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferingsOutput, error) { req, out := c.GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferingsRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opModifyCluster = "ModifyCluster" // ModifyClusterRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ModifyCluster operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ModifyCluster for more information on using the ModifyCluster // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ModifyClusterRequest method. // req, resp := client.ModifyClusterRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/ModifyCluster func (c *Redshift) ModifyClusterRequest(input *ModifyClusterInput) (req *request.Request, output *ModifyClusterOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opModifyCluster, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &ModifyClusterInput{} } output = &ModifyClusterOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ModifyCluster API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Modifies the settings for a cluster. For example, you can add another security // or parameter group, update the preferred maintenance window, or change the // master user password. Resetting a cluster password or modifying the security // groups associated with a cluster do not need a reboot. However, modifying // a parameter group requires a reboot for parameters to take effect. For more // information about managing clusters, go to Amazon Redshift Clusters (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-clusters.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // You can also change node type and the number of nodes to scale up or down // the cluster. When resizing a cluster, you must specify both the number of // nodes and the node type even if one of the parameters does not change. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation ModifyCluster for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeInvalidClusterStateFault "InvalidClusterState" // The specified cluster is not in the available state. // // * ErrCodeInvalidClusterSecurityGroupStateFault "InvalidClusterSecurityGroupState" // The state of the cluster security group is not available. // // * ErrCodeClusterNotFoundFault "ClusterNotFound" // The ClusterIdentifier parameter does not refer to an existing cluster. // // * ErrCodeNumberOfNodesQuotaExceededFault "NumberOfNodesQuotaExceeded" // The operation would exceed the number of nodes allotted to the account. For // information about increasing your quota, go to Limits in Amazon Redshift // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/amazon-redshift-limits.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // * ErrCodeNumberOfNodesPerClusterLimitExceededFault "NumberOfNodesPerClusterLimitExceeded" // The operation would exceed the number of nodes allowed for a cluster. // // * ErrCodeClusterSecurityGroupNotFoundFault "ClusterSecurityGroupNotFound" // The cluster security group name does not refer to an existing cluster security // group. // // * ErrCodeClusterParameterGroupNotFoundFault "ClusterParameterGroupNotFound" // The parameter group name does not refer to an existing parameter group. // // * ErrCodeInsufficientClusterCapacityFault "InsufficientClusterCapacity" // The number of nodes specified exceeds the allotted capacity of the cluster. // // * ErrCodeUnsupportedOptionFault "UnsupportedOptionFault" // A request option was specified that is not supported. // // * ErrCodeUnauthorizedOperation "UnauthorizedOperation" // Your account is not authorized to perform the requested operation. // // * ErrCodeHsmClientCertificateNotFoundFault "HsmClientCertificateNotFoundFault" // There is no Amazon Redshift HSM client certificate with the specified identifier. // // * ErrCodeHsmConfigurationNotFoundFault "HsmConfigurationNotFoundFault" // There is no Amazon Redshift HSM configuration with the specified identifier. // // * ErrCodeClusterAlreadyExistsFault "ClusterAlreadyExists" // The account already has a cluster with the given identifier. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededFault "LimitExceededFault" // The encryption key has exceeded its grant limit in AWS KMS. // // * ErrCodeDependentServiceRequestThrottlingFault "DependentServiceRequestThrottlingFault" // The request cannot be completed because a dependent service is throttling // requests made by Amazon Redshift on your behalf. Wait and retry the request. // // * ErrCodeInvalidElasticIpFault "InvalidElasticIpFault" // The Elastic IP (EIP) is invalid or cannot be found. // // * ErrCodeTableLimitExceededFault "TableLimitExceeded" // The number of tables in the cluster exceeds the limit for the requested new // cluster node type. // // * ErrCodeInvalidClusterTrackFault "InvalidClusterTrack" // The provided cluster track name is not valid. // // * ErrCodeInvalidRetentionPeriodFault "InvalidRetentionPeriodFault" // The retention period specified is either in the past or is not a valid value. // // The value must be either -1 or an integer between 1 and 3,653. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/ModifyCluster func (c *Redshift) ModifyCluster(input *ModifyClusterInput) (*ModifyClusterOutput, error) { req, out := c.ModifyClusterRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ModifyClusterWithContext is the same as ModifyCluster with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ModifyCluster for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) ModifyClusterWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyClusterInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ModifyClusterOutput, error) { req, out := c.ModifyClusterRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opModifyClusterDbRevision = "ModifyClusterDbRevision" // ModifyClusterDbRevisionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ModifyClusterDbRevision operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ModifyClusterDbRevision for more information on using the ModifyClusterDbRevision // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ModifyClusterDbRevisionRequest method. // req, resp := client.ModifyClusterDbRevisionRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/ModifyClusterDbRevision func (c *Redshift) ModifyClusterDbRevisionRequest(input *ModifyClusterDbRevisionInput) (req *request.Request, output *ModifyClusterDbRevisionOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opModifyClusterDbRevision, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &ModifyClusterDbRevisionInput{} } output = &ModifyClusterDbRevisionOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ModifyClusterDbRevision API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Modifies the database revision of a cluster. The database revision is a unique // revision of the database running in a cluster. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation ModifyClusterDbRevision for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeClusterNotFoundFault "ClusterNotFound" // The ClusterIdentifier parameter does not refer to an existing cluster. // // * ErrCodeClusterOnLatestRevisionFault "ClusterOnLatestRevision" // Cluster is already on the latest database revision. // // * ErrCodeInvalidClusterStateFault "InvalidClusterState" // The specified cluster is not in the available state. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/ModifyClusterDbRevision func (c *Redshift) ModifyClusterDbRevision(input *ModifyClusterDbRevisionInput) (*ModifyClusterDbRevisionOutput, error) { req, out := c.ModifyClusterDbRevisionRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ModifyClusterDbRevisionWithContext is the same as ModifyClusterDbRevision with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ModifyClusterDbRevision for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) ModifyClusterDbRevisionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyClusterDbRevisionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ModifyClusterDbRevisionOutput, error) { req, out := c.ModifyClusterDbRevisionRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opModifyClusterIamRoles = "ModifyClusterIamRoles" // ModifyClusterIamRolesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ModifyClusterIamRoles operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ModifyClusterIamRoles for more information on using the ModifyClusterIamRoles // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ModifyClusterIamRolesRequest method. // req, resp := client.ModifyClusterIamRolesRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/ModifyClusterIamRoles func (c *Redshift) ModifyClusterIamRolesRequest(input *ModifyClusterIamRolesInput) (req *request.Request, output *ModifyClusterIamRolesOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opModifyClusterIamRoles, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &ModifyClusterIamRolesInput{} } output = &ModifyClusterIamRolesOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ModifyClusterIamRoles API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Modifies the list of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) roles that // can be used by the cluster to access other AWS services. // // A cluster can have up to 10 IAM roles associated at any time. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation ModifyClusterIamRoles for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeInvalidClusterStateFault "InvalidClusterState" // The specified cluster is not in the available state. // // * ErrCodeClusterNotFoundFault "ClusterNotFound" // The ClusterIdentifier parameter does not refer to an existing cluster. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/ModifyClusterIamRoles func (c *Redshift) ModifyClusterIamRoles(input *ModifyClusterIamRolesInput) (*ModifyClusterIamRolesOutput, error) { req, out := c.ModifyClusterIamRolesRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ModifyClusterIamRolesWithContext is the same as ModifyClusterIamRoles with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ModifyClusterIamRoles for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) ModifyClusterIamRolesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyClusterIamRolesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ModifyClusterIamRolesOutput, error) { req, out := c.ModifyClusterIamRolesRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opModifyClusterMaintenance = "ModifyClusterMaintenance" // ModifyClusterMaintenanceRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ModifyClusterMaintenance operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ModifyClusterMaintenance for more information on using the ModifyClusterMaintenance // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ModifyClusterMaintenanceRequest method. // req, resp := client.ModifyClusterMaintenanceRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/ModifyClusterMaintenance func (c *Redshift) ModifyClusterMaintenanceRequest(input *ModifyClusterMaintenanceInput) (req *request.Request, output *ModifyClusterMaintenanceOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opModifyClusterMaintenance, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &ModifyClusterMaintenanceInput{} } output = &ModifyClusterMaintenanceOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ModifyClusterMaintenance API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Modifies the maintenance settings of a cluster. For example, you can defer // a maintenance window. You can also update or cancel a deferment. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation ModifyClusterMaintenance for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeClusterNotFoundFault "ClusterNotFound" // The ClusterIdentifier parameter does not refer to an existing cluster. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/ModifyClusterMaintenance func (c *Redshift) ModifyClusterMaintenance(input *ModifyClusterMaintenanceInput) (*ModifyClusterMaintenanceOutput, error) { req, out := c.ModifyClusterMaintenanceRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ModifyClusterMaintenanceWithContext is the same as ModifyClusterMaintenance with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ModifyClusterMaintenance for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) ModifyClusterMaintenanceWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyClusterMaintenanceInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ModifyClusterMaintenanceOutput, error) { req, out := c.ModifyClusterMaintenanceRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opModifyClusterParameterGroup = "ModifyClusterParameterGroup" // ModifyClusterParameterGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ModifyClusterParameterGroup operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ModifyClusterParameterGroup for more information on using the ModifyClusterParameterGroup // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ModifyClusterParameterGroupRequest method. // req, resp := client.ModifyClusterParameterGroupRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/ModifyClusterParameterGroup func (c *Redshift) ModifyClusterParameterGroupRequest(input *ModifyClusterParameterGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *ClusterParameterGroupNameMessage) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opModifyClusterParameterGroup, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &ModifyClusterParameterGroupInput{} } output = &ClusterParameterGroupNameMessage{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ModifyClusterParameterGroup API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Modifies the parameters of a parameter group. // // For more information about parameters and parameter groups, go to Amazon // Redshift Parameter Groups (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-parameter-groups.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation ModifyClusterParameterGroup for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeClusterParameterGroupNotFoundFault "ClusterParameterGroupNotFound" // The parameter group name does not refer to an existing parameter group. // // * ErrCodeInvalidClusterParameterGroupStateFault "InvalidClusterParameterGroupState" // The cluster parameter group action can not be completed because another task // is in progress that involves the parameter group. Wait a few moments and // try the operation again. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/ModifyClusterParameterGroup func (c *Redshift) ModifyClusterParameterGroup(input *ModifyClusterParameterGroupInput) (*ClusterParameterGroupNameMessage, error) { req, out := c.ModifyClusterParameterGroupRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ModifyClusterParameterGroupWithContext is the same as ModifyClusterParameterGroup with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ModifyClusterParameterGroup for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) ModifyClusterParameterGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyClusterParameterGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ClusterParameterGroupNameMessage, error) { req, out := c.ModifyClusterParameterGroupRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opModifyClusterSnapshot = "ModifyClusterSnapshot" // ModifyClusterSnapshotRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ModifyClusterSnapshot operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ModifyClusterSnapshot for more information on using the ModifyClusterSnapshot // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ModifyClusterSnapshotRequest method. // req, resp := client.ModifyClusterSnapshotRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/ModifyClusterSnapshot func (c *Redshift) ModifyClusterSnapshotRequest(input *ModifyClusterSnapshotInput) (req *request.Request, output *ModifyClusterSnapshotOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opModifyClusterSnapshot, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &ModifyClusterSnapshotInput{} } output = &ModifyClusterSnapshotOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ModifyClusterSnapshot API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Modifies the settings for a snapshot. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation ModifyClusterSnapshot for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeInvalidClusterSnapshotStateFault "InvalidClusterSnapshotState" // The specified cluster snapshot is not in the available state, or other accounts // are authorized to access the snapshot. // // * ErrCodeClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault "ClusterSnapshotNotFound" // The snapshot identifier does not refer to an existing cluster snapshot. // // * ErrCodeInvalidRetentionPeriodFault "InvalidRetentionPeriodFault" // The retention period specified is either in the past or is not a valid value. // // The value must be either -1 or an integer between 1 and 3,653. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/ModifyClusterSnapshot func (c *Redshift) ModifyClusterSnapshot(input *ModifyClusterSnapshotInput) (*ModifyClusterSnapshotOutput, error) { req, out := c.ModifyClusterSnapshotRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ModifyClusterSnapshotWithContext is the same as ModifyClusterSnapshot with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ModifyClusterSnapshot for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) ModifyClusterSnapshotWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyClusterSnapshotInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ModifyClusterSnapshotOutput, error) { req, out := c.ModifyClusterSnapshotRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opModifyClusterSnapshotSchedule = "ModifyClusterSnapshotSchedule" // ModifyClusterSnapshotScheduleRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ModifyClusterSnapshotSchedule operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ModifyClusterSnapshotSchedule for more information on using the ModifyClusterSnapshotSchedule // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ModifyClusterSnapshotScheduleRequest method. // req, resp := client.ModifyClusterSnapshotScheduleRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/ModifyClusterSnapshotSchedule func (c *Redshift) ModifyClusterSnapshotScheduleRequest(input *ModifyClusterSnapshotScheduleInput) (req *request.Request, output *ModifyClusterSnapshotScheduleOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opModifyClusterSnapshotSchedule, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &ModifyClusterSnapshotScheduleInput{} } output = &ModifyClusterSnapshotScheduleOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(query.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler) return } // ModifyClusterSnapshotSchedule API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Modifies a snapshot schedule for a cluster. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation ModifyClusterSnapshotSchedule for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeClusterNotFoundFault "ClusterNotFound" // The ClusterIdentifier parameter does not refer to an existing cluster. // // * ErrCodeSnapshotScheduleNotFoundFault "SnapshotScheduleNotFound" // We could not find the specified snapshot schedule. // // * ErrCodeInvalidClusterSnapshotScheduleStateFault "InvalidClusterSnapshotScheduleState" // The cluster snapshot schedule state is not valid. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/ModifyClusterSnapshotSchedule func (c *Redshift) ModifyClusterSnapshotSchedule(input *ModifyClusterSnapshotScheduleInput) (*ModifyClusterSnapshotScheduleOutput, error) { req, out := c.ModifyClusterSnapshotScheduleRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ModifyClusterSnapshotScheduleWithContext is the same as ModifyClusterSnapshotSchedule with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ModifyClusterSnapshotSchedule for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) ModifyClusterSnapshotScheduleWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyClusterSnapshotScheduleInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ModifyClusterSnapshotScheduleOutput, error) { req, out := c.ModifyClusterSnapshotScheduleRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opModifyClusterSubnetGroup = "ModifyClusterSubnetGroup" // ModifyClusterSubnetGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ModifyClusterSubnetGroup operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ModifyClusterSubnetGroup for more information on using the ModifyClusterSubnetGroup // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ModifyClusterSubnetGroupRequest method. // req, resp := client.ModifyClusterSubnetGroupRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/ModifyClusterSubnetGroup func (c *Redshift) ModifyClusterSubnetGroupRequest(input *ModifyClusterSubnetGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *ModifyClusterSubnetGroupOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opModifyClusterSubnetGroup, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &ModifyClusterSubnetGroupInput{} } output = &ModifyClusterSubnetGroupOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ModifyClusterSubnetGroup API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Modifies a cluster subnet group to include the specified list of VPC subnets. // The operation replaces the existing list of subnets with the new list of // subnets. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation ModifyClusterSubnetGroup for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeClusterSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "ClusterSubnetGroupNotFoundFault" // The cluster subnet group name does not refer to an existing cluster subnet // group. // // * ErrCodeClusterSubnetQuotaExceededFault "ClusterSubnetQuotaExceededFault" // The request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of subnets // in a cluster subnet groups. For information about increasing your quota, // go to Limits in Amazon Redshift (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/amazon-redshift-limits.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // * ErrCodeSubnetAlreadyInUse "SubnetAlreadyInUse" // A specified subnet is already in use by another cluster. // // * ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet" // The requested subnet is not valid, or not all of the subnets are in the same // VPC. // // * ErrCodeUnauthorizedOperation "UnauthorizedOperation" // Your account is not authorized to perform the requested operation. // // * ErrCodeDependentServiceRequestThrottlingFault "DependentServiceRequestThrottlingFault" // The request cannot be completed because a dependent service is throttling // requests made by Amazon Redshift on your behalf. Wait and retry the request. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/ModifyClusterSubnetGroup func (c *Redshift) ModifyClusterSubnetGroup(input *ModifyClusterSubnetGroupInput) (*ModifyClusterSubnetGroupOutput, error) { req, out := c.ModifyClusterSubnetGroupRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ModifyClusterSubnetGroupWithContext is the same as ModifyClusterSubnetGroup with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ModifyClusterSubnetGroup for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) ModifyClusterSubnetGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyClusterSubnetGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ModifyClusterSubnetGroupOutput, error) { req, out := c.ModifyClusterSubnetGroupRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opModifyEventSubscription = "ModifyEventSubscription" // ModifyEventSubscriptionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ModifyEventSubscription operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ModifyEventSubscription for more information on using the ModifyEventSubscription // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ModifyEventSubscriptionRequest method. // req, resp := client.ModifyEventSubscriptionRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/ModifyEventSubscription func (c *Redshift) ModifyEventSubscriptionRequest(input *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) (req *request.Request, output *ModifyEventSubscriptionOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opModifyEventSubscription, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &ModifyEventSubscriptionInput{} } output = &ModifyEventSubscriptionOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ModifyEventSubscription API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Modifies an existing Amazon Redshift event notification subscription. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation ModifyEventSubscription for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeSubscriptionNotFoundFault "SubscriptionNotFound" // An Amazon Redshift event notification subscription with the specified name // does not exist. // // * ErrCodeSNSInvalidTopicFault "SNSInvalidTopic" // Amazon SNS has responded that there is a problem with the specified Amazon // SNS topic. // // * ErrCodeSNSNoAuthorizationFault "SNSNoAuthorization" // You do not have permission to publish to the specified Amazon SNS topic. // // * ErrCodeSNSTopicArnNotFoundFault "SNSTopicArnNotFound" // An Amazon SNS topic with the specified Amazon Resource Name (ARN) does not // exist. // // * ErrCodeSubscriptionEventIdNotFoundFault "SubscriptionEventIdNotFound" // An Amazon Redshift event with the specified event ID does not exist. // // * ErrCodeSubscriptionCategoryNotFoundFault "SubscriptionCategoryNotFound" // The value specified for the event category was not one of the allowed values, // or it specified a category that does not apply to the specified source type. // The allowed values are Configuration, Management, Monitoring, and Security. // // * ErrCodeSubscriptionSeverityNotFoundFault "SubscriptionSeverityNotFound" // The value specified for the event severity was not one of the allowed values, // or it specified a severity that does not apply to the specified source type. // The allowed values are ERROR and INFO. // // * ErrCodeSourceNotFoundFault "SourceNotFound" // The specified Amazon Redshift event source could not be found. // // * ErrCodeInvalidSubscriptionStateFault "InvalidSubscriptionStateFault" // The subscription request is invalid because it is a duplicate request. This // subscription request is already in progress. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/ModifyEventSubscription func (c *Redshift) ModifyEventSubscription(input *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) (*ModifyEventSubscriptionOutput, error) { req, out := c.ModifyEventSubscriptionRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ModifyEventSubscriptionWithContext is the same as ModifyEventSubscription with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ModifyEventSubscription for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) ModifyEventSubscriptionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ModifyEventSubscriptionOutput, error) { req, out := c.ModifyEventSubscriptionRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriod = "ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriod" // ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriodRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriod operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriod for more information on using the ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriod // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriodRequest method. // req, resp := client.ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriodRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriod func (c *Redshift) ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriodRequest(input *ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriodInput) (req *request.Request, output *ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriodOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriod, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriodInput{} } output = &ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriodOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriod API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Modifies the number of days to retain snapshots in the destination AWS Region // after they are copied from the source AWS Region. By default, this operation // only changes the retention period of copied automated snapshots. The retention // periods for both new and existing copied automated snapshots are updated // with the new retention period. You can set the manual option to change only // the retention periods of copied manual snapshots. If you set this option, // only newly copied manual snapshots have the new retention period. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriod for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeClusterNotFoundFault "ClusterNotFound" // The ClusterIdentifier parameter does not refer to an existing cluster. // // * ErrCodeSnapshotCopyDisabledFault "SnapshotCopyDisabledFault" // Cross-region snapshot copy was temporarily disabled. Try your request again. // // * ErrCodeUnauthorizedOperation "UnauthorizedOperation" // Your account is not authorized to perform the requested operation. // // * ErrCodeInvalidClusterStateFault "InvalidClusterState" // The specified cluster is not in the available state. // // * ErrCodeInvalidRetentionPeriodFault "InvalidRetentionPeriodFault" // The retention period specified is either in the past or is not a valid value. // // The value must be either -1 or an integer between 1 and 3,653. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriod func (c *Redshift) ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriod(input *ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriodInput) (*ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriodOutput, error) { req, out := c.ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriodRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriodWithContext is the same as ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriod with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriod for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriodWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriodInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriodOutput, error) { req, out := c.ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriodRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opModifySnapshotSchedule = "ModifySnapshotSchedule" // ModifySnapshotScheduleRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ModifySnapshotSchedule operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ModifySnapshotSchedule for more information on using the ModifySnapshotSchedule // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ModifySnapshotScheduleRequest method. // req, resp := client.ModifySnapshotScheduleRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/ModifySnapshotSchedule func (c *Redshift) ModifySnapshotScheduleRequest(input *ModifySnapshotScheduleInput) (req *request.Request, output *ModifySnapshotScheduleOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opModifySnapshotSchedule, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &ModifySnapshotScheduleInput{} } output = &ModifySnapshotScheduleOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ModifySnapshotSchedule API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Modifies a snapshot schedule. Any schedule associated with a cluster is modified // asynchronously. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation ModifySnapshotSchedule for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeInvalidScheduleFault "InvalidSchedule" // The schedule you submitted isn't valid. // // * ErrCodeSnapshotScheduleNotFoundFault "SnapshotScheduleNotFound" // We could not find the specified snapshot schedule. // // * ErrCodeSnapshotScheduleUpdateInProgressFault "SnapshotScheduleUpdateInProgress" // The specified snapshot schedule is already being updated. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/ModifySnapshotSchedule func (c *Redshift) ModifySnapshotSchedule(input *ModifySnapshotScheduleInput) (*ModifySnapshotScheduleOutput, error) { req, out := c.ModifySnapshotScheduleRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ModifySnapshotScheduleWithContext is the same as ModifySnapshotSchedule with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ModifySnapshotSchedule for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) ModifySnapshotScheduleWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifySnapshotScheduleInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ModifySnapshotScheduleOutput, error) { req, out := c.ModifySnapshotScheduleRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opPurchaseReservedNodeOffering = "PurchaseReservedNodeOffering" // PurchaseReservedNodeOfferingRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the PurchaseReservedNodeOffering operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See PurchaseReservedNodeOffering for more information on using the PurchaseReservedNodeOffering // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the PurchaseReservedNodeOfferingRequest method. // req, resp := client.PurchaseReservedNodeOfferingRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/PurchaseReservedNodeOffering func (c *Redshift) PurchaseReservedNodeOfferingRequest(input *PurchaseReservedNodeOfferingInput) (req *request.Request, output *PurchaseReservedNodeOfferingOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opPurchaseReservedNodeOffering, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &PurchaseReservedNodeOfferingInput{} } output = &PurchaseReservedNodeOfferingOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // PurchaseReservedNodeOffering API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Allows you to purchase reserved nodes. Amazon Redshift offers a predefined // set of reserved node offerings. You can purchase one or more of the offerings. // You can call the DescribeReservedNodeOfferings API to obtain the available // reserved node offerings. You can call this API by providing a specific reserved // node offering and the number of nodes you want to reserve. // // For more information about reserved node offerings, go to Purchasing Reserved // Nodes (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/purchase-reserved-node-instance.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation PurchaseReservedNodeOffering for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeReservedNodeOfferingNotFoundFault "ReservedNodeOfferingNotFound" // Specified offering does not exist. // // * ErrCodeReservedNodeAlreadyExistsFault "ReservedNodeAlreadyExists" // User already has a reservation with the given identifier. // // * ErrCodeReservedNodeQuotaExceededFault "ReservedNodeQuotaExceeded" // Request would exceed the user's compute node quota. For information about // increasing your quota, go to Limits in Amazon Redshift (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/amazon-redshift-limits.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // * ErrCodeUnsupportedOperationFault "UnsupportedOperation" // The requested operation isn't supported. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/PurchaseReservedNodeOffering func (c *Redshift) PurchaseReservedNodeOffering(input *PurchaseReservedNodeOfferingInput) (*PurchaseReservedNodeOfferingOutput, error) { req, out := c.PurchaseReservedNodeOfferingRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // PurchaseReservedNodeOfferingWithContext is the same as PurchaseReservedNodeOffering with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See PurchaseReservedNodeOffering for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) PurchaseReservedNodeOfferingWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PurchaseReservedNodeOfferingInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PurchaseReservedNodeOfferingOutput, error) { req, out := c.PurchaseReservedNodeOfferingRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opRebootCluster = "RebootCluster" // RebootClusterRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the RebootCluster operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See RebootCluster for more information on using the RebootCluster // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the RebootClusterRequest method. // req, resp := client.RebootClusterRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/RebootCluster func (c *Redshift) RebootClusterRequest(input *RebootClusterInput) (req *request.Request, output *RebootClusterOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opRebootCluster, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &RebootClusterInput{} } output = &RebootClusterOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // RebootCluster API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Reboots a cluster. This action is taken as soon as possible. It results in // a momentary outage to the cluster, during which the cluster status is set // to rebooting. A cluster event is created when the reboot is completed. Any // pending cluster modifications (see ModifyCluster) are applied at this reboot. // For more information about managing clusters, go to Amazon Redshift Clusters // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-clusters.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation RebootCluster for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeInvalidClusterStateFault "InvalidClusterState" // The specified cluster is not in the available state. // // * ErrCodeClusterNotFoundFault "ClusterNotFound" // The ClusterIdentifier parameter does not refer to an existing cluster. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/RebootCluster func (c *Redshift) RebootCluster(input *RebootClusterInput) (*RebootClusterOutput, error) { req, out := c.RebootClusterRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // RebootClusterWithContext is the same as RebootCluster with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See RebootCluster for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) RebootClusterWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RebootClusterInput, opts ...request.Option) (*RebootClusterOutput, error) { req, out := c.RebootClusterRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opResetClusterParameterGroup = "ResetClusterParameterGroup" // ResetClusterParameterGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ResetClusterParameterGroup operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ResetClusterParameterGroup for more information on using the ResetClusterParameterGroup // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ResetClusterParameterGroupRequest method. // req, resp := client.ResetClusterParameterGroupRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/ResetClusterParameterGroup func (c *Redshift) ResetClusterParameterGroupRequest(input *ResetClusterParameterGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *ClusterParameterGroupNameMessage) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opResetClusterParameterGroup, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &ResetClusterParameterGroupInput{} } output = &ClusterParameterGroupNameMessage{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ResetClusterParameterGroup API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Sets one or more parameters of the specified parameter group to their default // values and sets the source values of the parameters to "engine-default". // To reset the entire parameter group specify the ResetAllParameters parameter. // For parameter changes to take effect you must reboot any associated clusters. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation ResetClusterParameterGroup for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeInvalidClusterParameterGroupStateFault "InvalidClusterParameterGroupState" // The cluster parameter group action can not be completed because another task // is in progress that involves the parameter group. Wait a few moments and // try the operation again. // // * ErrCodeClusterParameterGroupNotFoundFault "ClusterParameterGroupNotFound" // The parameter group name does not refer to an existing parameter group. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/ResetClusterParameterGroup func (c *Redshift) ResetClusterParameterGroup(input *ResetClusterParameterGroupInput) (*ClusterParameterGroupNameMessage, error) { req, out := c.ResetClusterParameterGroupRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ResetClusterParameterGroupWithContext is the same as ResetClusterParameterGroup with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ResetClusterParameterGroup for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) ResetClusterParameterGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ResetClusterParameterGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ClusterParameterGroupNameMessage, error) { req, out := c.ResetClusterParameterGroupRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opResizeCluster = "ResizeCluster" // ResizeClusterRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the ResizeCluster operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See ResizeCluster for more information on using the ResizeCluster // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the ResizeClusterRequest method. // req, resp := client.ResizeClusterRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/ResizeCluster func (c *Redshift) ResizeClusterRequest(input *ResizeClusterInput) (req *request.Request, output *ResizeClusterOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opResizeCluster, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &ResizeClusterInput{} } output = &ResizeClusterOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // ResizeCluster API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Changes the size of the cluster. You can change the cluster's type, or change // the number or type of nodes. The default behavior is to use the elastic resize // method. With an elastic resize, your cluster is available for read and write // operations more quickly than with the classic resize method. // // Elastic resize operations have the following restrictions: // // * You can only resize clusters of the following types: // // dc2.large // // dc2.8xlarge // // ds2.xlarge // // ds2.8xlarge // // * The type of nodes that you add must match the node type for the cluster. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation ResizeCluster for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeInvalidClusterStateFault "InvalidClusterState" // The specified cluster is not in the available state. // // * ErrCodeClusterNotFoundFault "ClusterNotFound" // The ClusterIdentifier parameter does not refer to an existing cluster. // // * ErrCodeNumberOfNodesQuotaExceededFault "NumberOfNodesQuotaExceeded" // The operation would exceed the number of nodes allotted to the account. For // information about increasing your quota, go to Limits in Amazon Redshift // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/amazon-redshift-limits.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // * ErrCodeNumberOfNodesPerClusterLimitExceededFault "NumberOfNodesPerClusterLimitExceeded" // The operation would exceed the number of nodes allowed for a cluster. // // * ErrCodeInsufficientClusterCapacityFault "InsufficientClusterCapacity" // The number of nodes specified exceeds the allotted capacity of the cluster. // // * ErrCodeUnsupportedOptionFault "UnsupportedOptionFault" // A request option was specified that is not supported. // // * ErrCodeUnsupportedOperationFault "UnsupportedOperation" // The requested operation isn't supported. // // * ErrCodeUnauthorizedOperation "UnauthorizedOperation" // Your account is not authorized to perform the requested operation. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededFault "LimitExceededFault" // The encryption key has exceeded its grant limit in AWS KMS. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/ResizeCluster func (c *Redshift) ResizeCluster(input *ResizeClusterInput) (*ResizeClusterOutput, error) { req, out := c.ResizeClusterRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // ResizeClusterWithContext is the same as ResizeCluster with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See ResizeCluster for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) ResizeClusterWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ResizeClusterInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ResizeClusterOutput, error) { req, out := c.ResizeClusterRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opRestoreFromClusterSnapshot = "RestoreFromClusterSnapshot" // RestoreFromClusterSnapshotRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the RestoreFromClusterSnapshot operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See RestoreFromClusterSnapshot for more information on using the RestoreFromClusterSnapshot // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the RestoreFromClusterSnapshotRequest method. // req, resp := client.RestoreFromClusterSnapshotRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/RestoreFromClusterSnapshot func (c *Redshift) RestoreFromClusterSnapshotRequest(input *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput) (req *request.Request, output *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opRestoreFromClusterSnapshot, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput{} } output = &RestoreFromClusterSnapshotOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // RestoreFromClusterSnapshot API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Creates a new cluster from a snapshot. By default, Amazon Redshift creates // the resulting cluster with the same configuration as the original cluster // from which the snapshot was created, except that the new cluster is created // with the default cluster security and parameter groups. After Amazon Redshift // creates the cluster, you can use the ModifyCluster API to associate a different // security group and different parameter group with the restored cluster. If // you are using a DS node type, you can also choose to change to another DS // node type of the same size during restore. // // If you restore a cluster into a VPC, you must provide a cluster subnet group // where you want the cluster restored. // // For more information about working with snapshots, go to Amazon Redshift // Snapshots (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-snapshots.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation RestoreFromClusterSnapshot for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeAccessToSnapshotDeniedFault "AccessToSnapshotDenied" // The owner of the specified snapshot has not authorized your account to access // the snapshot. // // * ErrCodeClusterAlreadyExistsFault "ClusterAlreadyExists" // The account already has a cluster with the given identifier. // // * ErrCodeClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault "ClusterSnapshotNotFound" // The snapshot identifier does not refer to an existing cluster snapshot. // // * ErrCodeClusterQuotaExceededFault "ClusterQuotaExceeded" // The request would exceed the allowed number of cluster instances for this // account. For information about increasing your quota, go to Limits in Amazon // Redshift (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/amazon-redshift-limits.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // * ErrCodeInsufficientClusterCapacityFault "InsufficientClusterCapacity" // The number of nodes specified exceeds the allotted capacity of the cluster. // // * ErrCodeInvalidClusterSnapshotStateFault "InvalidClusterSnapshotState" // The specified cluster snapshot is not in the available state, or other accounts // are authorized to access the snapshot. // // * ErrCodeInvalidRestoreFault "InvalidRestore" // The restore is invalid. // // * ErrCodeNumberOfNodesQuotaExceededFault "NumberOfNodesQuotaExceeded" // The operation would exceed the number of nodes allotted to the account. For // information about increasing your quota, go to Limits in Amazon Redshift // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/amazon-redshift-limits.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // * ErrCodeNumberOfNodesPerClusterLimitExceededFault "NumberOfNodesPerClusterLimitExceeded" // The operation would exceed the number of nodes allowed for a cluster. // // * ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault "InvalidVPCNetworkStateFault" // The cluster subnet group does not cover all Availability Zones. // // * ErrCodeInvalidClusterSubnetGroupStateFault "InvalidClusterSubnetGroupStateFault" // The cluster subnet group cannot be deleted because it is in use. // // * ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet" // The requested subnet is not valid, or not all of the subnets are in the same // VPC. // // * ErrCodeClusterSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "ClusterSubnetGroupNotFoundFault" // The cluster subnet group name does not refer to an existing cluster subnet // group. // // * ErrCodeUnauthorizedOperation "UnauthorizedOperation" // Your account is not authorized to perform the requested operation. // // * ErrCodeHsmClientCertificateNotFoundFault "HsmClientCertificateNotFoundFault" // There is no Amazon Redshift HSM client certificate with the specified identifier. // // * ErrCodeHsmConfigurationNotFoundFault "HsmConfigurationNotFoundFault" // There is no Amazon Redshift HSM configuration with the specified identifier. // // * ErrCodeInvalidElasticIpFault "InvalidElasticIpFault" // The Elastic IP (EIP) is invalid or cannot be found. // // * ErrCodeClusterParameterGroupNotFoundFault "ClusterParameterGroupNotFound" // The parameter group name does not refer to an existing parameter group. // // * ErrCodeClusterSecurityGroupNotFoundFault "ClusterSecurityGroupNotFound" // The cluster security group name does not refer to an existing cluster security // group. // // * ErrCodeLimitExceededFault "LimitExceededFault" // The encryption key has exceeded its grant limit in AWS KMS. // // * ErrCodeDependentServiceRequestThrottlingFault "DependentServiceRequestThrottlingFault" // The request cannot be completed because a dependent service is throttling // requests made by Amazon Redshift on your behalf. Wait and retry the request. // // * ErrCodeInvalidClusterTrackFault "InvalidClusterTrack" // The provided cluster track name is not valid. // // * ErrCodeSnapshotScheduleNotFoundFault "SnapshotScheduleNotFound" // We could not find the specified snapshot schedule. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/RestoreFromClusterSnapshot func (c *Redshift) RestoreFromClusterSnapshot(input *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput) (*RestoreFromClusterSnapshotOutput, error) { req, out := c.RestoreFromClusterSnapshotRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // RestoreFromClusterSnapshotWithContext is the same as RestoreFromClusterSnapshot with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See RestoreFromClusterSnapshot for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) RestoreFromClusterSnapshotWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput, opts ...request.Option) (*RestoreFromClusterSnapshotOutput, error) { req, out := c.RestoreFromClusterSnapshotRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opRestoreTableFromClusterSnapshot = "RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshot" // RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshot operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshot for more information on using the RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshot // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotRequest method. // req, resp := client.RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshot func (c *Redshift) RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotRequest(input *RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotInput) (req *request.Request, output *RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opRestoreTableFromClusterSnapshot, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotInput{} } output = &RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshot API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Creates a new table from a table in an Amazon Redshift cluster snapshot. // You must create the new table within the Amazon Redshift cluster that the // snapshot was taken from. // // You cannot use RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshot to restore a table with the // same name as an existing table in an Amazon Redshift cluster. That is, you // cannot overwrite an existing table in a cluster with a restored table. If // you want to replace your original table with a new, restored table, then // rename or drop your original table before you call RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshot. // When you have renamed your original table, then you can pass the original // name of the table as the NewTableName parameter value in the call to RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshot. // This way, you can replace the original table with the table created from // the snapshot. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshot for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault "ClusterSnapshotNotFound" // The snapshot identifier does not refer to an existing cluster snapshot. // // * ErrCodeInProgressTableRestoreQuotaExceededFault "InProgressTableRestoreQuotaExceededFault" // You have exceeded the allowed number of table restore requests. Wait for // your current table restore requests to complete before making a new request. // // * ErrCodeInvalidClusterSnapshotStateFault "InvalidClusterSnapshotState" // The specified cluster snapshot is not in the available state, or other accounts // are authorized to access the snapshot. // // * ErrCodeInvalidTableRestoreArgumentFault "InvalidTableRestoreArgument" // The value specified for the sourceDatabaseName, sourceSchemaName, or sourceTableName // parameter, or a combination of these, doesn't exist in the snapshot. // // * ErrCodeClusterNotFoundFault "ClusterNotFound" // The ClusterIdentifier parameter does not refer to an existing cluster. // // * ErrCodeInvalidClusterStateFault "InvalidClusterState" // The specified cluster is not in the available state. // // * ErrCodeUnsupportedOperationFault "UnsupportedOperation" // The requested operation isn't supported. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshot func (c *Redshift) RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshot(input *RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotInput) (*RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotOutput, error) { req, out := c.RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotWithContext is the same as RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshot with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshot for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotInput, opts ...request.Option) (*RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotOutput, error) { req, out := c.RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opRevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngress = "RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngress" // RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngressRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngress operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngress for more information on using the RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngress // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngressRequest method. // req, resp := client.RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngressRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngress func (c *Redshift) RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngressRequest(input *RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngressInput) (req *request.Request, output *RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngressOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opRevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngress, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngressInput{} } output = &RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngressOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngress API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Revokes an ingress rule in an Amazon Redshift security group for a previously // authorized IP range or Amazon EC2 security group. To add an ingress rule, // see AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngress. For information about managing // security groups, go to Amazon Redshift Cluster Security Groups (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-security-groups.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngress for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeClusterSecurityGroupNotFoundFault "ClusterSecurityGroupNotFound" // The cluster security group name does not refer to an existing cluster security // group. // // * ErrCodeAuthorizationNotFoundFault "AuthorizationNotFound" // The specified CIDR IP range or EC2 security group is not authorized for the // specified cluster security group. // // * ErrCodeInvalidClusterSecurityGroupStateFault "InvalidClusterSecurityGroupState" // The state of the cluster security group is not available. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngress func (c *Redshift) RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngress(input *RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngressInput) (*RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngressOutput, error) { req, out := c.RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngressRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngressWithContext is the same as RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngress with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngress for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngressWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngressInput, opts ...request.Option) (*RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngressOutput, error) { req, out := c.RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngressRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opRevokeSnapshotAccess = "RevokeSnapshotAccess" // RevokeSnapshotAccessRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the RevokeSnapshotAccess operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See RevokeSnapshotAccess for more information on using the RevokeSnapshotAccess // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the RevokeSnapshotAccessRequest method. // req, resp := client.RevokeSnapshotAccessRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/RevokeSnapshotAccess func (c *Redshift) RevokeSnapshotAccessRequest(input *RevokeSnapshotAccessInput) (req *request.Request, output *RevokeSnapshotAccessOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opRevokeSnapshotAccess, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &RevokeSnapshotAccessInput{} } output = &RevokeSnapshotAccessOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // RevokeSnapshotAccess API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Removes the ability of the specified AWS customer account to restore the // specified snapshot. If the account is currently restoring the snapshot, the // restore will run to completion. // // For more information about working with snapshots, go to Amazon Redshift // Snapshots (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-snapshots.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation RevokeSnapshotAccess for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeAccessToSnapshotDeniedFault "AccessToSnapshotDenied" // The owner of the specified snapshot has not authorized your account to access // the snapshot. // // * ErrCodeAuthorizationNotFoundFault "AuthorizationNotFound" // The specified CIDR IP range or EC2 security group is not authorized for the // specified cluster security group. // // * ErrCodeClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault "ClusterSnapshotNotFound" // The snapshot identifier does not refer to an existing cluster snapshot. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/RevokeSnapshotAccess func (c *Redshift) RevokeSnapshotAccess(input *RevokeSnapshotAccessInput) (*RevokeSnapshotAccessOutput, error) { req, out := c.RevokeSnapshotAccessRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // RevokeSnapshotAccessWithContext is the same as RevokeSnapshotAccess with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See RevokeSnapshotAccess for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) RevokeSnapshotAccessWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RevokeSnapshotAccessInput, opts ...request.Option) (*RevokeSnapshotAccessOutput, error) { req, out := c.RevokeSnapshotAccessRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } const opRotateEncryptionKey = "RotateEncryptionKey" // RotateEncryptionKeyRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the // client's request for the RotateEncryptionKey operation. The "output" return // value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes // successfully. // // Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. // the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error. // // See RotateEncryptionKey for more information on using the RotateEncryptionKey // API call, and error handling. // // This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration // into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic. // // // // Example sending a request using the RotateEncryptionKeyRequest method. // req, resp := client.RotateEncryptionKeyRequest(params) // // err := req.Send() // if err == nil { // resp is now filled // fmt.Println(resp) // } // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/RotateEncryptionKey func (c *Redshift) RotateEncryptionKeyRequest(input *RotateEncryptionKeyInput) (req *request.Request, output *RotateEncryptionKeyOutput) { op := &request.Operation{ Name: opRotateEncryptionKey, HTTPMethod: "POST", HTTPPath: "/", } if input == nil { input = &RotateEncryptionKeyInput{} } output = &RotateEncryptionKeyOutput{} req = c.newRequest(op, input, output) return } // RotateEncryptionKey API operation for Amazon Redshift. // // Rotates the encryption keys for a cluster. // // Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions // with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about // the error. // // See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Redshift's // API operation RotateEncryptionKey for usage and error information. // // Returned Error Codes: // * ErrCodeClusterNotFoundFault "ClusterNotFound" // The ClusterIdentifier parameter does not refer to an existing cluster. // // * ErrCodeInvalidClusterStateFault "InvalidClusterState" // The specified cluster is not in the available state. // // * ErrCodeDependentServiceRequestThrottlingFault "DependentServiceRequestThrottlingFault" // The request cannot be completed because a dependent service is throttling // requests made by Amazon Redshift on your behalf. Wait and retry the request. // // See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/redshift-2012-12-01/RotateEncryptionKey func (c *Redshift) RotateEncryptionKey(input *RotateEncryptionKeyInput) (*RotateEncryptionKeyOutput, error) { req, out := c.RotateEncryptionKeyRequest(input) return out, req.Send() } // RotateEncryptionKeyWithContext is the same as RotateEncryptionKey with the addition of // the ability to pass a context and additional request options. // // See RotateEncryptionKey for details on how to use this API operation. // // The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If // the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create // sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ // for more information on using Contexts. func (c *Redshift) RotateEncryptionKeyWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RotateEncryptionKeyInput, opts ...request.Option) (*RotateEncryptionKeyOutput, error) { req, out := c.RotateEncryptionKeyRequest(input) req.SetContext(ctx) req.ApplyOptions(opts...) return out, req.Send() } type AcceptReservedNodeExchangeInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A string representing the node identifier of the DC1 Reserved Node to be // exchanged. // // ReservedNodeId is a required field ReservedNodeId *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The unique identifier of the DC2 Reserved Node offering to be used for the // exchange. You can obtain the value for the parameter by calling GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferings // // TargetReservedNodeOfferingId is a required field TargetReservedNodeOfferingId *string `type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AcceptReservedNodeExchangeInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AcceptReservedNodeExchangeInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *AcceptReservedNodeExchangeInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AcceptReservedNodeExchangeInput"} if s.ReservedNodeId == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ReservedNodeId")) } if s.TargetReservedNodeOfferingId == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TargetReservedNodeOfferingId")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetReservedNodeId sets the ReservedNodeId field's value. func (s *AcceptReservedNodeExchangeInput) SetReservedNodeId(v string) *AcceptReservedNodeExchangeInput { s.ReservedNodeId = &v return s } // SetTargetReservedNodeOfferingId sets the TargetReservedNodeOfferingId field's value. func (s *AcceptReservedNodeExchangeInput) SetTargetReservedNodeOfferingId(v string) *AcceptReservedNodeExchangeInput { s.TargetReservedNodeOfferingId = &v return s } type AcceptReservedNodeExchangeOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Describes a reserved node. You can call the DescribeReservedNodeOfferings // API to obtain the available reserved node offerings. ExchangedReservedNode *ReservedNode `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AcceptReservedNodeExchangeOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AcceptReservedNodeExchangeOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetExchangedReservedNode sets the ExchangedReservedNode field's value. func (s *AcceptReservedNodeExchangeOutput) SetExchangedReservedNode(v *ReservedNode) *AcceptReservedNodeExchangeOutput { s.ExchangedReservedNode = v return s } // A name value pair that describes an aspect of an account. type AccountAttribute struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the attribute. AttributeName *string `type:"string"` // A list of attribute values. AttributeValues []*AttributeValueTarget `locationNameList:"AttributeValueTarget" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AccountAttribute) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AccountAttribute) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetAttributeName sets the AttributeName field's value. func (s *AccountAttribute) SetAttributeName(v string) *AccountAttribute { s.AttributeName = &v return s } // SetAttributeValues sets the AttributeValues field's value. func (s *AccountAttribute) SetAttributeValues(v []*AttributeValueTarget) *AccountAttribute { s.AttributeValues = v return s } // Describes an AWS customer account authorized to restore a snapshot. type AccountWithRestoreAccess struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The identifier of an AWS support account authorized to restore a snapshot. // For AWS support, the identifier is amazon-redshift-support. AccountAlias *string `type:"string"` // The identifier of an AWS customer account authorized to restore a snapshot. AccountId *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AccountWithRestoreAccess) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AccountWithRestoreAccess) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetAccountAlias sets the AccountAlias field's value. func (s *AccountWithRestoreAccess) SetAccountAlias(v string) *AccountWithRestoreAccess { s.AccountAlias = &v return s } // SetAccountId sets the AccountId field's value. func (s *AccountWithRestoreAccess) SetAccountId(v string) *AccountWithRestoreAccess { s.AccountId = &v return s } // Describes an attribute value. type AttributeValueTarget struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The value of the attribute. AttributeValue *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AttributeValueTarget) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AttributeValueTarget) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetAttributeValue sets the AttributeValue field's value. func (s *AttributeValueTarget) SetAttributeValue(v string) *AttributeValueTarget { s.AttributeValue = &v return s } type AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngressInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The IP range to be added the Amazon Redshift security group. CIDRIP *string `type:"string"` // The name of the security group to which the ingress rule is added. // // ClusterSecurityGroupName is a required field ClusterSecurityGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The EC2 security group to be added the Amazon Redshift security group. EC2SecurityGroupName *string `type:"string"` // The AWS account number of the owner of the security group specified by the // EC2SecurityGroupName parameter. The AWS Access Key ID is not an acceptable // value. // // Example: 111122223333 EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngressInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngressInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngressInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngressInput"} if s.ClusterSecurityGroupName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ClusterSecurityGroupName")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetCIDRIP sets the CIDRIP field's value. func (s *AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngressInput) SetCIDRIP(v string) *AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngressInput { s.CIDRIP = &v return s } // SetClusterSecurityGroupName sets the ClusterSecurityGroupName field's value. func (s *AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngressInput) SetClusterSecurityGroupName(v string) *AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngressInput { s.ClusterSecurityGroupName = &v return s } // SetEC2SecurityGroupName sets the EC2SecurityGroupName field's value. func (s *AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngressInput) SetEC2SecurityGroupName(v string) *AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngressInput { s.EC2SecurityGroupName = &v return s } // SetEC2SecurityGroupOwnerId sets the EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId field's value. func (s *AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngressInput) SetEC2SecurityGroupOwnerId(v string) *AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngressInput { s.EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId = &v return s } type AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngressOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Describes a security group. ClusterSecurityGroup *ClusterSecurityGroup `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngressOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngressOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetClusterSecurityGroup sets the ClusterSecurityGroup field's value. func (s *AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngressOutput) SetClusterSecurityGroup(v *ClusterSecurityGroup) *AuthorizeClusterSecurityGroupIngressOutput { s.ClusterSecurityGroup = v return s } type AuthorizeSnapshotAccessInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The identifier of the AWS customer account authorized to restore the specified // snapshot. // // To share a snapshot with AWS support, specify amazon-redshift-support. // // AccountWithRestoreAccess is a required field AccountWithRestoreAccess *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The identifier of the cluster the snapshot was created from. This parameter // is required if your IAM user has a policy containing a snapshot resource // element that specifies anything other than * for the cluster name. SnapshotClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // The identifier of the snapshot the account is authorized to restore. // // SnapshotIdentifier is a required field SnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AuthorizeSnapshotAccessInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AuthorizeSnapshotAccessInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *AuthorizeSnapshotAccessInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AuthorizeSnapshotAccessInput"} if s.AccountWithRestoreAccess == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("AccountWithRestoreAccess")) } if s.SnapshotIdentifier == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SnapshotIdentifier")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAccountWithRestoreAccess sets the AccountWithRestoreAccess field's value. func (s *AuthorizeSnapshotAccessInput) SetAccountWithRestoreAccess(v string) *AuthorizeSnapshotAccessInput { s.AccountWithRestoreAccess = &v return s } // SetSnapshotClusterIdentifier sets the SnapshotClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *AuthorizeSnapshotAccessInput) SetSnapshotClusterIdentifier(v string) *AuthorizeSnapshotAccessInput { s.SnapshotClusterIdentifier = &v return s } // SetSnapshotIdentifier sets the SnapshotIdentifier field's value. func (s *AuthorizeSnapshotAccessInput) SetSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *AuthorizeSnapshotAccessInput { s.SnapshotIdentifier = &v return s } type AuthorizeSnapshotAccessOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Describes a snapshot. Snapshot *Snapshot `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AuthorizeSnapshotAccessOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AuthorizeSnapshotAccessOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetSnapshot sets the Snapshot field's value. func (s *AuthorizeSnapshotAccessOutput) SetSnapshot(v *Snapshot) *AuthorizeSnapshotAccessOutput { s.Snapshot = v return s } // Describes an availability zone. type AvailabilityZone struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the availability zone. Name *string `type:"string"` SupportedPlatforms []*SupportedPlatform `locationNameList:"SupportedPlatform" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s AvailabilityZone) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s AvailabilityZone) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetName sets the Name field's value. func (s *AvailabilityZone) SetName(v string) *AvailabilityZone { s.Name = &v return s } // SetSupportedPlatforms sets the SupportedPlatforms field's value. func (s *AvailabilityZone) SetSupportedPlatforms(v []*SupportedPlatform) *AvailabilityZone { s.SupportedPlatforms = v return s } type BatchDeleteClusterSnapshotsInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A list of identifiers for the snapshots that you want to delete. // // Identifiers is a required field Identifiers []*DeleteClusterSnapshotMessage `locationNameList:"DeleteClusterSnapshotMessage" type:"list" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s BatchDeleteClusterSnapshotsInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s BatchDeleteClusterSnapshotsInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *BatchDeleteClusterSnapshotsInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "BatchDeleteClusterSnapshotsInput"} if s.Identifiers == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Identifiers")) } if s.Identifiers != nil { for i, v := range s.Identifiers { if v == nil { continue } if err := v.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Identifiers", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetIdentifiers sets the Identifiers field's value. func (s *BatchDeleteClusterSnapshotsInput) SetIdentifiers(v []*DeleteClusterSnapshotMessage) *BatchDeleteClusterSnapshotsInput { s.Identifiers = v return s } type BatchDeleteClusterSnapshotsOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A list of any errors returned. Errors []*SnapshotErrorMessage `locationNameList:"SnapshotErrorMessage" type:"list"` // A list of the snapshot identifiers that were deleted. Resources []*string `locationNameList:"String" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s BatchDeleteClusterSnapshotsOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s BatchDeleteClusterSnapshotsOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetErrors sets the Errors field's value. func (s *BatchDeleteClusterSnapshotsOutput) SetErrors(v []*SnapshotErrorMessage) *BatchDeleteClusterSnapshotsOutput { s.Errors = v return s } // SetResources sets the Resources field's value. func (s *BatchDeleteClusterSnapshotsOutput) SetResources(v []*string) *BatchDeleteClusterSnapshotsOutput { s.Resources = v return s } type BatchModifyClusterSnapshotsInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A boolean value indicating whether to override an exception if the retention // period has passed. Force *bool `type:"boolean"` // The number of days that a manual snapshot is retained. If you specify the // value -1, the manual snapshot is retained indefinitely. // // The number must be either -1 or an integer between 1 and 3,653. // // If you decrease the manual snapshot retention period from its current value, // existing manual snapshots that fall outside of the new retention period will // return an error. If you want to suppress the errors and delete the snapshots, // use the force option. ManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"` // A list of snapshot identifiers you want to modify. // // SnapshotIdentifierList is a required field SnapshotIdentifierList []*string `locationNameList:"String" type:"list" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s BatchModifyClusterSnapshotsInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s BatchModifyClusterSnapshotsInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *BatchModifyClusterSnapshotsInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "BatchModifyClusterSnapshotsInput"} if s.SnapshotIdentifierList == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SnapshotIdentifierList")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetForce sets the Force field's value. func (s *BatchModifyClusterSnapshotsInput) SetForce(v bool) *BatchModifyClusterSnapshotsInput { s.Force = &v return s } // SetManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod sets the ManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod field's value. func (s *BatchModifyClusterSnapshotsInput) SetManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod(v int64) *BatchModifyClusterSnapshotsInput { s.ManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod = &v return s } // SetSnapshotIdentifierList sets the SnapshotIdentifierList field's value. func (s *BatchModifyClusterSnapshotsInput) SetSnapshotIdentifierList(v []*string) *BatchModifyClusterSnapshotsInput { s.SnapshotIdentifierList = v return s } type BatchModifyClusterSnapshotsOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A list of any errors returned. Errors []*SnapshotErrorMessage `locationNameList:"SnapshotErrorMessage" type:"list"` // A list of the snapshots that were modified. Resources []*string `locationNameList:"String" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s BatchModifyClusterSnapshotsOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s BatchModifyClusterSnapshotsOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetErrors sets the Errors field's value. func (s *BatchModifyClusterSnapshotsOutput) SetErrors(v []*SnapshotErrorMessage) *BatchModifyClusterSnapshotsOutput { s.Errors = v return s } // SetResources sets the Resources field's value. func (s *BatchModifyClusterSnapshotsOutput) SetResources(v []*string) *BatchModifyClusterSnapshotsOutput { s.Resources = v return s } type CancelResizeInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The unique identifier for the cluster that you want to cancel a resize operation // for. // // ClusterIdentifier is a required field ClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CancelResizeInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CancelResizeInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *CancelResizeInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CancelResizeInput"} if s.ClusterIdentifier == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ClusterIdentifier")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetClusterIdentifier sets the ClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *CancelResizeInput) SetClusterIdentifier(v string) *CancelResizeInput { s.ClusterIdentifier = &v return s } // Describes the result of a cluster resize operation. type CancelResizeOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The average rate of the resize operation over the last few minutes, measured // in megabytes per second. After the resize operation completes, this value // shows the average rate of the entire resize operation. AvgResizeRateInMegaBytesPerSecond *float64 `type:"double"` // The amount of seconds that have elapsed since the resize operation began. // After the resize operation completes, this value shows the total actual time, // in seconds, for the resize operation. ElapsedTimeInSeconds *int64 `type:"long"` // The estimated time remaining, in seconds, until the resize operation is complete. // This value is calculated based on the average resize rate and the estimated // amount of data remaining to be processed. Once the resize operation is complete, // this value will be 0. EstimatedTimeToCompletionInSeconds *int64 `type:"long"` // The names of tables that have been completely imported . // // Valid Values: List of table names. ImportTablesCompleted []*string `type:"list"` // The names of tables that are being currently imported. // // Valid Values: List of table names. ImportTablesInProgress []*string `type:"list"` // The names of tables that have not been yet imported. // // Valid Values: List of table names ImportTablesNotStarted []*string `type:"list"` // An optional string to provide additional details about the resize action. Message *string `type:"string"` // While the resize operation is in progress, this value shows the current amount // of data, in megabytes, that has been processed so far. When the resize operation // is complete, this value shows the total amount of data, in megabytes, on // the cluster, which may be more or less than TotalResizeDataInMegaBytes (the // estimated total amount of data before resize). ProgressInMegaBytes *int64 `type:"long"` // An enum with possible values of ClassicResize and ElasticResize. These values // describe the type of resize operation being performed. ResizeType *string `type:"string"` // The status of the resize operation. // // Valid Values: NONE | IN_PROGRESS | FAILED | SUCCEEDED | CANCELLING Status *string `type:"string"` // The cluster type after the resize operation is complete. // // Valid Values: multi-node | single-node TargetClusterType *string `type:"string"` // The type of encryption for the cluster after the resize is complete. // // Possible values are KMS and None. In the China region possible values are: // Legacy and None. TargetEncryptionType *string `type:"string"` // The node type that the cluster will have after the resize operation is complete. TargetNodeType *string `type:"string"` // The number of nodes that the cluster will have after the resize operation // is complete. TargetNumberOfNodes *int64 `type:"integer"` // The estimated total amount of data, in megabytes, on the cluster before the // resize operation began. TotalResizeDataInMegaBytes *int64 `type:"long"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CancelResizeOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CancelResizeOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetAvgResizeRateInMegaBytesPerSecond sets the AvgResizeRateInMegaBytesPerSecond field's value. func (s *CancelResizeOutput) SetAvgResizeRateInMegaBytesPerSecond(v float64) *CancelResizeOutput { s.AvgResizeRateInMegaBytesPerSecond = &v return s } // SetElapsedTimeInSeconds sets the ElapsedTimeInSeconds field's value. func (s *CancelResizeOutput) SetElapsedTimeInSeconds(v int64) *CancelResizeOutput { s.ElapsedTimeInSeconds = &v return s } // SetEstimatedTimeToCompletionInSeconds sets the EstimatedTimeToCompletionInSeconds field's value. func (s *CancelResizeOutput) SetEstimatedTimeToCompletionInSeconds(v int64) *CancelResizeOutput { s.EstimatedTimeToCompletionInSeconds = &v return s } // SetImportTablesCompleted sets the ImportTablesCompleted field's value. func (s *CancelResizeOutput) SetImportTablesCompleted(v []*string) *CancelResizeOutput { s.ImportTablesCompleted = v return s } // SetImportTablesInProgress sets the ImportTablesInProgress field's value. func (s *CancelResizeOutput) SetImportTablesInProgress(v []*string) *CancelResizeOutput { s.ImportTablesInProgress = v return s } // SetImportTablesNotStarted sets the ImportTablesNotStarted field's value. func (s *CancelResizeOutput) SetImportTablesNotStarted(v []*string) *CancelResizeOutput { s.ImportTablesNotStarted = v return s } // SetMessage sets the Message field's value. func (s *CancelResizeOutput) SetMessage(v string) *CancelResizeOutput { s.Message = &v return s } // SetProgressInMegaBytes sets the ProgressInMegaBytes field's value. func (s *CancelResizeOutput) SetProgressInMegaBytes(v int64) *CancelResizeOutput { s.ProgressInMegaBytes = &v return s } // SetResizeType sets the ResizeType field's value. func (s *CancelResizeOutput) SetResizeType(v string) *CancelResizeOutput { s.ResizeType = &v return s } // SetStatus sets the Status field's value. func (s *CancelResizeOutput) SetStatus(v string) *CancelResizeOutput { s.Status = &v return s } // SetTargetClusterType sets the TargetClusterType field's value. func (s *CancelResizeOutput) SetTargetClusterType(v string) *CancelResizeOutput { s.TargetClusterType = &v return s } // SetTargetEncryptionType sets the TargetEncryptionType field's value. func (s *CancelResizeOutput) SetTargetEncryptionType(v string) *CancelResizeOutput { s.TargetEncryptionType = &v return s } // SetTargetNodeType sets the TargetNodeType field's value. func (s *CancelResizeOutput) SetTargetNodeType(v string) *CancelResizeOutput { s.TargetNodeType = &v return s } // SetTargetNumberOfNodes sets the TargetNumberOfNodes field's value. func (s *CancelResizeOutput) SetTargetNumberOfNodes(v int64) *CancelResizeOutput { s.TargetNumberOfNodes = &v return s } // SetTotalResizeDataInMegaBytes sets the TotalResizeDataInMegaBytes field's value. func (s *CancelResizeOutput) SetTotalResizeDataInMegaBytes(v int64) *CancelResizeOutput { s.TotalResizeDataInMegaBytes = &v return s } // Describes a cluster. type Cluster struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A boolean value that, if true, indicates that major version upgrades will // be applied automatically to the cluster during the maintenance window. AllowVersionUpgrade *bool `type:"boolean"` // The number of days that automatic cluster snapshots are retained. AutomatedSnapshotRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"` // The name of the Availability Zone in which the cluster is located. AvailabilityZone *string `type:"string"` // The date and time that the cluster was created. ClusterCreateTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"` // The unique identifier of the cluster. ClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // The nodes in the cluster. ClusterNodes []*ClusterNode `type:"list"` // The list of cluster parameter groups that are associated with this cluster. // Each parameter group in the list is returned with its status. ClusterParameterGroups []*ClusterParameterGroupStatus `locationNameList:"ClusterParameterGroup" type:"list"` // The public key for the cluster. ClusterPublicKey *string `type:"string"` // The specific revision number of the database in the cluster. ClusterRevisionNumber *string `type:"string"` // A list of cluster security group that are associated with the cluster. Each // security group is represented by an element that contains ClusterSecurityGroup.Name // and ClusterSecurityGroup.Status subelements. // // Cluster security groups are used when the cluster is not created in an Amazon // Virtual Private Cloud (VPC). Clusters that are created in a VPC use VPC security // groups, which are listed by the VpcSecurityGroups parameter. ClusterSecurityGroups []*ClusterSecurityGroupMembership `locationNameList:"ClusterSecurityGroup" type:"list"` // A value that returns the destination region and retention period that are // configured for cross-region snapshot copy. ClusterSnapshotCopyStatus *ClusterSnapshotCopyStatus `type:"structure"` // The current state of the cluster. Possible values are the following: // // * available // // * available, prep-for-resize // // * available, resize-cleanup // // * cancelling-resize // // * creating // // * deleting // // * final-snapshot // // * hardware-failure // // * incompatible-hsm // // * incompatible-network // // * incompatible-parameters // // * incompatible-restore // // * modifying // // * rebooting // // * renaming // // * resizing // // * rotating-keys // // * storage-full // // * updating-hsm ClusterStatus *string `type:"string"` // The name of the subnet group that is associated with the cluster. This parameter // is valid only when the cluster is in a VPC. ClusterSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"` // The version ID of the Amazon Redshift engine that is running on the cluster. ClusterVersion *string `type:"string"` // The name of the initial database that was created when the cluster was created. // This same name is returned for the life of the cluster. If an initial database // was not specified, a database named devdev was created by default. DBName *string `type:"string"` // Describes the status of a cluster while it is in the process of resizing // with an incremental resize. DataTransferProgress *DataTransferProgress `type:"structure"` // Describes a group of DeferredMaintenanceWindow objects. DeferredMaintenanceWindows []*DeferredMaintenanceWindow `locationNameList:"DeferredMaintenanceWindow" type:"list"` // The status of the elastic IP (EIP) address. ElasticIpStatus *ElasticIpStatus `type:"structure"` // The number of nodes that you can resize the cluster to with the elastic resize // method. ElasticResizeNumberOfNodeOptions *string `type:"string"` // A boolean value that, if true, indicates that data in the cluster is encrypted // at rest. Encrypted *bool `type:"boolean"` // The connection endpoint. Endpoint *Endpoint `type:"structure"` // An option that specifies whether to create the cluster with enhanced VPC // routing enabled. To create a cluster that uses enhanced VPC routing, the // cluster must be in a VPC. For more information, see Enhanced VPC Routing // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/enhanced-vpc-routing.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // If this option is true, enhanced VPC routing is enabled. // // Default: false EnhancedVpcRouting *bool `type:"boolean"` // A value that reports whether the Amazon Redshift cluster has finished applying // any hardware security module (HSM) settings changes specified in a modify // cluster command. // // Values: active, applying HsmStatus *HsmStatus `type:"structure"` // A list of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) roles that can be used // by the cluster to access other AWS services. IamRoles []*ClusterIamRole `locationNameList:"ClusterIamRole" type:"list"` // The AWS Key Management Service (AWS KMS) key ID of the encryption key used // to encrypt data in the cluster. KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"` // The name of the maintenance track for the cluster. MaintenanceTrackName *string `type:"string"` // The default number of days to retain a manual snapshot. If the value is -1, // the snapshot is retained indefinitely. This setting doesn't change the retention // period of existing snapshots. // // The value must be either -1 or an integer between 1 and 3,653. ManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"` // The master user name for the cluster. This name is used to connect to the // database that is specified in the DBName parameter. MasterUsername *string `type:"string"` // The status of a modify operation, if any, initiated for the cluster. ModifyStatus *string `type:"string"` // The node type for the nodes in the cluster. NodeType *string `type:"string"` // The number of compute nodes in the cluster. NumberOfNodes *int64 `type:"integer"` // Cluster operations that are waiting to be started. PendingActions []*string `type:"list"` // A value that, if present, indicates that changes to the cluster are pending. // Specific pending changes are identified by subelements. PendingModifiedValues *PendingModifiedValues `type:"structure"` // The weekly time range, in Universal Coordinated Time (UTC), during which // system maintenance can occur. PreferredMaintenanceWindow *string `type:"string"` // A boolean value that, if true, indicates that the cluster can be accessed // from a public network. PubliclyAccessible *bool `type:"boolean"` // Returns the following: // // * AllowCancelResize: a boolean value indicating if the resize operation // can be cancelled. // // * ResizeType: Returns ClassicResize ResizeInfo *ResizeInfo `type:"structure"` // A value that describes the status of a cluster restore action. This parameter // returns null if the cluster was not created by restoring a snapshot. RestoreStatus *RestoreStatus `type:"structure"` // A unique identifier for the cluster snapshot schedule. SnapshotScheduleIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // The current state of the cluster snapshot schedule. SnapshotScheduleState *string `type:"string" enum:"ScheduleState"` // The list of tags for the cluster. Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"` // The identifier of the VPC the cluster is in, if the cluster is in a VPC. VpcId *string `type:"string"` // A list of Amazon Virtual Private Cloud (Amazon VPC) security groups that // are associated with the cluster. This parameter is returned only if the cluster // is in a VPC. VpcSecurityGroups []*VpcSecurityGroupMembership `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroup" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s Cluster) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s Cluster) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetAllowVersionUpgrade sets the AllowVersionUpgrade field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetAllowVersionUpgrade(v bool) *Cluster { s.AllowVersionUpgrade = &v return s } // SetAutomatedSnapshotRetentionPeriod sets the AutomatedSnapshotRetentionPeriod field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetAutomatedSnapshotRetentionPeriod(v int64) *Cluster { s.AutomatedSnapshotRetentionPeriod = &v return s } // SetAvailabilityZone sets the AvailabilityZone field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetAvailabilityZone(v string) *Cluster { s.AvailabilityZone = &v return s } // SetClusterCreateTime sets the ClusterCreateTime field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetClusterCreateTime(v time.Time) *Cluster { s.ClusterCreateTime = &v return s } // SetClusterIdentifier sets the ClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetClusterIdentifier(v string) *Cluster { s.ClusterIdentifier = &v return s } // SetClusterNodes sets the ClusterNodes field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetClusterNodes(v []*ClusterNode) *Cluster { s.ClusterNodes = v return s } // SetClusterParameterGroups sets the ClusterParameterGroups field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetClusterParameterGroups(v []*ClusterParameterGroupStatus) *Cluster { s.ClusterParameterGroups = v return s } // SetClusterPublicKey sets the ClusterPublicKey field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetClusterPublicKey(v string) *Cluster { s.ClusterPublicKey = &v return s } // SetClusterRevisionNumber sets the ClusterRevisionNumber field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetClusterRevisionNumber(v string) *Cluster { s.ClusterRevisionNumber = &v return s } // SetClusterSecurityGroups sets the ClusterSecurityGroups field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetClusterSecurityGroups(v []*ClusterSecurityGroupMembership) *Cluster { s.ClusterSecurityGroups = v return s } // SetClusterSnapshotCopyStatus sets the ClusterSnapshotCopyStatus field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetClusterSnapshotCopyStatus(v *ClusterSnapshotCopyStatus) *Cluster { s.ClusterSnapshotCopyStatus = v return s } // SetClusterStatus sets the ClusterStatus field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetClusterStatus(v string) *Cluster { s.ClusterStatus = &v return s } // SetClusterSubnetGroupName sets the ClusterSubnetGroupName field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetClusterSubnetGroupName(v string) *Cluster { s.ClusterSubnetGroupName = &v return s } // SetClusterVersion sets the ClusterVersion field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetClusterVersion(v string) *Cluster { s.ClusterVersion = &v return s } // SetDBName sets the DBName field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetDBName(v string) *Cluster { s.DBName = &v return s } // SetDataTransferProgress sets the DataTransferProgress field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetDataTransferProgress(v *DataTransferProgress) *Cluster { s.DataTransferProgress = v return s } // SetDeferredMaintenanceWindows sets the DeferredMaintenanceWindows field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetDeferredMaintenanceWindows(v []*DeferredMaintenanceWindow) *Cluster { s.DeferredMaintenanceWindows = v return s } // SetElasticIpStatus sets the ElasticIpStatus field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetElasticIpStatus(v *ElasticIpStatus) *Cluster { s.ElasticIpStatus = v return s } // SetElasticResizeNumberOfNodeOptions sets the ElasticResizeNumberOfNodeOptions field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetElasticResizeNumberOfNodeOptions(v string) *Cluster { s.ElasticResizeNumberOfNodeOptions = &v return s } // SetEncrypted sets the Encrypted field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetEncrypted(v bool) *Cluster { s.Encrypted = &v return s } // SetEndpoint sets the Endpoint field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetEndpoint(v *Endpoint) *Cluster { s.Endpoint = v return s } // SetEnhancedVpcRouting sets the EnhancedVpcRouting field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetEnhancedVpcRouting(v bool) *Cluster { s.EnhancedVpcRouting = &v return s } // SetHsmStatus sets the HsmStatus field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetHsmStatus(v *HsmStatus) *Cluster { s.HsmStatus = v return s } // SetIamRoles sets the IamRoles field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetIamRoles(v []*ClusterIamRole) *Cluster { s.IamRoles = v return s } // SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetKmsKeyId(v string) *Cluster { s.KmsKeyId = &v return s } // SetMaintenanceTrackName sets the MaintenanceTrackName field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetMaintenanceTrackName(v string) *Cluster { s.MaintenanceTrackName = &v return s } // SetManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod sets the ManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod(v int64) *Cluster { s.ManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod = &v return s } // SetMasterUsername sets the MasterUsername field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetMasterUsername(v string) *Cluster { s.MasterUsername = &v return s } // SetModifyStatus sets the ModifyStatus field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetModifyStatus(v string) *Cluster { s.ModifyStatus = &v return s } // SetNodeType sets the NodeType field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetNodeType(v string) *Cluster { s.NodeType = &v return s } // SetNumberOfNodes sets the NumberOfNodes field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetNumberOfNodes(v int64) *Cluster { s.NumberOfNodes = &v return s } // SetPendingActions sets the PendingActions field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetPendingActions(v []*string) *Cluster { s.PendingActions = v return s } // SetPendingModifiedValues sets the PendingModifiedValues field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetPendingModifiedValues(v *PendingModifiedValues) *Cluster { s.PendingModifiedValues = v return s } // SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow sets the PreferredMaintenanceWindow field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow(v string) *Cluster { s.PreferredMaintenanceWindow = &v return s } // SetPubliclyAccessible sets the PubliclyAccessible field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetPubliclyAccessible(v bool) *Cluster { s.PubliclyAccessible = &v return s } // SetResizeInfo sets the ResizeInfo field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetResizeInfo(v *ResizeInfo) *Cluster { s.ResizeInfo = v return s } // SetRestoreStatus sets the RestoreStatus field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetRestoreStatus(v *RestoreStatus) *Cluster { s.RestoreStatus = v return s } // SetSnapshotScheduleIdentifier sets the SnapshotScheduleIdentifier field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetSnapshotScheduleIdentifier(v string) *Cluster { s.SnapshotScheduleIdentifier = &v return s } // SetSnapshotScheduleState sets the SnapshotScheduleState field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetSnapshotScheduleState(v string) *Cluster { s.SnapshotScheduleState = &v return s } // SetTags sets the Tags field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetTags(v []*Tag) *Cluster { s.Tags = v return s } // SetVpcId sets the VpcId field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetVpcId(v string) *Cluster { s.VpcId = &v return s } // SetVpcSecurityGroups sets the VpcSecurityGroups field's value. func (s *Cluster) SetVpcSecurityGroups(v []*VpcSecurityGroupMembership) *Cluster { s.VpcSecurityGroups = v return s } type ClusterAssociatedToSchedule struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` ClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"` ScheduleAssociationState *string `type:"string" enum:"ScheduleState"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ClusterAssociatedToSchedule) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ClusterAssociatedToSchedule) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetClusterIdentifier sets the ClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *ClusterAssociatedToSchedule) SetClusterIdentifier(v string) *ClusterAssociatedToSchedule { s.ClusterIdentifier = &v return s } // SetScheduleAssociationState sets the ScheduleAssociationState field's value. func (s *ClusterAssociatedToSchedule) SetScheduleAssociationState(v string) *ClusterAssociatedToSchedule { s.ScheduleAssociationState = &v return s } // Describes a ClusterDbRevision. type ClusterDbRevision struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The unique identifier of the cluster. ClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // A string representing the current cluster version. CurrentDatabaseRevision *string `type:"string"` // The date on which the database revision was released. DatabaseRevisionReleaseDate *time.Time `type:"timestamp"` // A list of RevisionTarget objects, where each object describes the database // revision that a cluster can be updated to. RevisionTargets []*RevisionTarget `locationNameList:"RevisionTarget" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ClusterDbRevision) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ClusterDbRevision) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetClusterIdentifier sets the ClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *ClusterDbRevision) SetClusterIdentifier(v string) *ClusterDbRevision { s.ClusterIdentifier = &v return s } // SetCurrentDatabaseRevision sets the CurrentDatabaseRevision field's value. func (s *ClusterDbRevision) SetCurrentDatabaseRevision(v string) *ClusterDbRevision { s.CurrentDatabaseRevision = &v return s } // SetDatabaseRevisionReleaseDate sets the DatabaseRevisionReleaseDate field's value. func (s *ClusterDbRevision) SetDatabaseRevisionReleaseDate(v time.Time) *ClusterDbRevision { s.DatabaseRevisionReleaseDate = &v return s } // SetRevisionTargets sets the RevisionTargets field's value. func (s *ClusterDbRevision) SetRevisionTargets(v []*RevisionTarget) *ClusterDbRevision { s.RevisionTargets = v return s } // An AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) role that can be used by the // associated Amazon Redshift cluster to access other AWS services. type ClusterIamRole struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A value that describes the status of the IAM role's association with an Amazon // Redshift cluster. // // The following are possible statuses and descriptions. // // * in-sync: The role is available for use by the cluster. // // * adding: The role is in the process of being associated with the cluster. // // * removing: The role is in the process of being disassociated with the // cluster. ApplyStatus *string `type:"string"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM role, for example, arn:aws:iam::123456789012:role/RedshiftCopyUnload. IamRoleArn *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ClusterIamRole) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ClusterIamRole) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetApplyStatus sets the ApplyStatus field's value. func (s *ClusterIamRole) SetApplyStatus(v string) *ClusterIamRole { s.ApplyStatus = &v return s } // SetIamRoleArn sets the IamRoleArn field's value. func (s *ClusterIamRole) SetIamRoleArn(v string) *ClusterIamRole { s.IamRoleArn = &v return s } // The identifier of a node in a cluster. type ClusterNode struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Whether the node is a leader node or a compute node. NodeRole *string `type:"string"` // The private IP address of a node within a cluster. PrivateIPAddress *string `type:"string"` // The public IP address of a node within a cluster. PublicIPAddress *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ClusterNode) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ClusterNode) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetNodeRole sets the NodeRole field's value. func (s *ClusterNode) SetNodeRole(v string) *ClusterNode { s.NodeRole = &v return s } // SetPrivateIPAddress sets the PrivateIPAddress field's value. func (s *ClusterNode) SetPrivateIPAddress(v string) *ClusterNode { s.PrivateIPAddress = &v return s } // SetPublicIPAddress sets the PublicIPAddress field's value. func (s *ClusterNode) SetPublicIPAddress(v string) *ClusterNode { s.PublicIPAddress = &v return s } // Describes a parameter group. type ClusterParameterGroup struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The description of the parameter group. Description *string `type:"string"` // The name of the cluster parameter group family that this cluster parameter // group is compatible with. ParameterGroupFamily *string `type:"string"` // The name of the cluster parameter group. ParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"` // The list of tags for the cluster parameter group. Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ClusterParameterGroup) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ClusterParameterGroup) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetDescription sets the Description field's value. func (s *ClusterParameterGroup) SetDescription(v string) *ClusterParameterGroup { s.Description = &v return s } // SetParameterGroupFamily sets the ParameterGroupFamily field's value. func (s *ClusterParameterGroup) SetParameterGroupFamily(v string) *ClusterParameterGroup { s.ParameterGroupFamily = &v return s } // SetParameterGroupName sets the ParameterGroupName field's value. func (s *ClusterParameterGroup) SetParameterGroupName(v string) *ClusterParameterGroup { s.ParameterGroupName = &v return s } // SetTags sets the Tags field's value. func (s *ClusterParameterGroup) SetTags(v []*Tag) *ClusterParameterGroup { s.Tags = v return s } type ClusterParameterGroupNameMessage struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the cluster parameter group. ParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"` // The status of the parameter group. For example, if you made a change to a // parameter group name-value pair, then the change could be pending a reboot // of an associated cluster. ParameterGroupStatus *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ClusterParameterGroupNameMessage) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ClusterParameterGroupNameMessage) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetParameterGroupName sets the ParameterGroupName field's value. func (s *ClusterParameterGroupNameMessage) SetParameterGroupName(v string) *ClusterParameterGroupNameMessage { s.ParameterGroupName = &v return s } // SetParameterGroupStatus sets the ParameterGroupStatus field's value. func (s *ClusterParameterGroupNameMessage) SetParameterGroupStatus(v string) *ClusterParameterGroupNameMessage { s.ParameterGroupStatus = &v return s } // Describes the status of a parameter group. type ClusterParameterGroupStatus struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The list of parameter statuses. // // For more information about parameters and parameter groups, go to Amazon // Redshift Parameter Groups (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-parameter-groups.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. ClusterParameterStatusList []*ClusterParameterStatus `type:"list"` // The status of parameter updates. ParameterApplyStatus *string `type:"string"` // The name of the cluster parameter group. ParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ClusterParameterGroupStatus) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ClusterParameterGroupStatus) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetClusterParameterStatusList sets the ClusterParameterStatusList field's value. func (s *ClusterParameterGroupStatus) SetClusterParameterStatusList(v []*ClusterParameterStatus) *ClusterParameterGroupStatus { s.ClusterParameterStatusList = v return s } // SetParameterApplyStatus sets the ParameterApplyStatus field's value. func (s *ClusterParameterGroupStatus) SetParameterApplyStatus(v string) *ClusterParameterGroupStatus { s.ParameterApplyStatus = &v return s } // SetParameterGroupName sets the ParameterGroupName field's value. func (s *ClusterParameterGroupStatus) SetParameterGroupName(v string) *ClusterParameterGroupStatus { s.ParameterGroupName = &v return s } // Describes the status of a parameter group. type ClusterParameterStatus struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The error that prevented the parameter from being applied to the database. ParameterApplyErrorDescription *string `type:"string"` // The status of the parameter that indicates whether the parameter is in sync // with the database, waiting for a cluster reboot, or encountered an error // when being applied. // // The following are possible statuses and descriptions. // // * in-sync: The parameter value is in sync with the database. // // * pending-reboot: The parameter value will be applied after the cluster // reboots. // // * applying: The parameter value is being applied to the database. // // * invalid-parameter: Cannot apply the parameter value because it has an // invalid value or syntax. // // * apply-deferred: The parameter contains static property changes. The // changes are deferred until the cluster reboots. // // * apply-error: Cannot connect to the cluster. The parameter change will // be applied after the cluster reboots. // // * unknown-error: Cannot apply the parameter change right now. The change // will be applied after the cluster reboots. ParameterApplyStatus *string `type:"string"` // The name of the parameter. ParameterName *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ClusterParameterStatus) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ClusterParameterStatus) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetParameterApplyErrorDescription sets the ParameterApplyErrorDescription field's value. func (s *ClusterParameterStatus) SetParameterApplyErrorDescription(v string) *ClusterParameterStatus { s.ParameterApplyErrorDescription = &v return s } // SetParameterApplyStatus sets the ParameterApplyStatus field's value. func (s *ClusterParameterStatus) SetParameterApplyStatus(v string) *ClusterParameterStatus { s.ParameterApplyStatus = &v return s } // SetParameterName sets the ParameterName field's value. func (s *ClusterParameterStatus) SetParameterName(v string) *ClusterParameterStatus { s.ParameterName = &v return s } // Describes a security group. type ClusterSecurityGroup struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the cluster security group to which the operation was applied. ClusterSecurityGroupName *string `type:"string"` // A description of the security group. Description *string `type:"string"` // A list of EC2 security groups that are permitted to access clusters associated // with this cluster security group. EC2SecurityGroups []*EC2SecurityGroup `locationNameList:"EC2SecurityGroup" type:"list"` // A list of IP ranges (CIDR blocks) that are permitted to access clusters associated // with this cluster security group. IPRanges []*IPRange `locationNameList:"IPRange" type:"list"` // The list of tags for the cluster security group. Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ClusterSecurityGroup) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ClusterSecurityGroup) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetClusterSecurityGroupName sets the ClusterSecurityGroupName field's value. func (s *ClusterSecurityGroup) SetClusterSecurityGroupName(v string) *ClusterSecurityGroup { s.ClusterSecurityGroupName = &v return s } // SetDescription sets the Description field's value. func (s *ClusterSecurityGroup) SetDescription(v string) *ClusterSecurityGroup { s.Description = &v return s } // SetEC2SecurityGroups sets the EC2SecurityGroups field's value. func (s *ClusterSecurityGroup) SetEC2SecurityGroups(v []*EC2SecurityGroup) *ClusterSecurityGroup { s.EC2SecurityGroups = v return s } // SetIPRanges sets the IPRanges field's value. func (s *ClusterSecurityGroup) SetIPRanges(v []*IPRange) *ClusterSecurityGroup { s.IPRanges = v return s } // SetTags sets the Tags field's value. func (s *ClusterSecurityGroup) SetTags(v []*Tag) *ClusterSecurityGroup { s.Tags = v return s } // Describes a cluster security group. type ClusterSecurityGroupMembership struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the cluster security group. ClusterSecurityGroupName *string `type:"string"` // The status of the cluster security group. Status *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ClusterSecurityGroupMembership) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ClusterSecurityGroupMembership) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetClusterSecurityGroupName sets the ClusterSecurityGroupName field's value. func (s *ClusterSecurityGroupMembership) SetClusterSecurityGroupName(v string) *ClusterSecurityGroupMembership { s.ClusterSecurityGroupName = &v return s } // SetStatus sets the Status field's value. func (s *ClusterSecurityGroupMembership) SetStatus(v string) *ClusterSecurityGroupMembership { s.Status = &v return s } // Returns the destination region and retention period that are configured for // cross-region snapshot copy. type ClusterSnapshotCopyStatus struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The destination region that snapshots are automatically copied to when cross-region // snapshot copy is enabled. DestinationRegion *string `type:"string"` // The number of days that automated snapshots are retained in the destination // region after they are copied from a source region. If the value is -1, the // manual snapshot is retained indefinitely. // // The value must be either -1 or an integer between 1 and 3,653. ManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"` // The number of days that automated snapshots are retained in the destination // region after they are copied from a source region. RetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"long"` // The name of the snapshot copy grant. SnapshotCopyGrantName *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ClusterSnapshotCopyStatus) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ClusterSnapshotCopyStatus) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetDestinationRegion sets the DestinationRegion field's value. func (s *ClusterSnapshotCopyStatus) SetDestinationRegion(v string) *ClusterSnapshotCopyStatus { s.DestinationRegion = &v return s } // SetManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod sets the ManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod field's value. func (s *ClusterSnapshotCopyStatus) SetManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod(v int64) *ClusterSnapshotCopyStatus { s.ManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod = &v return s } // SetRetentionPeriod sets the RetentionPeriod field's value. func (s *ClusterSnapshotCopyStatus) SetRetentionPeriod(v int64) *ClusterSnapshotCopyStatus { s.RetentionPeriod = &v return s } // SetSnapshotCopyGrantName sets the SnapshotCopyGrantName field's value. func (s *ClusterSnapshotCopyStatus) SetSnapshotCopyGrantName(v string) *ClusterSnapshotCopyStatus { s.SnapshotCopyGrantName = &v return s } // Describes a subnet group. type ClusterSubnetGroup struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the cluster subnet group. ClusterSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"` // The description of the cluster subnet group. Description *string `type:"string"` // The status of the cluster subnet group. Possible values are Complete, Incomplete // and Invalid. SubnetGroupStatus *string `type:"string"` // A list of the VPC Subnet elements. Subnets []*Subnet `locationNameList:"Subnet" type:"list"` // The list of tags for the cluster subnet group. Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"` // The VPC ID of the cluster subnet group. VpcId *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ClusterSubnetGroup) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ClusterSubnetGroup) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetClusterSubnetGroupName sets the ClusterSubnetGroupName field's value. func (s *ClusterSubnetGroup) SetClusterSubnetGroupName(v string) *ClusterSubnetGroup { s.ClusterSubnetGroupName = &v return s } // SetDescription sets the Description field's value. func (s *ClusterSubnetGroup) SetDescription(v string) *ClusterSubnetGroup { s.Description = &v return s } // SetSubnetGroupStatus sets the SubnetGroupStatus field's value. func (s *ClusterSubnetGroup) SetSubnetGroupStatus(v string) *ClusterSubnetGroup { s.SubnetGroupStatus = &v return s } // SetSubnets sets the Subnets field's value. func (s *ClusterSubnetGroup) SetSubnets(v []*Subnet) *ClusterSubnetGroup { s.Subnets = v return s } // SetTags sets the Tags field's value. func (s *ClusterSubnetGroup) SetTags(v []*Tag) *ClusterSubnetGroup { s.Tags = v return s } // SetVpcId sets the VpcId field's value. func (s *ClusterSubnetGroup) SetVpcId(v string) *ClusterSubnetGroup { s.VpcId = &v return s } // Describes a cluster version, including the parameter group family and description // of the version. type ClusterVersion struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the cluster parameter group family for the cluster. ClusterParameterGroupFamily *string `type:"string"` // The version number used by the cluster. ClusterVersion *string `type:"string"` // The description of the cluster version. Description *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ClusterVersion) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ClusterVersion) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetClusterParameterGroupFamily sets the ClusterParameterGroupFamily field's value. func (s *ClusterVersion) SetClusterParameterGroupFamily(v string) *ClusterVersion { s.ClusterParameterGroupFamily = &v return s } // SetClusterVersion sets the ClusterVersion field's value. func (s *ClusterVersion) SetClusterVersion(v string) *ClusterVersion { s.ClusterVersion = &v return s } // SetDescription sets the Description field's value. func (s *ClusterVersion) SetDescription(v string) *ClusterVersion { s.Description = &v return s } type CopyClusterSnapshotInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The number of days that a manual snapshot is retained. If the value is -1, // the manual snapshot is retained indefinitely. // // The value must be either -1 or an integer between 1 and 3,653. // // The default value is -1. ManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"` // The identifier of the cluster the source snapshot was created from. This // parameter is required if your IAM user has a policy containing a snapshot // resource element that specifies anything other than * for the cluster name. // // Constraints: // // * Must be the identifier for a valid cluster. SourceSnapshotClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // The identifier for the source snapshot. // // Constraints: // // * Must be the identifier for a valid automated snapshot whose state is // available. // // SourceSnapshotIdentifier is a required field SourceSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The identifier given to the new manual snapshot. // // Constraints: // // * Cannot be null, empty, or blank. // // * Must contain from 1 to 255 alphanumeric characters or hyphens. // // * First character must be a letter. // // * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens. // // * Must be unique for the AWS account that is making the request. // // TargetSnapshotIdentifier is a required field TargetSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CopyClusterSnapshotInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CopyClusterSnapshotInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *CopyClusterSnapshotInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CopyClusterSnapshotInput"} if s.SourceSnapshotIdentifier == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SourceSnapshotIdentifier")) } if s.TargetSnapshotIdentifier == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TargetSnapshotIdentifier")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod sets the ManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod field's value. func (s *CopyClusterSnapshotInput) SetManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod(v int64) *CopyClusterSnapshotInput { s.ManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod = &v return s } // SetSourceSnapshotClusterIdentifier sets the SourceSnapshotClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *CopyClusterSnapshotInput) SetSourceSnapshotClusterIdentifier(v string) *CopyClusterSnapshotInput { s.SourceSnapshotClusterIdentifier = &v return s } // SetSourceSnapshotIdentifier sets the SourceSnapshotIdentifier field's value. func (s *CopyClusterSnapshotInput) SetSourceSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *CopyClusterSnapshotInput { s.SourceSnapshotIdentifier = &v return s } // SetTargetSnapshotIdentifier sets the TargetSnapshotIdentifier field's value. func (s *CopyClusterSnapshotInput) SetTargetSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *CopyClusterSnapshotInput { s.TargetSnapshotIdentifier = &v return s } type CopyClusterSnapshotOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Describes a snapshot. Snapshot *Snapshot `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CopyClusterSnapshotOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CopyClusterSnapshotOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetSnapshot sets the Snapshot field's value. func (s *CopyClusterSnapshotOutput) SetSnapshot(v *Snapshot) *CopyClusterSnapshotOutput { s.Snapshot = v return s } type CreateClusterInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Reserved. AdditionalInfo *string `type:"string"` // If true, major version upgrades can be applied during the maintenance window // to the Amazon Redshift engine that is running on the cluster. // // When a new major version of the Amazon Redshift engine is released, you can // request that the service automatically apply upgrades during the maintenance // window to the Amazon Redshift engine that is running on your cluster. // // Default: true AllowVersionUpgrade *bool `type:"boolean"` // The number of days that automated snapshots are retained. If the value is // 0, automated snapshots are disabled. Even if automated snapshots are disabled, // you can still create manual snapshots when you want with CreateClusterSnapshot. // // Default: 1 // // Constraints: Must be a value from 0 to 35. AutomatedSnapshotRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"` // The EC2 Availability Zone (AZ) in which you want Amazon Redshift to provision // the cluster. For example, if you have several EC2 instances running in a // specific Availability Zone, then you might want the cluster to be provisioned // in the same zone in order to decrease network latency. // // Default: A random, system-chosen Availability Zone in the region that is // specified by the endpoint. // // Example: us-east-1d // // Constraint: The specified Availability Zone must be in the same region as // the current endpoint. AvailabilityZone *string `type:"string"` // A unique identifier for the cluster. You use this identifier to refer to // the cluster for any subsequent cluster operations such as deleting or modifying. // The identifier also appears in the Amazon Redshift console. // // Constraints: // // * Must contain from 1 to 63 alphanumeric characters or hyphens. // // * Alphabetic characters must be lowercase. // // * First character must be a letter. // // * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens. // // * Must be unique for all clusters within an AWS account. // // Example: myexamplecluster // // ClusterIdentifier is a required field ClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The name of the parameter group to be associated with this cluster. // // Default: The default Amazon Redshift cluster parameter group. For information // about the default parameter group, go to Working with Amazon Redshift Parameter // Groups (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-parameter-groups.html) // // Constraints: // // * Must be 1 to 255 alphanumeric characters or hyphens. // // * First character must be a letter. // // * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens. ClusterParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"` // A list of security groups to be associated with this cluster. // // Default: The default cluster security group for Amazon Redshift. ClusterSecurityGroups []*string `locationNameList:"ClusterSecurityGroupName" type:"list"` // The name of a cluster subnet group to be associated with this cluster. // // If this parameter is not provided the resulting cluster will be deployed // outside virtual private cloud (VPC). ClusterSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"` // The type of the cluster. When cluster type is specified as // // * single-node, the NumberOfNodes parameter is not required. // // * multi-node, the NumberOfNodes parameter is required. // // Valid Values: multi-node | single-node // // Default: multi-node ClusterType *string `type:"string"` // The version of the Amazon Redshift engine software that you want to deploy // on the cluster. // // The version selected runs on all the nodes in the cluster. // // Constraints: Only version 1.0 is currently available. // // Example: 1.0 ClusterVersion *string `type:"string"` // The name of the first database to be created when the cluster is created. // // To create additional databases after the cluster is created, connect to the // cluster with a SQL client and use SQL commands to create a database. For // more information, go to Create a Database (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/dg/t_creating_database.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Database Developer Guide. // // Default: dev // // Constraints: // // * Must contain 1 to 64 alphanumeric characters. // // * Must contain only lowercase letters. // // * Cannot be a word that is reserved by the service. A list of reserved // words can be found in Reserved Words (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/dg/r_pg_keywords.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Database Developer Guide. DBName *string `type:"string"` // The Elastic IP (EIP) address for the cluster. // // Constraints: The cluster must be provisioned in EC2-VPC and publicly-accessible // through an Internet gateway. For more information about provisioning clusters // in EC2-VPC, go to Supported Platforms to Launch Your Cluster (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-clusters.html#cluster-platforms) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. ElasticIp *string `type:"string"` // If true, the data in the cluster is encrypted at rest. // // Default: false Encrypted *bool `type:"boolean"` // An option that specifies whether to create the cluster with enhanced VPC // routing enabled. To create a cluster that uses enhanced VPC routing, the // cluster must be in a VPC. For more information, see Enhanced VPC Routing // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/enhanced-vpc-routing.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // If this option is true, enhanced VPC routing is enabled. // // Default: false EnhancedVpcRouting *bool `type:"boolean"` // Specifies the name of the HSM client certificate the Amazon Redshift cluster // uses to retrieve the data encryption keys stored in an HSM. HsmClientCertificateIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // Specifies the name of the HSM configuration that contains the information // the Amazon Redshift cluster can use to retrieve and store keys in an HSM. HsmConfigurationIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // A list of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) roles that can be used // by the cluster to access other AWS services. You must supply the IAM roles // in their Amazon Resource Name (ARN) format. You can supply up to 10 IAM roles // in a single request. // // A cluster can have up to 10 IAM roles associated with it at any time. IamRoles []*string `locationNameList:"IamRoleArn" type:"list"` // The AWS Key Management Service (KMS) key ID of the encryption key that you // want to use to encrypt data in the cluster. KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"` // An optional parameter for the name of the maintenance track for the cluster. // If you don't provide a maintenance track name, the cluster is assigned to // the current track. MaintenanceTrackName *string `type:"string"` // The default number of days to retain a manual snapshot. If the value is -1, // the snapshot is retained indefinitely. This setting doesn't change the retention // period of existing snapshots. // // The value must be either -1 or an integer between 1 and 3,653. ManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"` // The password associated with the master user account for the cluster that // is being created. // // Constraints: // // * Must be between 8 and 64 characters in length. // // * Must contain at least one uppercase letter. // // * Must contain at least one lowercase letter. // // * Must contain one number. // // * Can be any printable ASCII character (ASCII code 33 to 126) except ' // (single quote), " (double quote), \, /, @, or space. // // MasterUserPassword is a required field MasterUserPassword *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The user name associated with the master user account for the cluster that // is being created. // // Constraints: // // * Must be 1 - 128 alphanumeric characters. The user name can't be PUBLIC. // // * First character must be a letter. // // * Cannot be a reserved word. A list of reserved words can be found in // Reserved Words (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/dg/r_pg_keywords.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Database Developer Guide. // // MasterUsername is a required field MasterUsername *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The node type to be provisioned for the cluster. For information about node // types, go to Working with Clusters (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-clusters.html#how-many-nodes) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // Valid Values: ds2.xlarge | ds2.8xlarge | ds2.xlarge | ds2.8xlarge | dc1.large // | dc1.8xlarge | dc2.large | dc2.8xlarge // // NodeType is a required field NodeType *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The number of compute nodes in the cluster. This parameter is required when // the ClusterType parameter is specified as multi-node. // // For information about determining how many nodes you need, go to Working // with Clusters (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-clusters.html#how-many-nodes) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // If you don't specify this parameter, you get a single-node cluster. When // requesting a multi-node cluster, you must specify the number of nodes that // you want in the cluster. // // Default: 1 // // Constraints: Value must be at least 1 and no more than 100. NumberOfNodes *int64 `type:"integer"` // The port number on which the cluster accepts incoming connections. // // The cluster is accessible only via the JDBC and ODBC connection strings. // Part of the connection string requires the port on which the cluster will // listen for incoming connections. // // Default: 5439 // // Valid Values: 1150-65535 Port *int64 `type:"integer"` // The weekly time range (in UTC) during which automated cluster maintenance // can occur. // // Format: ddd:hh24:mi-ddd:hh24:mi // // Default: A 30-minute window selected at random from an 8-hour block of time // per region, occurring on a random day of the week. For more information about // the time blocks for each region, see Maintenance Windows (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-clusters.html#rs-maintenance-windows) // in Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // Valid Days: Mon | Tue | Wed | Thu | Fri | Sat | Sun // // Constraints: Minimum 30-minute window. PreferredMaintenanceWindow *string `type:"string"` // If true, the cluster can be accessed from a public network. PubliclyAccessible *bool `type:"boolean"` // A unique identifier for the snapshot schedule. SnapshotScheduleIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // A list of tag instances. Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"` // A list of Virtual Private Cloud (VPC) security groups to be associated with // the cluster. // // Default: The default VPC security group is associated with the cluster. VpcSecurityGroupIds []*string `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupId" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateClusterInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateClusterInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *CreateClusterInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateClusterInput"} if s.ClusterIdentifier == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ClusterIdentifier")) } if s.MasterUserPassword == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("MasterUserPassword")) } if s.MasterUsername == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("MasterUsername")) } if s.NodeType == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("NodeType")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAdditionalInfo sets the AdditionalInfo field's value. func (s *CreateClusterInput) SetAdditionalInfo(v string) *CreateClusterInput { s.AdditionalInfo = &v return s } // SetAllowVersionUpgrade sets the AllowVersionUpgrade field's value. func (s *CreateClusterInput) SetAllowVersionUpgrade(v bool) *CreateClusterInput { s.AllowVersionUpgrade = &v return s } // SetAutomatedSnapshotRetentionPeriod sets the AutomatedSnapshotRetentionPeriod field's value. func (s *CreateClusterInput) SetAutomatedSnapshotRetentionPeriod(v int64) *CreateClusterInput { s.AutomatedSnapshotRetentionPeriod = &v return s } // SetAvailabilityZone sets the AvailabilityZone field's value. func (s *CreateClusterInput) SetAvailabilityZone(v string) *CreateClusterInput { s.AvailabilityZone = &v return s } // SetClusterIdentifier sets the ClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *CreateClusterInput) SetClusterIdentifier(v string) *CreateClusterInput { s.ClusterIdentifier = &v return s } // SetClusterParameterGroupName sets the ClusterParameterGroupName field's value. func (s *CreateClusterInput) SetClusterParameterGroupName(v string) *CreateClusterInput { s.ClusterParameterGroupName = &v return s } // SetClusterSecurityGroups sets the ClusterSecurityGroups field's value. func (s *CreateClusterInput) SetClusterSecurityGroups(v []*string) *CreateClusterInput { s.ClusterSecurityGroups = v return s } // SetClusterSubnetGroupName sets the ClusterSubnetGroupName field's value. func (s *CreateClusterInput) SetClusterSubnetGroupName(v string) *CreateClusterInput { s.ClusterSubnetGroupName = &v return s } // SetClusterType sets the ClusterType field's value. func (s *CreateClusterInput) SetClusterType(v string) *CreateClusterInput { s.ClusterType = &v return s } // SetClusterVersion sets the ClusterVersion field's value. func (s *CreateClusterInput) SetClusterVersion(v string) *CreateClusterInput { s.ClusterVersion = &v return s } // SetDBName sets the DBName field's value. func (s *CreateClusterInput) SetDBName(v string) *CreateClusterInput { s.DBName = &v return s } // SetElasticIp sets the ElasticIp field's value. func (s *CreateClusterInput) SetElasticIp(v string) *CreateClusterInput { s.ElasticIp = &v return s } // SetEncrypted sets the Encrypted field's value. func (s *CreateClusterInput) SetEncrypted(v bool) *CreateClusterInput { s.Encrypted = &v return s } // SetEnhancedVpcRouting sets the EnhancedVpcRouting field's value. func (s *CreateClusterInput) SetEnhancedVpcRouting(v bool) *CreateClusterInput { s.EnhancedVpcRouting = &v return s } // SetHsmClientCertificateIdentifier sets the HsmClientCertificateIdentifier field's value. func (s *CreateClusterInput) SetHsmClientCertificateIdentifier(v string) *CreateClusterInput { s.HsmClientCertificateIdentifier = &v return s } // SetHsmConfigurationIdentifier sets the HsmConfigurationIdentifier field's value. func (s *CreateClusterInput) SetHsmConfigurationIdentifier(v string) *CreateClusterInput { s.HsmConfigurationIdentifier = &v return s } // SetIamRoles sets the IamRoles field's value. func (s *CreateClusterInput) SetIamRoles(v []*string) *CreateClusterInput { s.IamRoles = v return s } // SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value. func (s *CreateClusterInput) SetKmsKeyId(v string) *CreateClusterInput { s.KmsKeyId = &v return s } // SetMaintenanceTrackName sets the MaintenanceTrackName field's value. func (s *CreateClusterInput) SetMaintenanceTrackName(v string) *CreateClusterInput { s.MaintenanceTrackName = &v return s } // SetManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod sets the ManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod field's value. func (s *CreateClusterInput) SetManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod(v int64) *CreateClusterInput { s.ManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod = &v return s } // SetMasterUserPassword sets the MasterUserPassword field's value. func (s *CreateClusterInput) SetMasterUserPassword(v string) *CreateClusterInput { s.MasterUserPassword = &v return s } // SetMasterUsername sets the MasterUsername field's value. func (s *CreateClusterInput) SetMasterUsername(v string) *CreateClusterInput { s.MasterUsername = &v return s } // SetNodeType sets the NodeType field's value. func (s *CreateClusterInput) SetNodeType(v string) *CreateClusterInput { s.NodeType = &v return s } // SetNumberOfNodes sets the NumberOfNodes field's value. func (s *CreateClusterInput) SetNumberOfNodes(v int64) *CreateClusterInput { s.NumberOfNodes = &v return s } // SetPort sets the Port field's value. func (s *CreateClusterInput) SetPort(v int64) *CreateClusterInput { s.Port = &v return s } // SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow sets the PreferredMaintenanceWindow field's value. func (s *CreateClusterInput) SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow(v string) *CreateClusterInput { s.PreferredMaintenanceWindow = &v return s } // SetPubliclyAccessible sets the PubliclyAccessible field's value. func (s *CreateClusterInput) SetPubliclyAccessible(v bool) *CreateClusterInput { s.PubliclyAccessible = &v return s } // SetSnapshotScheduleIdentifier sets the SnapshotScheduleIdentifier field's value. func (s *CreateClusterInput) SetSnapshotScheduleIdentifier(v string) *CreateClusterInput { s.SnapshotScheduleIdentifier = &v return s } // SetTags sets the Tags field's value. func (s *CreateClusterInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CreateClusterInput { s.Tags = v return s } // SetVpcSecurityGroupIds sets the VpcSecurityGroupIds field's value. func (s *CreateClusterInput) SetVpcSecurityGroupIds(v []*string) *CreateClusterInput { s.VpcSecurityGroupIds = v return s } type CreateClusterOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Describes a cluster. Cluster *Cluster `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateClusterOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateClusterOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetCluster sets the Cluster field's value. func (s *CreateClusterOutput) SetCluster(v *Cluster) *CreateClusterOutput { s.Cluster = v return s } type CreateClusterParameterGroupInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A description of the parameter group. // // Description is a required field Description *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The Amazon Redshift engine version to which the cluster parameter group applies. // The cluster engine version determines the set of parameters. // // To get a list of valid parameter group family names, you can call DescribeClusterParameterGroups. // By default, Amazon Redshift returns a list of all the parameter groups that // are owned by your AWS account, including the default parameter groups for // each Amazon Redshift engine version. The parameter group family names associated // with the default parameter groups provide you the valid values. For example, // a valid family name is "redshift-1.0". // // ParameterGroupFamily is a required field ParameterGroupFamily *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The name of the cluster parameter group. // // Constraints: // // * Must be 1 to 255 alphanumeric characters or hyphens // // * First character must be a letter. // // * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens. // // * Must be unique withing your AWS account. // // This value is stored as a lower-case string. // // ParameterGroupName is a required field ParameterGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // A list of tag instances. Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateClusterParameterGroupInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateClusterParameterGroupInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *CreateClusterParameterGroupInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateClusterParameterGroupInput"} if s.Description == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Description")) } if s.ParameterGroupFamily == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ParameterGroupFamily")) } if s.ParameterGroupName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ParameterGroupName")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetDescription sets the Description field's value. func (s *CreateClusterParameterGroupInput) SetDescription(v string) *CreateClusterParameterGroupInput { s.Description = &v return s } // SetParameterGroupFamily sets the ParameterGroupFamily field's value. func (s *CreateClusterParameterGroupInput) SetParameterGroupFamily(v string) *CreateClusterParameterGroupInput { s.ParameterGroupFamily = &v return s } // SetParameterGroupName sets the ParameterGroupName field's value. func (s *CreateClusterParameterGroupInput) SetParameterGroupName(v string) *CreateClusterParameterGroupInput { s.ParameterGroupName = &v return s } // SetTags sets the Tags field's value. func (s *CreateClusterParameterGroupInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CreateClusterParameterGroupInput { s.Tags = v return s } type CreateClusterParameterGroupOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Describes a parameter group. ClusterParameterGroup *ClusterParameterGroup `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateClusterParameterGroupOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateClusterParameterGroupOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetClusterParameterGroup sets the ClusterParameterGroup field's value. func (s *CreateClusterParameterGroupOutput) SetClusterParameterGroup(v *ClusterParameterGroup) *CreateClusterParameterGroupOutput { s.ClusterParameterGroup = v return s } type CreateClusterSecurityGroupInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name for the security group. Amazon Redshift stores the value as a lowercase // string. // // Constraints: // // * Must contain no more than 255 alphanumeric characters or hyphens. // // * Must not be "Default". // // * Must be unique for all security groups that are created by your AWS // account. // // Example: examplesecuritygroup // // ClusterSecurityGroupName is a required field ClusterSecurityGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // A description for the security group. // // Description is a required field Description *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // A list of tag instances. Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateClusterSecurityGroupInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateClusterSecurityGroupInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *CreateClusterSecurityGroupInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateClusterSecurityGroupInput"} if s.ClusterSecurityGroupName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ClusterSecurityGroupName")) } if s.Description == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Description")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetClusterSecurityGroupName sets the ClusterSecurityGroupName field's value. func (s *CreateClusterSecurityGroupInput) SetClusterSecurityGroupName(v string) *CreateClusterSecurityGroupInput { s.ClusterSecurityGroupName = &v return s } // SetDescription sets the Description field's value. func (s *CreateClusterSecurityGroupInput) SetDescription(v string) *CreateClusterSecurityGroupInput { s.Description = &v return s } // SetTags sets the Tags field's value. func (s *CreateClusterSecurityGroupInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CreateClusterSecurityGroupInput { s.Tags = v return s } type CreateClusterSecurityGroupOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Describes a security group. ClusterSecurityGroup *ClusterSecurityGroup `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateClusterSecurityGroupOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateClusterSecurityGroupOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetClusterSecurityGroup sets the ClusterSecurityGroup field's value. func (s *CreateClusterSecurityGroupOutput) SetClusterSecurityGroup(v *ClusterSecurityGroup) *CreateClusterSecurityGroupOutput { s.ClusterSecurityGroup = v return s } type CreateClusterSnapshotInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The cluster identifier for which you want a snapshot. // // ClusterIdentifier is a required field ClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The number of days that a manual snapshot is retained. If the value is -1, // the manual snapshot is retained indefinitely. // // The value must be either -1 or an integer between 1 and 3,653. // // The default value is -1. ManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"` // A unique identifier for the snapshot that you are requesting. This identifier // must be unique for all snapshots within the AWS account. // // Constraints: // // * Cannot be null, empty, or blank // // * Must contain from 1 to 255 alphanumeric characters or hyphens // // * First character must be a letter // // * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens // // Example: my-snapshot-id // // SnapshotIdentifier is a required field SnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // A list of tag instances. Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateClusterSnapshotInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateClusterSnapshotInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *CreateClusterSnapshotInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateClusterSnapshotInput"} if s.ClusterIdentifier == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ClusterIdentifier")) } if s.SnapshotIdentifier == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SnapshotIdentifier")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetClusterIdentifier sets the ClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *CreateClusterSnapshotInput) SetClusterIdentifier(v string) *CreateClusterSnapshotInput { s.ClusterIdentifier = &v return s } // SetManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod sets the ManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod field's value. func (s *CreateClusterSnapshotInput) SetManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod(v int64) *CreateClusterSnapshotInput { s.ManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod = &v return s } // SetSnapshotIdentifier sets the SnapshotIdentifier field's value. func (s *CreateClusterSnapshotInput) SetSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *CreateClusterSnapshotInput { s.SnapshotIdentifier = &v return s } // SetTags sets the Tags field's value. func (s *CreateClusterSnapshotInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CreateClusterSnapshotInput { s.Tags = v return s } type CreateClusterSnapshotOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Describes a snapshot. Snapshot *Snapshot `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateClusterSnapshotOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateClusterSnapshotOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetSnapshot sets the Snapshot field's value. func (s *CreateClusterSnapshotOutput) SetSnapshot(v *Snapshot) *CreateClusterSnapshotOutput { s.Snapshot = v return s } type CreateClusterSubnetGroupInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name for the subnet group. Amazon Redshift stores the value as a lowercase // string. // // Constraints: // // * Must contain no more than 255 alphanumeric characters or hyphens. // // * Must not be "Default". // // * Must be unique for all subnet groups that are created by your AWS account. // // Example: examplesubnetgroup // // ClusterSubnetGroupName is a required field ClusterSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // A description for the subnet group. // // Description is a required field Description *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // An array of VPC subnet IDs. A maximum of 20 subnets can be modified in a // single request. // // SubnetIds is a required field SubnetIds []*string `locationNameList:"SubnetIdentifier" type:"list" required:"true"` // A list of tag instances. Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateClusterSubnetGroupInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateClusterSubnetGroupInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *CreateClusterSubnetGroupInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateClusterSubnetGroupInput"} if s.ClusterSubnetGroupName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ClusterSubnetGroupName")) } if s.Description == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Description")) } if s.SubnetIds == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SubnetIds")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetClusterSubnetGroupName sets the ClusterSubnetGroupName field's value. func (s *CreateClusterSubnetGroupInput) SetClusterSubnetGroupName(v string) *CreateClusterSubnetGroupInput { s.ClusterSubnetGroupName = &v return s } // SetDescription sets the Description field's value. func (s *CreateClusterSubnetGroupInput) SetDescription(v string) *CreateClusterSubnetGroupInput { s.Description = &v return s } // SetSubnetIds sets the SubnetIds field's value. func (s *CreateClusterSubnetGroupInput) SetSubnetIds(v []*string) *CreateClusterSubnetGroupInput { s.SubnetIds = v return s } // SetTags sets the Tags field's value. func (s *CreateClusterSubnetGroupInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CreateClusterSubnetGroupInput { s.Tags = v return s } type CreateClusterSubnetGroupOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Describes a subnet group. ClusterSubnetGroup *ClusterSubnetGroup `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateClusterSubnetGroupOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateClusterSubnetGroupOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetClusterSubnetGroup sets the ClusterSubnetGroup field's value. func (s *CreateClusterSubnetGroupOutput) SetClusterSubnetGroup(v *ClusterSubnetGroup) *CreateClusterSubnetGroupOutput { s.ClusterSubnetGroup = v return s } type CreateEventSubscriptionInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A boolean value; set to true to activate the subscription, and set to false // to create the subscription but not activate it. Enabled *bool `type:"boolean"` // Specifies the Amazon Redshift event categories to be published by the event // notification subscription. // // Values: configuration, management, monitoring, security EventCategories []*string `locationNameList:"EventCategory" type:"list"` // Specifies the Amazon Redshift event severity to be published by the event // notification subscription. // // Values: ERROR, INFO Severity *string `type:"string"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the Amazon SNS topic used to transmit the // event notifications. The ARN is created by Amazon SNS when you create a topic // and subscribe to it. // // SnsTopicArn is a required field SnsTopicArn *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // A list of one or more identifiers of Amazon Redshift source objects. All // of the objects must be of the same type as was specified in the source type // parameter. The event subscription will return only events generated by the // specified objects. If not specified, then events are returned for all objects // within the source type specified. // // Example: my-cluster-1, my-cluster-2 // // Example: my-snapshot-20131010 SourceIds []*string `locationNameList:"SourceId" type:"list"` // The type of source that will be generating the events. For example, if you // want to be notified of events generated by a cluster, you would set this // parameter to cluster. If this value is not specified, events are returned // for all Amazon Redshift objects in your AWS account. You must specify a source // type in order to specify source IDs. // // Valid values: cluster, cluster-parameter-group, cluster-security-group, and // cluster-snapshot. SourceType *string `type:"string"` // The name of the event subscription to be created. // // Constraints: // // * Cannot be null, empty, or blank. // // * Must contain from 1 to 255 alphanumeric characters or hyphens. // // * First character must be a letter. // // * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens. // // SubscriptionName is a required field SubscriptionName *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // A list of tag instances. Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateEventSubscriptionInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateEventSubscriptionInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *CreateEventSubscriptionInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateEventSubscriptionInput"} if s.SnsTopicArn == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SnsTopicArn")) } if s.SubscriptionName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SubscriptionName")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetEnabled sets the Enabled field's value. func (s *CreateEventSubscriptionInput) SetEnabled(v bool) *CreateEventSubscriptionInput { s.Enabled = &v return s } // SetEventCategories sets the EventCategories field's value. func (s *CreateEventSubscriptionInput) SetEventCategories(v []*string) *CreateEventSubscriptionInput { s.EventCategories = v return s } // SetSeverity sets the Severity field's value. func (s *CreateEventSubscriptionInput) SetSeverity(v string) *CreateEventSubscriptionInput { s.Severity = &v return s } // SetSnsTopicArn sets the SnsTopicArn field's value. func (s *CreateEventSubscriptionInput) SetSnsTopicArn(v string) *CreateEventSubscriptionInput { s.SnsTopicArn = &v return s } // SetSourceIds sets the SourceIds field's value. func (s *CreateEventSubscriptionInput) SetSourceIds(v []*string) *CreateEventSubscriptionInput { s.SourceIds = v return s } // SetSourceType sets the SourceType field's value. func (s *CreateEventSubscriptionInput) SetSourceType(v string) *CreateEventSubscriptionInput { s.SourceType = &v return s } // SetSubscriptionName sets the SubscriptionName field's value. func (s *CreateEventSubscriptionInput) SetSubscriptionName(v string) *CreateEventSubscriptionInput { s.SubscriptionName = &v return s } // SetTags sets the Tags field's value. func (s *CreateEventSubscriptionInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CreateEventSubscriptionInput { s.Tags = v return s } type CreateEventSubscriptionOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Describes event subscriptions. EventSubscription *EventSubscription `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateEventSubscriptionOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateEventSubscriptionOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetEventSubscription sets the EventSubscription field's value. func (s *CreateEventSubscriptionOutput) SetEventSubscription(v *EventSubscription) *CreateEventSubscriptionOutput { s.EventSubscription = v return s } type CreateHsmClientCertificateInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The identifier to be assigned to the new HSM client certificate that the // cluster will use to connect to the HSM to use the database encryption keys. // // HsmClientCertificateIdentifier is a required field HsmClientCertificateIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // A list of tag instances. Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateHsmClientCertificateInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateHsmClientCertificateInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *CreateHsmClientCertificateInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateHsmClientCertificateInput"} if s.HsmClientCertificateIdentifier == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("HsmClientCertificateIdentifier")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetHsmClientCertificateIdentifier sets the HsmClientCertificateIdentifier field's value. func (s *CreateHsmClientCertificateInput) SetHsmClientCertificateIdentifier(v string) *CreateHsmClientCertificateInput { s.HsmClientCertificateIdentifier = &v return s } // SetTags sets the Tags field's value. func (s *CreateHsmClientCertificateInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CreateHsmClientCertificateInput { s.Tags = v return s } type CreateHsmClientCertificateOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Returns information about an HSM client certificate. The certificate is stored // in a secure Hardware Storage Module (HSM), and used by the Amazon Redshift // cluster to encrypt data files. HsmClientCertificate *HsmClientCertificate `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateHsmClientCertificateOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateHsmClientCertificateOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetHsmClientCertificate sets the HsmClientCertificate field's value. func (s *CreateHsmClientCertificateOutput) SetHsmClientCertificate(v *HsmClientCertificate) *CreateHsmClientCertificateOutput { s.HsmClientCertificate = v return s } type CreateHsmConfigurationInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A text description of the HSM configuration to be created. // // Description is a required field Description *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The identifier to be assigned to the new Amazon Redshift HSM configuration. // // HsmConfigurationIdentifier is a required field HsmConfigurationIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The IP address that the Amazon Redshift cluster must use to access the HSM. // // HsmIpAddress is a required field HsmIpAddress *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The name of the partition in the HSM where the Amazon Redshift clusters will // store their database encryption keys. // // HsmPartitionName is a required field HsmPartitionName *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The password required to access the HSM partition. // // HsmPartitionPassword is a required field HsmPartitionPassword *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The HSMs public certificate file. When using Cloud HSM, the file name is // server.pem. // // HsmServerPublicCertificate is a required field HsmServerPublicCertificate *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // A list of tag instances. Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateHsmConfigurationInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateHsmConfigurationInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *CreateHsmConfigurationInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateHsmConfigurationInput"} if s.Description == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Description")) } if s.HsmConfigurationIdentifier == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("HsmConfigurationIdentifier")) } if s.HsmIpAddress == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("HsmIpAddress")) } if s.HsmPartitionName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("HsmPartitionName")) } if s.HsmPartitionPassword == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("HsmPartitionPassword")) } if s.HsmServerPublicCertificate == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("HsmServerPublicCertificate")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetDescription sets the Description field's value. func (s *CreateHsmConfigurationInput) SetDescription(v string) *CreateHsmConfigurationInput { s.Description = &v return s } // SetHsmConfigurationIdentifier sets the HsmConfigurationIdentifier field's value. func (s *CreateHsmConfigurationInput) SetHsmConfigurationIdentifier(v string) *CreateHsmConfigurationInput { s.HsmConfigurationIdentifier = &v return s } // SetHsmIpAddress sets the HsmIpAddress field's value. func (s *CreateHsmConfigurationInput) SetHsmIpAddress(v string) *CreateHsmConfigurationInput { s.HsmIpAddress = &v return s } // SetHsmPartitionName sets the HsmPartitionName field's value. func (s *CreateHsmConfigurationInput) SetHsmPartitionName(v string) *CreateHsmConfigurationInput { s.HsmPartitionName = &v return s } // SetHsmPartitionPassword sets the HsmPartitionPassword field's value. func (s *CreateHsmConfigurationInput) SetHsmPartitionPassword(v string) *CreateHsmConfigurationInput { s.HsmPartitionPassword = &v return s } // SetHsmServerPublicCertificate sets the HsmServerPublicCertificate field's value. func (s *CreateHsmConfigurationInput) SetHsmServerPublicCertificate(v string) *CreateHsmConfigurationInput { s.HsmServerPublicCertificate = &v return s } // SetTags sets the Tags field's value. func (s *CreateHsmConfigurationInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CreateHsmConfigurationInput { s.Tags = v return s } type CreateHsmConfigurationOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Returns information about an HSM configuration, which is an object that describes // to Amazon Redshift clusters the information they require to connect to an // HSM where they can store database encryption keys. HsmConfiguration *HsmConfiguration `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateHsmConfigurationOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateHsmConfigurationOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetHsmConfiguration sets the HsmConfiguration field's value. func (s *CreateHsmConfigurationOutput) SetHsmConfiguration(v *HsmConfiguration) *CreateHsmConfigurationOutput { s.HsmConfiguration = v return s } // The result of the CreateSnapshotCopyGrant action. type CreateSnapshotCopyGrantInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The unique identifier of the customer master key (CMK) to which to grant // Amazon Redshift permission. If no key is specified, the default key is used. KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"` // The name of the snapshot copy grant. This name must be unique in the region // for the AWS account. // // Constraints: // // * Must contain from 1 to 63 alphanumeric characters or hyphens. // // * Alphabetic characters must be lowercase. // // * First character must be a letter. // // * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens. // // * Must be unique for all clusters within an AWS account. // // SnapshotCopyGrantName is a required field SnapshotCopyGrantName *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // A list of tag instances. Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateSnapshotCopyGrantInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateSnapshotCopyGrantInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *CreateSnapshotCopyGrantInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateSnapshotCopyGrantInput"} if s.SnapshotCopyGrantName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SnapshotCopyGrantName")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value. func (s *CreateSnapshotCopyGrantInput) SetKmsKeyId(v string) *CreateSnapshotCopyGrantInput { s.KmsKeyId = &v return s } // SetSnapshotCopyGrantName sets the SnapshotCopyGrantName field's value. func (s *CreateSnapshotCopyGrantInput) SetSnapshotCopyGrantName(v string) *CreateSnapshotCopyGrantInput { s.SnapshotCopyGrantName = &v return s } // SetTags sets the Tags field's value. func (s *CreateSnapshotCopyGrantInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CreateSnapshotCopyGrantInput { s.Tags = v return s } type CreateSnapshotCopyGrantOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The snapshot copy grant that grants Amazon Redshift permission to encrypt // copied snapshots with the specified customer master key (CMK) from AWS KMS // in the destination region. // // For more information about managing snapshot copy grants, go to Amazon Redshift // Database Encryption (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-db-encryption.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. SnapshotCopyGrant *SnapshotCopyGrant `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateSnapshotCopyGrantOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateSnapshotCopyGrantOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetSnapshotCopyGrant sets the SnapshotCopyGrant field's value. func (s *CreateSnapshotCopyGrantOutput) SetSnapshotCopyGrant(v *SnapshotCopyGrant) *CreateSnapshotCopyGrantOutput { s.SnapshotCopyGrant = v return s } type CreateSnapshotScheduleInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` DryRun *bool `type:"boolean"` NextInvocations *int64 `type:"integer"` // The definition of the snapshot schedule. The definition is made up of schedule // expressions, for example "cron(30 12 *)" or "rate(12 hours)". ScheduleDefinitions []*string `locationNameList:"ScheduleDefinition" type:"list"` // The description of the snapshot schedule. ScheduleDescription *string `type:"string"` // A unique identifier for a snapshot schedule. Only alphanumeric characters // are allowed for the identifier. ScheduleIdentifier *string `type:"string"` Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateSnapshotScheduleInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateSnapshotScheduleInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetDryRun sets the DryRun field's value. func (s *CreateSnapshotScheduleInput) SetDryRun(v bool) *CreateSnapshotScheduleInput { s.DryRun = &v return s } // SetNextInvocations sets the NextInvocations field's value. func (s *CreateSnapshotScheduleInput) SetNextInvocations(v int64) *CreateSnapshotScheduleInput { s.NextInvocations = &v return s } // SetScheduleDefinitions sets the ScheduleDefinitions field's value. func (s *CreateSnapshotScheduleInput) SetScheduleDefinitions(v []*string) *CreateSnapshotScheduleInput { s.ScheduleDefinitions = v return s } // SetScheduleDescription sets the ScheduleDescription field's value. func (s *CreateSnapshotScheduleInput) SetScheduleDescription(v string) *CreateSnapshotScheduleInput { s.ScheduleDescription = &v return s } // SetScheduleIdentifier sets the ScheduleIdentifier field's value. func (s *CreateSnapshotScheduleInput) SetScheduleIdentifier(v string) *CreateSnapshotScheduleInput { s.ScheduleIdentifier = &v return s } // SetTags sets the Tags field's value. func (s *CreateSnapshotScheduleInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CreateSnapshotScheduleInput { s.Tags = v return s } // Describes a snapshot schedule. You can set a regular interval for creating // snapshots of a cluster. You can also schedule snapshots for specific dates. type CreateSnapshotScheduleOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` AssociatedClusterCount *int64 `type:"integer"` AssociatedClusters []*ClusterAssociatedToSchedule `locationNameList:"ClusterAssociatedToSchedule" type:"list"` NextInvocations []*time.Time `locationNameList:"SnapshotTime" type:"list"` // A list of ScheduleDefinitions ScheduleDefinitions []*string `locationNameList:"ScheduleDefinition" type:"list"` // The description of the schedule. ScheduleDescription *string `type:"string"` // A unique identifier for the schedule. ScheduleIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // An optional set of tags describing the schedule. Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateSnapshotScheduleOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateSnapshotScheduleOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetAssociatedClusterCount sets the AssociatedClusterCount field's value. func (s *CreateSnapshotScheduleOutput) SetAssociatedClusterCount(v int64) *CreateSnapshotScheduleOutput { s.AssociatedClusterCount = &v return s } // SetAssociatedClusters sets the AssociatedClusters field's value. func (s *CreateSnapshotScheduleOutput) SetAssociatedClusters(v []*ClusterAssociatedToSchedule) *CreateSnapshotScheduleOutput { s.AssociatedClusters = v return s } // SetNextInvocations sets the NextInvocations field's value. func (s *CreateSnapshotScheduleOutput) SetNextInvocations(v []*time.Time) *CreateSnapshotScheduleOutput { s.NextInvocations = v return s } // SetScheduleDefinitions sets the ScheduleDefinitions field's value. func (s *CreateSnapshotScheduleOutput) SetScheduleDefinitions(v []*string) *CreateSnapshotScheduleOutput { s.ScheduleDefinitions = v return s } // SetScheduleDescription sets the ScheduleDescription field's value. func (s *CreateSnapshotScheduleOutput) SetScheduleDescription(v string) *CreateSnapshotScheduleOutput { s.ScheduleDescription = &v return s } // SetScheduleIdentifier sets the ScheduleIdentifier field's value. func (s *CreateSnapshotScheduleOutput) SetScheduleIdentifier(v string) *CreateSnapshotScheduleOutput { s.ScheduleIdentifier = &v return s } // SetTags sets the Tags field's value. func (s *CreateSnapshotScheduleOutput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CreateSnapshotScheduleOutput { s.Tags = v return s } // Contains the output from the CreateTags action. type CreateTagsInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) to which you want to add the tag or tags. // For example, arn:aws:redshift:us-east-1:123456789:cluster:t1. // // ResourceName is a required field ResourceName *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // One or more name/value pairs to add as tags to the specified resource. Each // tag name is passed in with the parameter Key and the corresponding value // is passed in with the parameter Value. The Key and Value parameters are separated // by a comma (,). Separate multiple tags with a space. For example, --tags // "Key"="owner","Value"="admin" "Key"="environment","Value"="test" "Key"="version","Value"="1.0". // // Tags is a required field Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateTagsInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateTagsInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *CreateTagsInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateTagsInput"} if s.ResourceName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ResourceName")) } if s.Tags == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Tags")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetResourceName sets the ResourceName field's value. func (s *CreateTagsInput) SetResourceName(v string) *CreateTagsInput { s.ResourceName = &v return s } // SetTags sets the Tags field's value. func (s *CreateTagsInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CreateTagsInput { s.Tags = v return s } type CreateTagsOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s CreateTagsOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s CreateTagsOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Describes the status of a cluster while it is in the process of resizing // with an incremental resize. type DataTransferProgress struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Describes the data transfer rate in MB's per second. CurrentRateInMegaBytesPerSecond *float64 `type:"double"` // Describes the total amount of data that has been transfered in MB's. DataTransferredInMegaBytes *int64 `type:"long"` // Describes the number of seconds that have elapsed during the data transfer. ElapsedTimeInSeconds *int64 `type:"long"` // Describes the estimated number of seconds remaining to complete the transfer. EstimatedTimeToCompletionInSeconds *int64 `type:"long"` // Describes the status of the cluster. While the transfer is in progress the // status is transferringdata. Status *string `type:"string"` // Describes the total amount of data to be transfered in megabytes. TotalDataInMegaBytes *int64 `type:"long"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DataTransferProgress) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DataTransferProgress) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetCurrentRateInMegaBytesPerSecond sets the CurrentRateInMegaBytesPerSecond field's value. func (s *DataTransferProgress) SetCurrentRateInMegaBytesPerSecond(v float64) *DataTransferProgress { s.CurrentRateInMegaBytesPerSecond = &v return s } // SetDataTransferredInMegaBytes sets the DataTransferredInMegaBytes field's value. func (s *DataTransferProgress) SetDataTransferredInMegaBytes(v int64) *DataTransferProgress { s.DataTransferredInMegaBytes = &v return s } // SetElapsedTimeInSeconds sets the ElapsedTimeInSeconds field's value. func (s *DataTransferProgress) SetElapsedTimeInSeconds(v int64) *DataTransferProgress { s.ElapsedTimeInSeconds = &v return s } // SetEstimatedTimeToCompletionInSeconds sets the EstimatedTimeToCompletionInSeconds field's value. func (s *DataTransferProgress) SetEstimatedTimeToCompletionInSeconds(v int64) *DataTransferProgress { s.EstimatedTimeToCompletionInSeconds = &v return s } // SetStatus sets the Status field's value. func (s *DataTransferProgress) SetStatus(v string) *DataTransferProgress { s.Status = &v return s } // SetTotalDataInMegaBytes sets the TotalDataInMegaBytes field's value. func (s *DataTransferProgress) SetTotalDataInMegaBytes(v int64) *DataTransferProgress { s.TotalDataInMegaBytes = &v return s } // Describes the default cluster parameters for a parameter group family. type DefaultClusterParameters struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A value that indicates the starting point for the next set of response records // in a subsequent request. If a value is returned in a response, you can retrieve // the next set of records by providing this returned marker value in the Marker // parameter and retrying the command. If the Marker field is empty, all response // records have been retrieved for the request. Marker *string `type:"string"` // The name of the cluster parameter group family to which the engine default // parameters apply. ParameterGroupFamily *string `type:"string"` // The list of cluster default parameters. Parameters []*Parameter `locationNameList:"Parameter" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DefaultClusterParameters) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DefaultClusterParameters) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DefaultClusterParameters) SetMarker(v string) *DefaultClusterParameters { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetParameterGroupFamily sets the ParameterGroupFamily field's value. func (s *DefaultClusterParameters) SetParameterGroupFamily(v string) *DefaultClusterParameters { s.ParameterGroupFamily = &v return s } // SetParameters sets the Parameters field's value. func (s *DefaultClusterParameters) SetParameters(v []*Parameter) *DefaultClusterParameters { s.Parameters = v return s } // Describes a deferred maintenance window type DeferredMaintenanceWindow struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A timestamp for the end of the time period when we defer maintenance. DeferMaintenanceEndTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"` // A unique identifier for the maintenance window. DeferMaintenanceIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // A timestamp for the beginning of the time period when we defer maintenance. DeferMaintenanceStartTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeferredMaintenanceWindow) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeferredMaintenanceWindow) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetDeferMaintenanceEndTime sets the DeferMaintenanceEndTime field's value. func (s *DeferredMaintenanceWindow) SetDeferMaintenanceEndTime(v time.Time) *DeferredMaintenanceWindow { s.DeferMaintenanceEndTime = &v return s } // SetDeferMaintenanceIdentifier sets the DeferMaintenanceIdentifier field's value. func (s *DeferredMaintenanceWindow) SetDeferMaintenanceIdentifier(v string) *DeferredMaintenanceWindow { s.DeferMaintenanceIdentifier = &v return s } // SetDeferMaintenanceStartTime sets the DeferMaintenanceStartTime field's value. func (s *DeferredMaintenanceWindow) SetDeferMaintenanceStartTime(v time.Time) *DeferredMaintenanceWindow { s.DeferMaintenanceStartTime = &v return s } type DeleteClusterInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The identifier of the cluster to be deleted. // // Constraints: // // * Must contain lowercase characters. // // * Must contain from 1 to 63 alphanumeric characters or hyphens. // // * First character must be a letter. // // * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens. // // ClusterIdentifier is a required field ClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The identifier of the final snapshot that is to be created immediately before // deleting the cluster. If this parameter is provided, SkipFinalClusterSnapshot // must be false. // // Constraints: // // * Must be 1 to 255 alphanumeric characters. // // * First character must be a letter. // // * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens. FinalClusterSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // The number of days that a manual snapshot is retained. If the value is -1, // the manual snapshot is retained indefinitely. // // The value must be either -1 or an integer between 1 and 3,653. // // The default value is -1. FinalClusterSnapshotRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"` // Determines whether a final snapshot of the cluster is created before Amazon // Redshift deletes the cluster. If true, a final cluster snapshot is not created. // If false, a final cluster snapshot is created before the cluster is deleted. // // The FinalClusterSnapshotIdentifier parameter must be specified if SkipFinalClusterSnapshot // is false. // // Default: false SkipFinalClusterSnapshot *bool `type:"boolean"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteClusterInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteClusterInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DeleteClusterInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteClusterInput"} if s.ClusterIdentifier == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ClusterIdentifier")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetClusterIdentifier sets the ClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *DeleteClusterInput) SetClusterIdentifier(v string) *DeleteClusterInput { s.ClusterIdentifier = &v return s } // SetFinalClusterSnapshotIdentifier sets the FinalClusterSnapshotIdentifier field's value. func (s *DeleteClusterInput) SetFinalClusterSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DeleteClusterInput { s.FinalClusterSnapshotIdentifier = &v return s } // SetFinalClusterSnapshotRetentionPeriod sets the FinalClusterSnapshotRetentionPeriod field's value. func (s *DeleteClusterInput) SetFinalClusterSnapshotRetentionPeriod(v int64) *DeleteClusterInput { s.FinalClusterSnapshotRetentionPeriod = &v return s } // SetSkipFinalClusterSnapshot sets the SkipFinalClusterSnapshot field's value. func (s *DeleteClusterInput) SetSkipFinalClusterSnapshot(v bool) *DeleteClusterInput { s.SkipFinalClusterSnapshot = &v return s } type DeleteClusterOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Describes a cluster. Cluster *Cluster `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteClusterOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteClusterOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetCluster sets the Cluster field's value. func (s *DeleteClusterOutput) SetCluster(v *Cluster) *DeleteClusterOutput { s.Cluster = v return s } type DeleteClusterParameterGroupInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the parameter group to be deleted. // // Constraints: // // * Must be the name of an existing cluster parameter group. // // * Cannot delete a default cluster parameter group. // // ParameterGroupName is a required field ParameterGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteClusterParameterGroupInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteClusterParameterGroupInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DeleteClusterParameterGroupInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteClusterParameterGroupInput"} if s.ParameterGroupName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ParameterGroupName")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetParameterGroupName sets the ParameterGroupName field's value. func (s *DeleteClusterParameterGroupInput) SetParameterGroupName(v string) *DeleteClusterParameterGroupInput { s.ParameterGroupName = &v return s } type DeleteClusterParameterGroupOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteClusterParameterGroupOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteClusterParameterGroupOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type DeleteClusterSecurityGroupInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the cluster security group to be deleted. // // ClusterSecurityGroupName is a required field ClusterSecurityGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteClusterSecurityGroupInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteClusterSecurityGroupInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DeleteClusterSecurityGroupInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteClusterSecurityGroupInput"} if s.ClusterSecurityGroupName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ClusterSecurityGroupName")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetClusterSecurityGroupName sets the ClusterSecurityGroupName field's value. func (s *DeleteClusterSecurityGroupInput) SetClusterSecurityGroupName(v string) *DeleteClusterSecurityGroupInput { s.ClusterSecurityGroupName = &v return s } type DeleteClusterSecurityGroupOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteClusterSecurityGroupOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteClusterSecurityGroupOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type DeleteClusterSnapshotInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The unique identifier of the cluster the snapshot was created from. This // parameter is required if your IAM user has a policy containing a snapshot // resource element that specifies anything other than * for the cluster name. // // Constraints: Must be the name of valid cluster. SnapshotClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // The unique identifier of the manual snapshot to be deleted. // // Constraints: Must be the name of an existing snapshot that is in the available, // failed, or cancelled state. // // SnapshotIdentifier is a required field SnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteClusterSnapshotInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteClusterSnapshotInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DeleteClusterSnapshotInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteClusterSnapshotInput"} if s.SnapshotIdentifier == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SnapshotIdentifier")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetSnapshotClusterIdentifier sets the SnapshotClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *DeleteClusterSnapshotInput) SetSnapshotClusterIdentifier(v string) *DeleteClusterSnapshotInput { s.SnapshotClusterIdentifier = &v return s } // SetSnapshotIdentifier sets the SnapshotIdentifier field's value. func (s *DeleteClusterSnapshotInput) SetSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DeleteClusterSnapshotInput { s.SnapshotIdentifier = &v return s } type DeleteClusterSnapshotMessage struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The unique identifier of the cluster the snapshot was created from. This // parameter is required if your IAM user has a policy containing a snapshot // resource element that specifies anything other than * for the cluster name. // // Constraints: Must be the name of valid cluster. SnapshotClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // The unique identifier of the manual snapshot to be deleted. // // Constraints: Must be the name of an existing snapshot that is in the available, // failed, or cancelled state. // // SnapshotIdentifier is a required field SnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteClusterSnapshotMessage) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteClusterSnapshotMessage) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DeleteClusterSnapshotMessage) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteClusterSnapshotMessage"} if s.SnapshotIdentifier == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SnapshotIdentifier")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetSnapshotClusterIdentifier sets the SnapshotClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *DeleteClusterSnapshotMessage) SetSnapshotClusterIdentifier(v string) *DeleteClusterSnapshotMessage { s.SnapshotClusterIdentifier = &v return s } // SetSnapshotIdentifier sets the SnapshotIdentifier field's value. func (s *DeleteClusterSnapshotMessage) SetSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DeleteClusterSnapshotMessage { s.SnapshotIdentifier = &v return s } type DeleteClusterSnapshotOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Describes a snapshot. Snapshot *Snapshot `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteClusterSnapshotOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteClusterSnapshotOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetSnapshot sets the Snapshot field's value. func (s *DeleteClusterSnapshotOutput) SetSnapshot(v *Snapshot) *DeleteClusterSnapshotOutput { s.Snapshot = v return s } type DeleteClusterSubnetGroupInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the cluster subnet group name to be deleted. // // ClusterSubnetGroupName is a required field ClusterSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteClusterSubnetGroupInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteClusterSubnetGroupInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DeleteClusterSubnetGroupInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteClusterSubnetGroupInput"} if s.ClusterSubnetGroupName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ClusterSubnetGroupName")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetClusterSubnetGroupName sets the ClusterSubnetGroupName field's value. func (s *DeleteClusterSubnetGroupInput) SetClusterSubnetGroupName(v string) *DeleteClusterSubnetGroupInput { s.ClusterSubnetGroupName = &v return s } type DeleteClusterSubnetGroupOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteClusterSubnetGroupOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteClusterSubnetGroupOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type DeleteEventSubscriptionInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the Amazon Redshift event notification subscription to be deleted. // // SubscriptionName is a required field SubscriptionName *string `type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteEventSubscriptionInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteEventSubscriptionInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DeleteEventSubscriptionInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteEventSubscriptionInput"} if s.SubscriptionName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SubscriptionName")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetSubscriptionName sets the SubscriptionName field's value. func (s *DeleteEventSubscriptionInput) SetSubscriptionName(v string) *DeleteEventSubscriptionInput { s.SubscriptionName = &v return s } type DeleteEventSubscriptionOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteEventSubscriptionOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteEventSubscriptionOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type DeleteHsmClientCertificateInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The identifier of the HSM client certificate to be deleted. // // HsmClientCertificateIdentifier is a required field HsmClientCertificateIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteHsmClientCertificateInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteHsmClientCertificateInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DeleteHsmClientCertificateInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteHsmClientCertificateInput"} if s.HsmClientCertificateIdentifier == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("HsmClientCertificateIdentifier")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetHsmClientCertificateIdentifier sets the HsmClientCertificateIdentifier field's value. func (s *DeleteHsmClientCertificateInput) SetHsmClientCertificateIdentifier(v string) *DeleteHsmClientCertificateInput { s.HsmClientCertificateIdentifier = &v return s } type DeleteHsmClientCertificateOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteHsmClientCertificateOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteHsmClientCertificateOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type DeleteHsmConfigurationInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The identifier of the Amazon Redshift HSM configuration to be deleted. // // HsmConfigurationIdentifier is a required field HsmConfigurationIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteHsmConfigurationInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteHsmConfigurationInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DeleteHsmConfigurationInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteHsmConfigurationInput"} if s.HsmConfigurationIdentifier == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("HsmConfigurationIdentifier")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetHsmConfigurationIdentifier sets the HsmConfigurationIdentifier field's value. func (s *DeleteHsmConfigurationInput) SetHsmConfigurationIdentifier(v string) *DeleteHsmConfigurationInput { s.HsmConfigurationIdentifier = &v return s } type DeleteHsmConfigurationOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteHsmConfigurationOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteHsmConfigurationOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // The result of the DeleteSnapshotCopyGrant action. type DeleteSnapshotCopyGrantInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the snapshot copy grant to delete. // // SnapshotCopyGrantName is a required field SnapshotCopyGrantName *string `type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteSnapshotCopyGrantInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteSnapshotCopyGrantInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DeleteSnapshotCopyGrantInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteSnapshotCopyGrantInput"} if s.SnapshotCopyGrantName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SnapshotCopyGrantName")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetSnapshotCopyGrantName sets the SnapshotCopyGrantName field's value. func (s *DeleteSnapshotCopyGrantInput) SetSnapshotCopyGrantName(v string) *DeleteSnapshotCopyGrantInput { s.SnapshotCopyGrantName = &v return s } type DeleteSnapshotCopyGrantOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteSnapshotCopyGrantOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteSnapshotCopyGrantOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type DeleteSnapshotScheduleInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A unique identifier of the snapshot schedule to delete. // // ScheduleIdentifier is a required field ScheduleIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteSnapshotScheduleInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteSnapshotScheduleInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DeleteSnapshotScheduleInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteSnapshotScheduleInput"} if s.ScheduleIdentifier == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ScheduleIdentifier")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetScheduleIdentifier sets the ScheduleIdentifier field's value. func (s *DeleteSnapshotScheduleInput) SetScheduleIdentifier(v string) *DeleteSnapshotScheduleInput { s.ScheduleIdentifier = &v return s } type DeleteSnapshotScheduleOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteSnapshotScheduleOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteSnapshotScheduleOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Contains the output from the DeleteTags action. type DeleteTagsInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) from which you want to remove the tag or tags. // For example, arn:aws:redshift:us-east-1:123456789:cluster:t1. // // ResourceName is a required field ResourceName *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The tag key that you want to delete. // // TagKeys is a required field TagKeys []*string `locationNameList:"TagKey" type:"list" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteTagsInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteTagsInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DeleteTagsInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteTagsInput"} if s.ResourceName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ResourceName")) } if s.TagKeys == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TagKeys")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetResourceName sets the ResourceName field's value. func (s *DeleteTagsInput) SetResourceName(v string) *DeleteTagsInput { s.ResourceName = &v return s } // SetTagKeys sets the TagKeys field's value. func (s *DeleteTagsInput) SetTagKeys(v []*string) *DeleteTagsInput { s.TagKeys = v return s } type DeleteTagsOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DeleteTagsOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DeleteTagsOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type DescribeAccountAttributesInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A list of attribute names. AttributeNames []*string `locationNameList:"AttributeName" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeAccountAttributesInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeAccountAttributesInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetAttributeNames sets the AttributeNames field's value. func (s *DescribeAccountAttributesInput) SetAttributeNames(v []*string) *DescribeAccountAttributesInput { s.AttributeNames = v return s } type DescribeAccountAttributesOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A list of attributes assigned to an account. AccountAttributes []*AccountAttribute `locationNameList:"AccountAttribute" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeAccountAttributesOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeAccountAttributesOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetAccountAttributes sets the AccountAttributes field's value. func (s *DescribeAccountAttributesOutput) SetAccountAttributes(v []*AccountAttribute) *DescribeAccountAttributesOutput { s.AccountAttributes = v return s } type DescribeClusterDbRevisionsInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A unique identifier for a cluster whose ClusterDbRevisions you are requesting. // This parameter is case sensitive. All clusters defined for an account are // returned by default. ClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // An optional parameter that specifies the starting point for returning a set // of response records. When the results of a DescribeClusterDbRevisions request // exceed the value specified in MaxRecords, Amazon Redshift returns a value // in the marker field of the response. You can retrieve the next set of response // records by providing the returned marker value in the marker parameter and // retrying the request. // // Constraints: You can specify either the ClusterIdentifier parameter, or the // marker parameter, but not both. Marker *string `type:"string"` // The maximum number of response records to return in each call. If the number // of remaining response records exceeds the specified MaxRecords value, a value // is returned in the marker field of the response. You can retrieve the next // set of response records by providing the returned marker value in the marker // parameter and retrying the request. // // Default: 100 // // Constraints: minimum 20, maximum 100. MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeClusterDbRevisionsInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeClusterDbRevisionsInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetClusterIdentifier sets the ClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterDbRevisionsInput) SetClusterIdentifier(v string) *DescribeClusterDbRevisionsInput { s.ClusterIdentifier = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterDbRevisionsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeClusterDbRevisionsInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterDbRevisionsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeClusterDbRevisionsInput { s.MaxRecords = &v return s } type DescribeClusterDbRevisionsOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A list of revisions. ClusterDbRevisions []*ClusterDbRevision `locationNameList:"ClusterDbRevision" type:"list"` // A string representing the starting point for the next set of revisions. If // a value is returned in a response, you can retrieve the next set of revisions // by providing the value in the marker parameter and retrying the command. // If the marker field is empty, all revisions have already been returned. Marker *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeClusterDbRevisionsOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeClusterDbRevisionsOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetClusterDbRevisions sets the ClusterDbRevisions field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterDbRevisionsOutput) SetClusterDbRevisions(v []*ClusterDbRevision) *DescribeClusterDbRevisionsOutput { s.ClusterDbRevisions = v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterDbRevisionsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeClusterDbRevisionsOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } type DescribeClusterParameterGroupsInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // An optional parameter that specifies the starting point to return a set of // response records. When the results of a DescribeClusterParameterGroups request // exceed the value specified in MaxRecords, AWS returns a value in the Marker // field of the response. You can retrieve the next set of response records // by providing the returned marker value in the Marker parameter and retrying // the request. Marker *string `type:"string"` // The maximum number of response records to return in each call. If the number // of remaining response records exceeds the specified MaxRecords value, a value // is returned in a marker field of the response. You can retrieve the next // set of records by retrying the command with the returned marker value. // // Default: 100 // // Constraints: minimum 20, maximum 100. MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"` // The name of a specific parameter group for which to return details. By default, // details about all parameter groups and the default parameter group are returned. ParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"` // A tag key or keys for which you want to return all matching cluster parameter // groups that are associated with the specified key or keys. For example, suppose // that you have parameter groups that are tagged with keys called owner and // environment. If you specify both of these tag keys in the request, Amazon // Redshift returns a response with the parameter groups that have either or // both of these tag keys associated with them. TagKeys []*string `locationNameList:"TagKey" type:"list"` // A tag value or values for which you want to return all matching cluster parameter // groups that are associated with the specified tag value or values. For example, // suppose that you have parameter groups that are tagged with values called // admin and test. If you specify both of these tag values in the request, Amazon // Redshift returns a response with the parameter groups that have either or // both of these tag values associated with them. TagValues []*string `locationNameList:"TagValue" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeClusterParameterGroupsInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeClusterParameterGroupsInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterParameterGroupsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeClusterParameterGroupsInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterParameterGroupsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeClusterParameterGroupsInput { s.MaxRecords = &v return s } // SetParameterGroupName sets the ParameterGroupName field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterParameterGroupsInput) SetParameterGroupName(v string) *DescribeClusterParameterGroupsInput { s.ParameterGroupName = &v return s } // SetTagKeys sets the TagKeys field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterParameterGroupsInput) SetTagKeys(v []*string) *DescribeClusterParameterGroupsInput { s.TagKeys = v return s } // SetTagValues sets the TagValues field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterParameterGroupsInput) SetTagValues(v []*string) *DescribeClusterParameterGroupsInput { s.TagValues = v return s } // Contains the output from the DescribeClusterParameterGroups action. type DescribeClusterParameterGroupsOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A value that indicates the starting point for the next set of response records // in a subsequent request. If a value is returned in a response, you can retrieve // the next set of records by providing this returned marker value in the Marker // parameter and retrying the command. If the Marker field is empty, all response // records have been retrieved for the request. Marker *string `type:"string"` // A list of ClusterParameterGroup instances. Each instance describes one cluster // parameter group. ParameterGroups []*ClusterParameterGroup `locationNameList:"ClusterParameterGroup" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeClusterParameterGroupsOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeClusterParameterGroupsOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterParameterGroupsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeClusterParameterGroupsOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetParameterGroups sets the ParameterGroups field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterParameterGroupsOutput) SetParameterGroups(v []*ClusterParameterGroup) *DescribeClusterParameterGroupsOutput { s.ParameterGroups = v return s } type DescribeClusterParametersInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // An optional parameter that specifies the starting point to return a set of // response records. When the results of a DescribeClusterParameters request // exceed the value specified in MaxRecords, AWS returns a value in the Marker // field of the response. You can retrieve the next set of response records // by providing the returned marker value in the Marker parameter and retrying // the request. Marker *string `type:"string"` // The maximum number of response records to return in each call. If the number // of remaining response records exceeds the specified MaxRecords value, a value // is returned in a marker field of the response. You can retrieve the next // set of records by retrying the command with the returned marker value. // // Default: 100 // // Constraints: minimum 20, maximum 100. MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"` // The name of a cluster parameter group for which to return details. // // ParameterGroupName is a required field ParameterGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The parameter types to return. Specify user to show parameters that are different // form the default. Similarly, specify engine-default to show parameters that // are the same as the default parameter group. // // Default: All parameter types returned. // // Valid Values: user | engine-default Source *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeClusterParametersInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeClusterParametersInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DescribeClusterParametersInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeClusterParametersInput"} if s.ParameterGroupName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ParameterGroupName")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterParametersInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeClusterParametersInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterParametersInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeClusterParametersInput { s.MaxRecords = &v return s } // SetParameterGroupName sets the ParameterGroupName field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterParametersInput) SetParameterGroupName(v string) *DescribeClusterParametersInput { s.ParameterGroupName = &v return s } // SetSource sets the Source field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterParametersInput) SetSource(v string) *DescribeClusterParametersInput { s.Source = &v return s } // Contains the output from the DescribeClusterParameters action. type DescribeClusterParametersOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A value that indicates the starting point for the next set of response records // in a subsequent request. If a value is returned in a response, you can retrieve // the next set of records by providing this returned marker value in the Marker // parameter and retrying the command. If the Marker field is empty, all response // records have been retrieved for the request. Marker *string `type:"string"` // A list of Parameter instances. Each instance lists the parameters of one // cluster parameter group. Parameters []*Parameter `locationNameList:"Parameter" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeClusterParametersOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeClusterParametersOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterParametersOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeClusterParametersOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetParameters sets the Parameters field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterParametersOutput) SetParameters(v []*Parameter) *DescribeClusterParametersOutput { s.Parameters = v return s } type DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of a cluster security group for which you are requesting details. // You can specify either the Marker parameter or a ClusterSecurityGroupName // parameter, but not both. // // Example: securitygroup1 ClusterSecurityGroupName *string `type:"string"` // An optional parameter that specifies the starting point to return a set of // response records. When the results of a DescribeClusterSecurityGroups request // exceed the value specified in MaxRecords, AWS returns a value in the Marker // field of the response. You can retrieve the next set of response records // by providing the returned marker value in the Marker parameter and retrying // the request. // // Constraints: You can specify either the ClusterSecurityGroupName parameter // or the Marker parameter, but not both. Marker *string `type:"string"` // The maximum number of response records to return in each call. If the number // of remaining response records exceeds the specified MaxRecords value, a value // is returned in a marker field of the response. You can retrieve the next // set of records by retrying the command with the returned marker value. // // Default: 100 // // Constraints: minimum 20, maximum 100. MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"` // A tag key or keys for which you want to return all matching cluster security // groups that are associated with the specified key or keys. For example, suppose // that you have security groups that are tagged with keys called owner and // environment. If you specify both of these tag keys in the request, Amazon // Redshift returns a response with the security groups that have either or // both of these tag keys associated with them. TagKeys []*string `locationNameList:"TagKey" type:"list"` // A tag value or values for which you want to return all matching cluster security // groups that are associated with the specified tag value or values. For example, // suppose that you have security groups that are tagged with values called // admin and test. If you specify both of these tag values in the request, Amazon // Redshift returns a response with the security groups that have either or // both of these tag values associated with them. TagValues []*string `locationNameList:"TagValue" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetClusterSecurityGroupName sets the ClusterSecurityGroupName field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsInput) SetClusterSecurityGroupName(v string) *DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsInput { s.ClusterSecurityGroupName = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsInput { s.MaxRecords = &v return s } // SetTagKeys sets the TagKeys field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsInput) SetTagKeys(v []*string) *DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsInput { s.TagKeys = v return s } // SetTagValues sets the TagValues field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsInput) SetTagValues(v []*string) *DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsInput { s.TagValues = v return s } type DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A list of ClusterSecurityGroup instances. ClusterSecurityGroups []*ClusterSecurityGroup `locationNameList:"ClusterSecurityGroup" type:"list"` // A value that indicates the starting point for the next set of response records // in a subsequent request. If a value is returned in a response, you can retrieve // the next set of records by providing this returned marker value in the Marker // parameter and retrying the command. If the Marker field is empty, all response // records have been retrieved for the request. Marker *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetClusterSecurityGroups sets the ClusterSecurityGroups field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsOutput) SetClusterSecurityGroups(v []*ClusterSecurityGroup) *DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsOutput { s.ClusterSecurityGroups = v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeClusterSecurityGroupsOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } type DescribeClusterSnapshotsInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A value that indicates whether to return snapshots only for an existing cluster. // Table-level restore can be performed only using a snapshot of an existing // cluster, that is, a cluster that has not been deleted. If ClusterExists is // set to true, ClusterIdentifier is required. ClusterExists *bool `type:"boolean"` // The identifier of the cluster for which information about snapshots is requested. ClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // A time value that requests only snapshots created at or before the specified // time. The time value is specified in ISO 8601 format. For more information // about ISO 8601, go to the ISO8601 Wikipedia page. (http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/ISO_8601) // // Example: 2012-07-16T18:00:00Z EndTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"` // An optional parameter that specifies the starting point to return a set of // response records. When the results of a DescribeClusterSnapshots request // exceed the value specified in MaxRecords, AWS returns a value in the Marker // field of the response. You can retrieve the next set of response records // by providing the returned marker value in the Marker parameter and retrying // the request. Marker *string `type:"string"` // The maximum number of response records to return in each call. If the number // of remaining response records exceeds the specified MaxRecords value, a value // is returned in a marker field of the response. You can retrieve the next // set of records by retrying the command with the returned marker value. // // Default: 100 // // Constraints: minimum 20, maximum 100. MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"` // The AWS customer account used to create or copy the snapshot. Use this field // to filter the results to snapshots owned by a particular account. To describe // snapshots you own, either specify your AWS customer account, or do not specify // the parameter. OwnerAccount *string `type:"string"` // The snapshot identifier of the snapshot about which to return information. SnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // The type of snapshots for which you are requesting information. By default, // snapshots of all types are returned. // // Valid Values: automated | manual SnapshotType *string `type:"string"` SortingEntities []*SnapshotSortingEntity `locationNameList:"SnapshotSortingEntity" type:"list"` // A value that requests only snapshots created at or after the specified time. // The time value is specified in ISO 8601 format. For more information about // ISO 8601, go to the ISO8601 Wikipedia page. (http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/ISO_8601) // // Example: 2012-07-16T18:00:00Z StartTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"` // A tag key or keys for which you want to return all matching cluster snapshots // that are associated with the specified key or keys. For example, suppose // that you have snapshots that are tagged with keys called owner and environment. // If you specify both of these tag keys in the request, Amazon Redshift returns // a response with the snapshots that have either or both of these tag keys // associated with them. TagKeys []*string `locationNameList:"TagKey" type:"list"` // A tag value or values for which you want to return all matching cluster snapshots // that are associated with the specified tag value or values. For example, // suppose that you have snapshots that are tagged with values called admin // and test. If you specify both of these tag values in the request, Amazon // Redshift returns a response with the snapshots that have either or both of // these tag values associated with them. TagValues []*string `locationNameList:"TagValue" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeClusterSnapshotsInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeClusterSnapshotsInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DescribeClusterSnapshotsInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeClusterSnapshotsInput"} if s.SortingEntities != nil { for i, v := range s.SortingEntities { if v == nil { continue } if err := v.Validate(); err != nil { invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "SortingEntities", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams)) } } } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetClusterExists sets the ClusterExists field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterSnapshotsInput) SetClusterExists(v bool) *DescribeClusterSnapshotsInput { s.ClusterExists = &v return s } // SetClusterIdentifier sets the ClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterSnapshotsInput) SetClusterIdentifier(v string) *DescribeClusterSnapshotsInput { s.ClusterIdentifier = &v return s } // SetEndTime sets the EndTime field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterSnapshotsInput) SetEndTime(v time.Time) *DescribeClusterSnapshotsInput { s.EndTime = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterSnapshotsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeClusterSnapshotsInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterSnapshotsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeClusterSnapshotsInput { s.MaxRecords = &v return s } // SetOwnerAccount sets the OwnerAccount field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterSnapshotsInput) SetOwnerAccount(v string) *DescribeClusterSnapshotsInput { s.OwnerAccount = &v return s } // SetSnapshotIdentifier sets the SnapshotIdentifier field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterSnapshotsInput) SetSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DescribeClusterSnapshotsInput { s.SnapshotIdentifier = &v return s } // SetSnapshotType sets the SnapshotType field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterSnapshotsInput) SetSnapshotType(v string) *DescribeClusterSnapshotsInput { s.SnapshotType = &v return s } // SetSortingEntities sets the SortingEntities field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterSnapshotsInput) SetSortingEntities(v []*SnapshotSortingEntity) *DescribeClusterSnapshotsInput { s.SortingEntities = v return s } // SetStartTime sets the StartTime field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterSnapshotsInput) SetStartTime(v time.Time) *DescribeClusterSnapshotsInput { s.StartTime = &v return s } // SetTagKeys sets the TagKeys field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterSnapshotsInput) SetTagKeys(v []*string) *DescribeClusterSnapshotsInput { s.TagKeys = v return s } // SetTagValues sets the TagValues field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterSnapshotsInput) SetTagValues(v []*string) *DescribeClusterSnapshotsInput { s.TagValues = v return s } // Contains the output from the DescribeClusterSnapshots action. type DescribeClusterSnapshotsOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A value that indicates the starting point for the next set of response records // in a subsequent request. If a value is returned in a response, you can retrieve // the next set of records by providing this returned marker value in the Marker // parameter and retrying the command. If the Marker field is empty, all response // records have been retrieved for the request. Marker *string `type:"string"` // A list of Snapshot instances. Snapshots []*Snapshot `locationNameList:"Snapshot" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeClusterSnapshotsOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeClusterSnapshotsOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterSnapshotsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeClusterSnapshotsOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetSnapshots sets the Snapshots field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterSnapshotsOutput) SetSnapshots(v []*Snapshot) *DescribeClusterSnapshotsOutput { s.Snapshots = v return s } type DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the cluster subnet group for which information is requested. ClusterSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"` // An optional parameter that specifies the starting point to return a set of // response records. When the results of a DescribeClusterSubnetGroups request // exceed the value specified in MaxRecords, AWS returns a value in the Marker // field of the response. You can retrieve the next set of response records // by providing the returned marker value in the Marker parameter and retrying // the request. Marker *string `type:"string"` // The maximum number of response records to return in each call. If the number // of remaining response records exceeds the specified MaxRecords value, a value // is returned in a marker field of the response. You can retrieve the next // set of records by retrying the command with the returned marker value. // // Default: 100 // // Constraints: minimum 20, maximum 100. MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"` // A tag key or keys for which you want to return all matching cluster subnet // groups that are associated with the specified key or keys. For example, suppose // that you have subnet groups that are tagged with keys called owner and environment. // If you specify both of these tag keys in the request, Amazon Redshift returns // a response with the subnet groups that have either or both of these tag keys // associated with them. TagKeys []*string `locationNameList:"TagKey" type:"list"` // A tag value or values for which you want to return all matching cluster subnet // groups that are associated with the specified tag value or values. For example, // suppose that you have subnet groups that are tagged with values called admin // and test. If you specify both of these tag values in the request, Amazon // Redshift returns a response with the subnet groups that have either or both // of these tag values associated with them. TagValues []*string `locationNameList:"TagValue" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetClusterSubnetGroupName sets the ClusterSubnetGroupName field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsInput) SetClusterSubnetGroupName(v string) *DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsInput { s.ClusterSubnetGroupName = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsInput { s.MaxRecords = &v return s } // SetTagKeys sets the TagKeys field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsInput) SetTagKeys(v []*string) *DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsInput { s.TagKeys = v return s } // SetTagValues sets the TagValues field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsInput) SetTagValues(v []*string) *DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsInput { s.TagValues = v return s } // Contains the output from the DescribeClusterSubnetGroups action. type DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A list of ClusterSubnetGroup instances. ClusterSubnetGroups []*ClusterSubnetGroup `locationNameList:"ClusterSubnetGroup" type:"list"` // A value that indicates the starting point for the next set of response records // in a subsequent request. If a value is returned in a response, you can retrieve // the next set of records by providing this returned marker value in the Marker // parameter and retrying the command. If the Marker field is empty, all response // records have been retrieved for the request. Marker *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetClusterSubnetGroups sets the ClusterSubnetGroups field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsOutput) SetClusterSubnetGroups(v []*ClusterSubnetGroup) *DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsOutput { s.ClusterSubnetGroups = v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeClusterSubnetGroupsOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } type DescribeClusterTracksInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the maintenance track. MaintenanceTrackName *string `type:"string"` // An optional parameter that specifies the starting point to return a set of // response records. When the results of a DescribeClusterTracks request exceed // the value specified in MaxRecords, Amazon Redshift returns a value in the // Marker field of the response. You can retrieve the next set of response records // by providing the returned marker value in the Marker parameter and retrying // the request. Marker *string `type:"string"` // An integer value for the maximum number of maintenance tracks to return. MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeClusterTracksInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeClusterTracksInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetMaintenanceTrackName sets the MaintenanceTrackName field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterTracksInput) SetMaintenanceTrackName(v string) *DescribeClusterTracksInput { s.MaintenanceTrackName = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterTracksInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeClusterTracksInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterTracksInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeClusterTracksInput { s.MaxRecords = &v return s } type DescribeClusterTracksOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A list of maintenance tracks output by the DescribeClusterTracks operation. MaintenanceTracks []*MaintenanceTrack `locationNameList:"MaintenanceTrack" type:"list"` // The starting point to return a set of response tracklist records. You can // retrieve the next set of response records by providing the returned marker // value in the Marker parameter and retrying the request. Marker *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeClusterTracksOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeClusterTracksOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetMaintenanceTracks sets the MaintenanceTracks field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterTracksOutput) SetMaintenanceTracks(v []*MaintenanceTrack) *DescribeClusterTracksOutput { s.MaintenanceTracks = v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterTracksOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeClusterTracksOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } type DescribeClusterVersionsInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of a specific cluster parameter group family to return details for. // // Constraints: // // * Must be 1 to 255 alphanumeric characters // // * First character must be a letter // // * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens ClusterParameterGroupFamily *string `type:"string"` // The specific cluster version to return. // // Example: 1.0 ClusterVersion *string `type:"string"` // An optional parameter that specifies the starting point to return a set of // response records. When the results of a DescribeClusterVersions request exceed // the value specified in MaxRecords, AWS returns a value in the Marker field // of the response. You can retrieve the next set of response records by providing // the returned marker value in the Marker parameter and retrying the request. Marker *string `type:"string"` // The maximum number of response records to return in each call. If the number // of remaining response records exceeds the specified MaxRecords value, a value // is returned in a marker field of the response. You can retrieve the next // set of records by retrying the command with the returned marker value. // // Default: 100 // // Constraints: minimum 20, maximum 100. MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeClusterVersionsInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeClusterVersionsInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetClusterParameterGroupFamily sets the ClusterParameterGroupFamily field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterVersionsInput) SetClusterParameterGroupFamily(v string) *DescribeClusterVersionsInput { s.ClusterParameterGroupFamily = &v return s } // SetClusterVersion sets the ClusterVersion field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterVersionsInput) SetClusterVersion(v string) *DescribeClusterVersionsInput { s.ClusterVersion = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterVersionsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeClusterVersionsInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterVersionsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeClusterVersionsInput { s.MaxRecords = &v return s } // Contains the output from the DescribeClusterVersions action. type DescribeClusterVersionsOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A list of Version elements. ClusterVersions []*ClusterVersion `locationNameList:"ClusterVersion" type:"list"` // A value that indicates the starting point for the next set of response records // in a subsequent request. If a value is returned in a response, you can retrieve // the next set of records by providing this returned marker value in the Marker // parameter and retrying the command. If the Marker field is empty, all response // records have been retrieved for the request. Marker *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeClusterVersionsOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeClusterVersionsOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetClusterVersions sets the ClusterVersions field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterVersionsOutput) SetClusterVersions(v []*ClusterVersion) *DescribeClusterVersionsOutput { s.ClusterVersions = v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeClusterVersionsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeClusterVersionsOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } type DescribeClustersInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The unique identifier of a cluster whose properties you are requesting. This // parameter is case sensitive. // // The default is that all clusters defined for an account are returned. ClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // An optional parameter that specifies the starting point to return a set of // response records. When the results of a DescribeClusters request exceed the // value specified in MaxRecords, AWS returns a value in the Marker field of // the response. You can retrieve the next set of response records by providing // the returned marker value in the Marker parameter and retrying the request. // // Constraints: You can specify either the ClusterIdentifier parameter or the // Marker parameter, but not both. Marker *string `type:"string"` // The maximum number of response records to return in each call. If the number // of remaining response records exceeds the specified MaxRecords value, a value // is returned in a marker field of the response. You can retrieve the next // set of records by retrying the command with the returned marker value. // // Default: 100 // // Constraints: minimum 20, maximum 100. MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"` // A tag key or keys for which you want to return all matching clusters that // are associated with the specified key or keys. For example, suppose that // you have clusters that are tagged with keys called owner and environment. // If you specify both of these tag keys in the request, Amazon Redshift returns // a response with the clusters that have either or both of these tag keys associated // with them. TagKeys []*string `locationNameList:"TagKey" type:"list"` // A tag value or values for which you want to return all matching clusters // that are associated with the specified tag value or values. For example, // suppose that you have clusters that are tagged with values called admin and // test. If you specify both of these tag values in the request, Amazon Redshift // returns a response with the clusters that have either or both of these tag // values associated with them. TagValues []*string `locationNameList:"TagValue" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeClustersInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeClustersInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetClusterIdentifier sets the ClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *DescribeClustersInput) SetClusterIdentifier(v string) *DescribeClustersInput { s.ClusterIdentifier = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeClustersInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeClustersInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value. func (s *DescribeClustersInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeClustersInput { s.MaxRecords = &v return s } // SetTagKeys sets the TagKeys field's value. func (s *DescribeClustersInput) SetTagKeys(v []*string) *DescribeClustersInput { s.TagKeys = v return s } // SetTagValues sets the TagValues field's value. func (s *DescribeClustersInput) SetTagValues(v []*string) *DescribeClustersInput { s.TagValues = v return s } // Contains the output from the DescribeClusters action. type DescribeClustersOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A list of Cluster objects, where each object describes one cluster. Clusters []*Cluster `locationNameList:"Cluster" type:"list"` // A value that indicates the starting point for the next set of response records // in a subsequent request. If a value is returned in a response, you can retrieve // the next set of records by providing this returned marker value in the Marker // parameter and retrying the command. If the Marker field is empty, all response // records have been retrieved for the request. Marker *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeClustersOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeClustersOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetClusters sets the Clusters field's value. func (s *DescribeClustersOutput) SetClusters(v []*Cluster) *DescribeClustersOutput { s.Clusters = v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeClustersOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeClustersOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } type DescribeDefaultClusterParametersInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // An optional parameter that specifies the starting point to return a set of // response records. When the results of a DescribeDefaultClusterParameters // request exceed the value specified in MaxRecords, AWS returns a value in // the Marker field of the response. You can retrieve the next set of response // records by providing the returned marker value in the Marker parameter and // retrying the request. Marker *string `type:"string"` // The maximum number of response records to return in each call. If the number // of remaining response records exceeds the specified MaxRecords value, a value // is returned in a marker field of the response. You can retrieve the next // set of records by retrying the command with the returned marker value. // // Default: 100 // // Constraints: minimum 20, maximum 100. MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"` // The name of the cluster parameter group family. // // ParameterGroupFamily is a required field ParameterGroupFamily *string `type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeDefaultClusterParametersInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeDefaultClusterParametersInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DescribeDefaultClusterParametersInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeDefaultClusterParametersInput"} if s.ParameterGroupFamily == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ParameterGroupFamily")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeDefaultClusterParametersInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeDefaultClusterParametersInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value. func (s *DescribeDefaultClusterParametersInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeDefaultClusterParametersInput { s.MaxRecords = &v return s } // SetParameterGroupFamily sets the ParameterGroupFamily field's value. func (s *DescribeDefaultClusterParametersInput) SetParameterGroupFamily(v string) *DescribeDefaultClusterParametersInput { s.ParameterGroupFamily = &v return s } type DescribeDefaultClusterParametersOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Describes the default cluster parameters for a parameter group family. DefaultClusterParameters *DefaultClusterParameters `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeDefaultClusterParametersOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeDefaultClusterParametersOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetDefaultClusterParameters sets the DefaultClusterParameters field's value. func (s *DescribeDefaultClusterParametersOutput) SetDefaultClusterParameters(v *DefaultClusterParameters) *DescribeDefaultClusterParametersOutput { s.DefaultClusterParameters = v return s } type DescribeEventCategoriesInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The source type, such as cluster or parameter group, to which the described // event categories apply. // // Valid values: cluster, cluster-snapshot, cluster-parameter-group, and cluster-security-group. SourceType *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeEventCategoriesInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeEventCategoriesInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetSourceType sets the SourceType field's value. func (s *DescribeEventCategoriesInput) SetSourceType(v string) *DescribeEventCategoriesInput { s.SourceType = &v return s } type DescribeEventCategoriesOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A list of event categories descriptions. EventCategoriesMapList []*EventCategoriesMap `locationNameList:"EventCategoriesMap" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeEventCategoriesOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeEventCategoriesOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetEventCategoriesMapList sets the EventCategoriesMapList field's value. func (s *DescribeEventCategoriesOutput) SetEventCategoriesMapList(v []*EventCategoriesMap) *DescribeEventCategoriesOutput { s.EventCategoriesMapList = v return s } type DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // An optional parameter that specifies the starting point to return a set of // response records. When the results of a DescribeEventSubscriptions request // exceed the value specified in MaxRecords, AWS returns a value in the Marker // field of the response. You can retrieve the next set of response records // by providing the returned marker value in the Marker parameter and retrying // the request. Marker *string `type:"string"` // The maximum number of response records to return in each call. If the number // of remaining response records exceeds the specified MaxRecords value, a value // is returned in a marker field of the response. You can retrieve the next // set of records by retrying the command with the returned marker value. // // Default: 100 // // Constraints: minimum 20, maximum 100. MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"` // The name of the Amazon Redshift event notification subscription to be described. SubscriptionName *string `type:"string"` // A tag key or keys for which you want to return all matching event notification // subscriptions that are associated with the specified key or keys. For example, // suppose that you have subscriptions that are tagged with keys called owner // and environment. If you specify both of these tag keys in the request, Amazon // Redshift returns a response with the subscriptions that have either or both // of these tag keys associated with them. TagKeys []*string `locationNameList:"TagKey" type:"list"` // A tag value or values for which you want to return all matching event notification // subscriptions that are associated with the specified tag value or values. // For example, suppose that you have subscriptions that are tagged with values // called admin and test. If you specify both of these tag values in the request, // Amazon Redshift returns a response with the subscriptions that have either // or both of these tag values associated with them. TagValues []*string `locationNameList:"TagValue" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value. func (s *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput { s.MaxRecords = &v return s } // SetSubscriptionName sets the SubscriptionName field's value. func (s *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput) SetSubscriptionName(v string) *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput { s.SubscriptionName = &v return s } // SetTagKeys sets the TagKeys field's value. func (s *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput) SetTagKeys(v []*string) *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput { s.TagKeys = v return s } // SetTagValues sets the TagValues field's value. func (s *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput) SetTagValues(v []*string) *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput { s.TagValues = v return s } type DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A list of event subscriptions. EventSubscriptionsList []*EventSubscription `locationNameList:"EventSubscription" type:"list"` // A value that indicates the starting point for the next set of response records // in a subsequent request. If a value is returned in a response, you can retrieve // the next set of records by providing this returned marker value in the Marker // parameter and retrying the command. If the Marker field is empty, all response // records have been retrieved for the request. Marker *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetEventSubscriptionsList sets the EventSubscriptionsList field's value. func (s *DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput) SetEventSubscriptionsList(v []*EventSubscription) *DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput { s.EventSubscriptionsList = v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } type DescribeEventsInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The number of minutes prior to the time of the request for which to retrieve // events. For example, if the request is sent at 18:00 and you specify a duration // of 60, then only events which have occurred after 17:00 will be returned. // // Default: 60 Duration *int64 `type:"integer"` // The end of the time interval for which to retrieve events, specified in ISO // 8601 format. For more information about ISO 8601, go to the ISO8601 Wikipedia // page. (http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/ISO_8601) // // Example: 2009-07-08T18:00Z EndTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"` // An optional parameter that specifies the starting point to return a set of // response records. When the results of a DescribeEvents request exceed the // value specified in MaxRecords, AWS returns a value in the Marker field of // the response. You can retrieve the next set of response records by providing // the returned marker value in the Marker parameter and retrying the request. Marker *string `type:"string"` // The maximum number of response records to return in each call. If the number // of remaining response records exceeds the specified MaxRecords value, a value // is returned in a marker field of the response. You can retrieve the next // set of records by retrying the command with the returned marker value. // // Default: 100 // // Constraints: minimum 20, maximum 100. MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"` // The identifier of the event source for which events will be returned. If // this parameter is not specified, then all sources are included in the response. // // Constraints: // // If SourceIdentifier is supplied, SourceType must also be provided. // // * Specify a cluster identifier when SourceType is cluster. // // * Specify a cluster security group name when SourceType is cluster-security-group. // // * Specify a cluster parameter group name when SourceType is cluster-parameter-group. // // * Specify a cluster snapshot identifier when SourceType is cluster-snapshot. SourceIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // The event source to retrieve events for. If no value is specified, all events // are returned. // // Constraints: // // If SourceType is supplied, SourceIdentifier must also be provided. // // * Specify cluster when SourceIdentifier is a cluster identifier. // // * Specify cluster-security-group when SourceIdentifier is a cluster security // group name. // // * Specify cluster-parameter-group when SourceIdentifier is a cluster parameter // group name. // // * Specify cluster-snapshot when SourceIdentifier is a cluster snapshot // identifier. SourceType *string `type:"string" enum:"SourceType"` // The beginning of the time interval to retrieve events for, specified in ISO // 8601 format. For more information about ISO 8601, go to the ISO8601 Wikipedia // page. (http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/ISO_8601) // // Example: 2009-07-08T18:00Z StartTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeEventsInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeEventsInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetDuration sets the Duration field's value. func (s *DescribeEventsInput) SetDuration(v int64) *DescribeEventsInput { s.Duration = &v return s } // SetEndTime sets the EndTime field's value. func (s *DescribeEventsInput) SetEndTime(v time.Time) *DescribeEventsInput { s.EndTime = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeEventsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeEventsInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value. func (s *DescribeEventsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeEventsInput { s.MaxRecords = &v return s } // SetSourceIdentifier sets the SourceIdentifier field's value. func (s *DescribeEventsInput) SetSourceIdentifier(v string) *DescribeEventsInput { s.SourceIdentifier = &v return s } // SetSourceType sets the SourceType field's value. func (s *DescribeEventsInput) SetSourceType(v string) *DescribeEventsInput { s.SourceType = &v return s } // SetStartTime sets the StartTime field's value. func (s *DescribeEventsInput) SetStartTime(v time.Time) *DescribeEventsInput { s.StartTime = &v return s } type DescribeEventsOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A list of Event instances. Events []*Event `locationNameList:"Event" type:"list"` // A value that indicates the starting point for the next set of response records // in a subsequent request. If a value is returned in a response, you can retrieve // the next set of records by providing this returned marker value in the Marker // parameter and retrying the command. If the Marker field is empty, all response // records have been retrieved for the request. Marker *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeEventsOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeEventsOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetEvents sets the Events field's value. func (s *DescribeEventsOutput) SetEvents(v []*Event) *DescribeEventsOutput { s.Events = v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeEventsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeEventsOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } type DescribeHsmClientCertificatesInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The identifier of a specific HSM client certificate for which you want information. // If no identifier is specified, information is returned for all HSM client // certificates owned by your AWS customer account. HsmClientCertificateIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // An optional parameter that specifies the starting point to return a set of // response records. When the results of a DescribeHsmClientCertificates request // exceed the value specified in MaxRecords, AWS returns a value in the Marker // field of the response. You can retrieve the next set of response records // by providing the returned marker value in the Marker parameter and retrying // the request. Marker *string `type:"string"` // The maximum number of response records to return in each call. If the number // of remaining response records exceeds the specified MaxRecords value, a value // is returned in a marker field of the response. You can retrieve the next // set of records by retrying the command with the returned marker value. // // Default: 100 // // Constraints: minimum 20, maximum 100. MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"` // A tag key or keys for which you want to return all matching HSM client certificates // that are associated with the specified key or keys. For example, suppose // that you have HSM client certificates that are tagged with keys called owner // and environment. If you specify both of these tag keys in the request, Amazon // Redshift returns a response with the HSM client certificates that have either // or both of these tag keys associated with them. TagKeys []*string `locationNameList:"TagKey" type:"list"` // A tag value or values for which you want to return all matching HSM client // certificates that are associated with the specified tag value or values. // For example, suppose that you have HSM client certificates that are tagged // with values called admin and test. If you specify both of these tag values // in the request, Amazon Redshift returns a response with the HSM client certificates // that have either or both of these tag values associated with them. TagValues []*string `locationNameList:"TagValue" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeHsmClientCertificatesInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeHsmClientCertificatesInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetHsmClientCertificateIdentifier sets the HsmClientCertificateIdentifier field's value. func (s *DescribeHsmClientCertificatesInput) SetHsmClientCertificateIdentifier(v string) *DescribeHsmClientCertificatesInput { s.HsmClientCertificateIdentifier = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeHsmClientCertificatesInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeHsmClientCertificatesInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value. func (s *DescribeHsmClientCertificatesInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeHsmClientCertificatesInput { s.MaxRecords = &v return s } // SetTagKeys sets the TagKeys field's value. func (s *DescribeHsmClientCertificatesInput) SetTagKeys(v []*string) *DescribeHsmClientCertificatesInput { s.TagKeys = v return s } // SetTagValues sets the TagValues field's value. func (s *DescribeHsmClientCertificatesInput) SetTagValues(v []*string) *DescribeHsmClientCertificatesInput { s.TagValues = v return s } type DescribeHsmClientCertificatesOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A list of the identifiers for one or more HSM client certificates used by // Amazon Redshift clusters to store and retrieve database encryption keys in // an HSM. HsmClientCertificates []*HsmClientCertificate `locationNameList:"HsmClientCertificate" type:"list"` // A value that indicates the starting point for the next set of response records // in a subsequent request. If a value is returned in a response, you can retrieve // the next set of records by providing this returned marker value in the Marker // parameter and retrying the command. If the Marker field is empty, all response // records have been retrieved for the request. Marker *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeHsmClientCertificatesOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeHsmClientCertificatesOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetHsmClientCertificates sets the HsmClientCertificates field's value. func (s *DescribeHsmClientCertificatesOutput) SetHsmClientCertificates(v []*HsmClientCertificate) *DescribeHsmClientCertificatesOutput { s.HsmClientCertificates = v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeHsmClientCertificatesOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeHsmClientCertificatesOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } type DescribeHsmConfigurationsInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The identifier of a specific Amazon Redshift HSM configuration to be described. // If no identifier is specified, information is returned for all HSM configurations // owned by your AWS customer account. HsmConfigurationIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // An optional parameter that specifies the starting point to return a set of // response records. When the results of a DescribeHsmConfigurations request // exceed the value specified in MaxRecords, AWS returns a value in the Marker // field of the response. You can retrieve the next set of response records // by providing the returned marker value in the Marker parameter and retrying // the request. Marker *string `type:"string"` // The maximum number of response records to return in each call. If the number // of remaining response records exceeds the specified MaxRecords value, a value // is returned in a marker field of the response. You can retrieve the next // set of records by retrying the command with the returned marker value. // // Default: 100 // // Constraints: minimum 20, maximum 100. MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"` // A tag key or keys for which you want to return all matching HSM configurations // that are associated with the specified key or keys. For example, suppose // that you have HSM configurations that are tagged with keys called owner and // environment. If you specify both of these tag keys in the request, Amazon // Redshift returns a response with the HSM configurations that have either // or both of these tag keys associated with them. TagKeys []*string `locationNameList:"TagKey" type:"list"` // A tag value or values for which you want to return all matching HSM configurations // that are associated with the specified tag value or values. For example, // suppose that you have HSM configurations that are tagged with values called // admin and test. If you specify both of these tag values in the request, Amazon // Redshift returns a response with the HSM configurations that have either // or both of these tag values associated with them. TagValues []*string `locationNameList:"TagValue" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeHsmConfigurationsInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeHsmConfigurationsInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetHsmConfigurationIdentifier sets the HsmConfigurationIdentifier field's value. func (s *DescribeHsmConfigurationsInput) SetHsmConfigurationIdentifier(v string) *DescribeHsmConfigurationsInput { s.HsmConfigurationIdentifier = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeHsmConfigurationsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeHsmConfigurationsInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value. func (s *DescribeHsmConfigurationsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeHsmConfigurationsInput { s.MaxRecords = &v return s } // SetTagKeys sets the TagKeys field's value. func (s *DescribeHsmConfigurationsInput) SetTagKeys(v []*string) *DescribeHsmConfigurationsInput { s.TagKeys = v return s } // SetTagValues sets the TagValues field's value. func (s *DescribeHsmConfigurationsInput) SetTagValues(v []*string) *DescribeHsmConfigurationsInput { s.TagValues = v return s } type DescribeHsmConfigurationsOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A list of HsmConfiguration objects. HsmConfigurations []*HsmConfiguration `locationNameList:"HsmConfiguration" type:"list"` // A value that indicates the starting point for the next set of response records // in a subsequent request. If a value is returned in a response, you can retrieve // the next set of records by providing this returned marker value in the Marker // parameter and retrying the command. If the Marker field is empty, all response // records have been retrieved for the request. Marker *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeHsmConfigurationsOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeHsmConfigurationsOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetHsmConfigurations sets the HsmConfigurations field's value. func (s *DescribeHsmConfigurationsOutput) SetHsmConfigurations(v []*HsmConfiguration) *DescribeHsmConfigurationsOutput { s.HsmConfigurations = v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeHsmConfigurationsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeHsmConfigurationsOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } type DescribeLoggingStatusInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The identifier of the cluster from which to get the logging status. // // Example: examplecluster // // ClusterIdentifier is a required field ClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeLoggingStatusInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeLoggingStatusInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DescribeLoggingStatusInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeLoggingStatusInput"} if s.ClusterIdentifier == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ClusterIdentifier")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetClusterIdentifier sets the ClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *DescribeLoggingStatusInput) SetClusterIdentifier(v string) *DescribeLoggingStatusInput { s.ClusterIdentifier = &v return s } type DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The version filter value. Specify this parameter to show only the available // offerings matching the specified version. // // Default: All versions. // // Constraints: Must be one of the version returned from DescribeClusterVersions. ClusterVersion *string `type:"string"` // An optional parameter that specifies the starting point to return a set of // response records. When the results of a DescribeOrderableClusterOptions request // exceed the value specified in MaxRecords, AWS returns a value in the Marker // field of the response. You can retrieve the next set of response records // by providing the returned marker value in the Marker parameter and retrying // the request. Marker *string `type:"string"` // The maximum number of response records to return in each call. If the number // of remaining response records exceeds the specified MaxRecords value, a value // is returned in a marker field of the response. You can retrieve the next // set of records by retrying the command with the returned marker value. // // Default: 100 // // Constraints: minimum 20, maximum 100. MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"` // The node type filter value. Specify this parameter to show only the available // offerings matching the specified node type. NodeType *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetClusterVersion sets the ClusterVersion field's value. func (s *DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsInput) SetClusterVersion(v string) *DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsInput { s.ClusterVersion = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value. func (s *DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsInput { s.MaxRecords = &v return s } // SetNodeType sets the NodeType field's value. func (s *DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsInput) SetNodeType(v string) *DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsInput { s.NodeType = &v return s } // Contains the output from the DescribeOrderableClusterOptions action. type DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A value that indicates the starting point for the next set of response records // in a subsequent request. If a value is returned in a response, you can retrieve // the next set of records by providing this returned marker value in the Marker // parameter and retrying the command. If the Marker field is empty, all response // records have been retrieved for the request. Marker *string `type:"string"` // An OrderableClusterOption structure containing information about orderable // options for the cluster. OrderableClusterOptions []*OrderableClusterOption `locationNameList:"OrderableClusterOption" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetOrderableClusterOptions sets the OrderableClusterOptions field's value. func (s *DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsOutput) SetOrderableClusterOptions(v []*OrderableClusterOption) *DescribeOrderableClusterOptionsOutput { s.OrderableClusterOptions = v return s } type DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // An optional parameter that specifies the starting point to return a set of // response records. When the results of a DescribeReservedNodeOfferings request // exceed the value specified in MaxRecords, AWS returns a value in the Marker // field of the response. You can retrieve the next set of response records // by providing the returned marker value in the Marker parameter and retrying // the request. Marker *string `type:"string"` // The maximum number of response records to return in each call. If the number // of remaining response records exceeds the specified MaxRecords value, a value // is returned in a marker field of the response. You can retrieve the next // set of records by retrying the command with the returned marker value. // // Default: 100 // // Constraints: minimum 20, maximum 100. MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"` // The unique identifier for the offering. ReservedNodeOfferingId *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value. func (s *DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsInput { s.MaxRecords = &v return s } // SetReservedNodeOfferingId sets the ReservedNodeOfferingId field's value. func (s *DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsInput) SetReservedNodeOfferingId(v string) *DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsInput { s.ReservedNodeOfferingId = &v return s } type DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A value that indicates the starting point for the next set of response records // in a subsequent request. If a value is returned in a response, you can retrieve // the next set of records by providing this returned marker value in the Marker // parameter and retrying the command. If the Marker field is empty, all response // records have been retrieved for the request. Marker *string `type:"string"` // A list of ReservedNodeOffering objects. ReservedNodeOfferings []*ReservedNodeOffering `locationNameList:"ReservedNodeOffering" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetReservedNodeOfferings sets the ReservedNodeOfferings field's value. func (s *DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsOutput) SetReservedNodeOfferings(v []*ReservedNodeOffering) *DescribeReservedNodeOfferingsOutput { s.ReservedNodeOfferings = v return s } type DescribeReservedNodesInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // An optional parameter that specifies the starting point to return a set of // response records. When the results of a DescribeReservedNodes request exceed // the value specified in MaxRecords, AWS returns a value in the Marker field // of the response. You can retrieve the next set of response records by providing // the returned marker value in the Marker parameter and retrying the request. Marker *string `type:"string"` // The maximum number of response records to return in each call. If the number // of remaining response records exceeds the specified MaxRecords value, a value // is returned in a marker field of the response. You can retrieve the next // set of records by retrying the command with the returned marker value. // // Default: 100 // // Constraints: minimum 20, maximum 100. MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"` // Identifier for the node reservation. ReservedNodeId *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeReservedNodesInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeReservedNodesInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeReservedNodesInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeReservedNodesInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value. func (s *DescribeReservedNodesInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeReservedNodesInput { s.MaxRecords = &v return s } // SetReservedNodeId sets the ReservedNodeId field's value. func (s *DescribeReservedNodesInput) SetReservedNodeId(v string) *DescribeReservedNodesInput { s.ReservedNodeId = &v return s } type DescribeReservedNodesOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A value that indicates the starting point for the next set of response records // in a subsequent request. If a value is returned in a response, you can retrieve // the next set of records by providing this returned marker value in the Marker // parameter and retrying the command. If the Marker field is empty, all response // records have been retrieved for the request. Marker *string `type:"string"` // The list of ReservedNode objects. ReservedNodes []*ReservedNode `locationNameList:"ReservedNode" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeReservedNodesOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeReservedNodesOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeReservedNodesOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeReservedNodesOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetReservedNodes sets the ReservedNodes field's value. func (s *DescribeReservedNodesOutput) SetReservedNodes(v []*ReservedNode) *DescribeReservedNodesOutput { s.ReservedNodes = v return s } type DescribeResizeInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The unique identifier of a cluster whose resize progress you are requesting. // This parameter is case-sensitive. // // By default, resize operations for all clusters defined for an AWS account // are returned. // // ClusterIdentifier is a required field ClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeResizeInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeResizeInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DescribeResizeInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeResizeInput"} if s.ClusterIdentifier == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ClusterIdentifier")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetClusterIdentifier sets the ClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *DescribeResizeInput) SetClusterIdentifier(v string) *DescribeResizeInput { s.ClusterIdentifier = &v return s } // Describes the result of a cluster resize operation. type DescribeResizeOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The average rate of the resize operation over the last few minutes, measured // in megabytes per second. After the resize operation completes, this value // shows the average rate of the entire resize operation. AvgResizeRateInMegaBytesPerSecond *float64 `type:"double"` // The amount of seconds that have elapsed since the resize operation began. // After the resize operation completes, this value shows the total actual time, // in seconds, for the resize operation. ElapsedTimeInSeconds *int64 `type:"long"` // The estimated time remaining, in seconds, until the resize operation is complete. // This value is calculated based on the average resize rate and the estimated // amount of data remaining to be processed. Once the resize operation is complete, // this value will be 0. EstimatedTimeToCompletionInSeconds *int64 `type:"long"` // The names of tables that have been completely imported . // // Valid Values: List of table names. ImportTablesCompleted []*string `type:"list"` // The names of tables that are being currently imported. // // Valid Values: List of table names. ImportTablesInProgress []*string `type:"list"` // The names of tables that have not been yet imported. // // Valid Values: List of table names ImportTablesNotStarted []*string `type:"list"` // An optional string to provide additional details about the resize action. Message *string `type:"string"` // While the resize operation is in progress, this value shows the current amount // of data, in megabytes, that has been processed so far. When the resize operation // is complete, this value shows the total amount of data, in megabytes, on // the cluster, which may be more or less than TotalResizeDataInMegaBytes (the // estimated total amount of data before resize). ProgressInMegaBytes *int64 `type:"long"` // An enum with possible values of ClassicResize and ElasticResize. These values // describe the type of resize operation being performed. ResizeType *string `type:"string"` // The status of the resize operation. // // Valid Values: NONE | IN_PROGRESS | FAILED | SUCCEEDED | CANCELLING Status *string `type:"string"` // The cluster type after the resize operation is complete. // // Valid Values: multi-node | single-node TargetClusterType *string `type:"string"` // The type of encryption for the cluster after the resize is complete. // // Possible values are KMS and None. In the China region possible values are: // Legacy and None. TargetEncryptionType *string `type:"string"` // The node type that the cluster will have after the resize operation is complete. TargetNodeType *string `type:"string"` // The number of nodes that the cluster will have after the resize operation // is complete. TargetNumberOfNodes *int64 `type:"integer"` // The estimated total amount of data, in megabytes, on the cluster before the // resize operation began. TotalResizeDataInMegaBytes *int64 `type:"long"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeResizeOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeResizeOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetAvgResizeRateInMegaBytesPerSecond sets the AvgResizeRateInMegaBytesPerSecond field's value. func (s *DescribeResizeOutput) SetAvgResizeRateInMegaBytesPerSecond(v float64) *DescribeResizeOutput { s.AvgResizeRateInMegaBytesPerSecond = &v return s } // SetElapsedTimeInSeconds sets the ElapsedTimeInSeconds field's value. func (s *DescribeResizeOutput) SetElapsedTimeInSeconds(v int64) *DescribeResizeOutput { s.ElapsedTimeInSeconds = &v return s } // SetEstimatedTimeToCompletionInSeconds sets the EstimatedTimeToCompletionInSeconds field's value. func (s *DescribeResizeOutput) SetEstimatedTimeToCompletionInSeconds(v int64) *DescribeResizeOutput { s.EstimatedTimeToCompletionInSeconds = &v return s } // SetImportTablesCompleted sets the ImportTablesCompleted field's value. func (s *DescribeResizeOutput) SetImportTablesCompleted(v []*string) *DescribeResizeOutput { s.ImportTablesCompleted = v return s } // SetImportTablesInProgress sets the ImportTablesInProgress field's value. func (s *DescribeResizeOutput) SetImportTablesInProgress(v []*string) *DescribeResizeOutput { s.ImportTablesInProgress = v return s } // SetImportTablesNotStarted sets the ImportTablesNotStarted field's value. func (s *DescribeResizeOutput) SetImportTablesNotStarted(v []*string) *DescribeResizeOutput { s.ImportTablesNotStarted = v return s } // SetMessage sets the Message field's value. func (s *DescribeResizeOutput) SetMessage(v string) *DescribeResizeOutput { s.Message = &v return s } // SetProgressInMegaBytes sets the ProgressInMegaBytes field's value. func (s *DescribeResizeOutput) SetProgressInMegaBytes(v int64) *DescribeResizeOutput { s.ProgressInMegaBytes = &v return s } // SetResizeType sets the ResizeType field's value. func (s *DescribeResizeOutput) SetResizeType(v string) *DescribeResizeOutput { s.ResizeType = &v return s } // SetStatus sets the Status field's value. func (s *DescribeResizeOutput) SetStatus(v string) *DescribeResizeOutput { s.Status = &v return s } // SetTargetClusterType sets the TargetClusterType field's value. func (s *DescribeResizeOutput) SetTargetClusterType(v string) *DescribeResizeOutput { s.TargetClusterType = &v return s } // SetTargetEncryptionType sets the TargetEncryptionType field's value. func (s *DescribeResizeOutput) SetTargetEncryptionType(v string) *DescribeResizeOutput { s.TargetEncryptionType = &v return s } // SetTargetNodeType sets the TargetNodeType field's value. func (s *DescribeResizeOutput) SetTargetNodeType(v string) *DescribeResizeOutput { s.TargetNodeType = &v return s } // SetTargetNumberOfNodes sets the TargetNumberOfNodes field's value. func (s *DescribeResizeOutput) SetTargetNumberOfNodes(v int64) *DescribeResizeOutput { s.TargetNumberOfNodes = &v return s } // SetTotalResizeDataInMegaBytes sets the TotalResizeDataInMegaBytes field's value. func (s *DescribeResizeOutput) SetTotalResizeDataInMegaBytes(v int64) *DescribeResizeOutput { s.TotalResizeDataInMegaBytes = &v return s } // The result of the DescribeSnapshotCopyGrants action. type DescribeSnapshotCopyGrantsInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // An optional parameter that specifies the starting point to return a set of // response records. When the results of a DescribeSnapshotCopyGrant request // exceed the value specified in MaxRecords, AWS returns a value in the Marker // field of the response. You can retrieve the next set of response records // by providing the returned marker value in the Marker parameter and retrying // the request. // // Constraints: You can specify either the SnapshotCopyGrantName parameter or // the Marker parameter, but not both. Marker *string `type:"string"` // The maximum number of response records to return in each call. If the number // of remaining response records exceeds the specified MaxRecords value, a value // is returned in a marker field of the response. You can retrieve the next // set of records by retrying the command with the returned marker value. // // Default: 100 // // Constraints: minimum 20, maximum 100. MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"` // The name of the snapshot copy grant. SnapshotCopyGrantName *string `type:"string"` // A tag key or keys for which you want to return all matching resources that // are associated with the specified key or keys. For example, suppose that // you have resources tagged with keys called owner and environment. If you // specify both of these tag keys in the request, Amazon Redshift returns a // response with all resources that have either or both of these tag keys associated // with them. TagKeys []*string `locationNameList:"TagKey" type:"list"` // A tag value or values for which you want to return all matching resources // that are associated with the specified value or values. For example, suppose // that you have resources tagged with values called admin and test. If you // specify both of these tag values in the request, Amazon Redshift returns // a response with all resources that have either or both of these tag values // associated with them. TagValues []*string `locationNameList:"TagValue" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeSnapshotCopyGrantsInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeSnapshotCopyGrantsInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeSnapshotCopyGrantsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeSnapshotCopyGrantsInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value. func (s *DescribeSnapshotCopyGrantsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeSnapshotCopyGrantsInput { s.MaxRecords = &v return s } // SetSnapshotCopyGrantName sets the SnapshotCopyGrantName field's value. func (s *DescribeSnapshotCopyGrantsInput) SetSnapshotCopyGrantName(v string) *DescribeSnapshotCopyGrantsInput { s.SnapshotCopyGrantName = &v return s } // SetTagKeys sets the TagKeys field's value. func (s *DescribeSnapshotCopyGrantsInput) SetTagKeys(v []*string) *DescribeSnapshotCopyGrantsInput { s.TagKeys = v return s } // SetTagValues sets the TagValues field's value. func (s *DescribeSnapshotCopyGrantsInput) SetTagValues(v []*string) *DescribeSnapshotCopyGrantsInput { s.TagValues = v return s } type DescribeSnapshotCopyGrantsOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // An optional parameter that specifies the starting point to return a set of // response records. When the results of a DescribeSnapshotCopyGrant request // exceed the value specified in MaxRecords, AWS returns a value in the Marker // field of the response. You can retrieve the next set of response records // by providing the returned marker value in the Marker parameter and retrying // the request. // // Constraints: You can specify either the SnapshotCopyGrantName parameter or // the Marker parameter, but not both. Marker *string `type:"string"` // The list of SnapshotCopyGrant objects. SnapshotCopyGrants []*SnapshotCopyGrant `locationNameList:"SnapshotCopyGrant" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeSnapshotCopyGrantsOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeSnapshotCopyGrantsOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeSnapshotCopyGrantsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeSnapshotCopyGrantsOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetSnapshotCopyGrants sets the SnapshotCopyGrants field's value. func (s *DescribeSnapshotCopyGrantsOutput) SetSnapshotCopyGrants(v []*SnapshotCopyGrant) *DescribeSnapshotCopyGrantsOutput { s.SnapshotCopyGrants = v return s } type DescribeSnapshotSchedulesInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The unique identifier for the cluster whose snapshot schedules you want to // view. ClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // A value that indicates the starting point for the next set of response records // in a subsequent request. If a value is returned in a response, you can retrieve // the next set of records by providing this returned marker value in the marker // parameter and retrying the command. If the marker field is empty, all response // records have been retrieved for the request. Marker *string `type:"string"` // The maximum number or response records to return in each call. If the number // of remaining response records exceeds the specified MaxRecords value, a value // is returned in a marker field of the response. You can retrieve the next // set of records by retrying the command with the returned marker value. MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"` // A unique identifier for a snapshot schedule. ScheduleIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // The key value for a snapshot schedule tag. TagKeys []*string `locationNameList:"TagKey" type:"list"` // The value corresponding to the key of the snapshot schedule tag. TagValues []*string `locationNameList:"TagValue" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeSnapshotSchedulesInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeSnapshotSchedulesInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetClusterIdentifier sets the ClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *DescribeSnapshotSchedulesInput) SetClusterIdentifier(v string) *DescribeSnapshotSchedulesInput { s.ClusterIdentifier = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeSnapshotSchedulesInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeSnapshotSchedulesInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value. func (s *DescribeSnapshotSchedulesInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeSnapshotSchedulesInput { s.MaxRecords = &v return s } // SetScheduleIdentifier sets the ScheduleIdentifier field's value. func (s *DescribeSnapshotSchedulesInput) SetScheduleIdentifier(v string) *DescribeSnapshotSchedulesInput { s.ScheduleIdentifier = &v return s } // SetTagKeys sets the TagKeys field's value. func (s *DescribeSnapshotSchedulesInput) SetTagKeys(v []*string) *DescribeSnapshotSchedulesInput { s.TagKeys = v return s } // SetTagValues sets the TagValues field's value. func (s *DescribeSnapshotSchedulesInput) SetTagValues(v []*string) *DescribeSnapshotSchedulesInput { s.TagValues = v return s } type DescribeSnapshotSchedulesOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A value that indicates the starting point for the next set of response records // in a subsequent request. If a value is returned in a response, you can retrieve // the next set of records by providing this returned marker value in the marker // parameter and retrying the command. If the marker field is empty, all response // records have been retrieved for the request. Marker *string `type:"string"` // A list of SnapshotSchedules. SnapshotSchedules []*SnapshotSchedule `locationNameList:"SnapshotSchedule" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeSnapshotSchedulesOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeSnapshotSchedulesOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeSnapshotSchedulesOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeSnapshotSchedulesOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetSnapshotSchedules sets the SnapshotSchedules field's value. func (s *DescribeSnapshotSchedulesOutput) SetSnapshotSchedules(v []*SnapshotSchedule) *DescribeSnapshotSchedulesOutput { s.SnapshotSchedules = v return s } type DescribeStorageInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeStorageInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeStorageInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type DescribeStorageOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The total amount of storage currently used for snapshots. TotalBackupSizeInMegaBytes *float64 `type:"double"` // The total amount of storage currently provisioned. TotalProvisionedStorageInMegaBytes *float64 `type:"double"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeStorageOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeStorageOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetTotalBackupSizeInMegaBytes sets the TotalBackupSizeInMegaBytes field's value. func (s *DescribeStorageOutput) SetTotalBackupSizeInMegaBytes(v float64) *DescribeStorageOutput { s.TotalBackupSizeInMegaBytes = &v return s } // SetTotalProvisionedStorageInMegaBytes sets the TotalProvisionedStorageInMegaBytes field's value. func (s *DescribeStorageOutput) SetTotalProvisionedStorageInMegaBytes(v float64) *DescribeStorageOutput { s.TotalProvisionedStorageInMegaBytes = &v return s } type DescribeTableRestoreStatusInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The Amazon Redshift cluster that the table is being restored to. ClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeTableRestoreStatus // request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records // beyond the marker, up to the value specified by the MaxRecords parameter. Marker *string `type:"string"` // The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records // exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker // is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved. MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"` // The identifier of the table restore request to return status for. If you // don't specify a TableRestoreRequestId value, then DescribeTableRestoreStatus // returns the status of all in-progress table restore requests. TableRestoreRequestId *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeTableRestoreStatusInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeTableRestoreStatusInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetClusterIdentifier sets the ClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *DescribeTableRestoreStatusInput) SetClusterIdentifier(v string) *DescribeTableRestoreStatusInput { s.ClusterIdentifier = &v return s } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeTableRestoreStatusInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeTableRestoreStatusInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value. func (s *DescribeTableRestoreStatusInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeTableRestoreStatusInput { s.MaxRecords = &v return s } // SetTableRestoreRequestId sets the TableRestoreRequestId field's value. func (s *DescribeTableRestoreStatusInput) SetTableRestoreRequestId(v string) *DescribeTableRestoreStatusInput { s.TableRestoreRequestId = &v return s } type DescribeTableRestoreStatusOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A pagination token that can be used in a subsequent DescribeTableRestoreStatus // request. Marker *string `type:"string"` // A list of status details for one or more table restore requests. TableRestoreStatusDetails []*TableRestoreStatus `locationNameList:"TableRestoreStatus" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeTableRestoreStatusOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeTableRestoreStatusOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeTableRestoreStatusOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeTableRestoreStatusOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetTableRestoreStatusDetails sets the TableRestoreStatusDetails field's value. func (s *DescribeTableRestoreStatusOutput) SetTableRestoreStatusDetails(v []*TableRestoreStatus) *DescribeTableRestoreStatusOutput { s.TableRestoreStatusDetails = v return s } type DescribeTagsInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A value that indicates the starting point for the next set of response records // in a subsequent request. If a value is returned in a response, you can retrieve // the next set of records by providing this returned marker value in the marker // parameter and retrying the command. If the marker field is empty, all response // records have been retrieved for the request. Marker *string `type:"string"` // The maximum number or response records to return in each call. If the number // of remaining response records exceeds the specified MaxRecords value, a value // is returned in a marker field of the response. You can retrieve the next // set of records by retrying the command with the returned marker value. MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for which you want to describe the tag or // tags. For example, arn:aws:redshift:us-east-1:123456789:cluster:t1. ResourceName *string `type:"string"` // The type of resource with which you want to view tags. Valid resource types // are: // // * Cluster // // * CIDR/IP // // * EC2 security group // // * Snapshot // // * Cluster security group // // * Subnet group // // * HSM connection // // * HSM certificate // // * Parameter group // // * Snapshot copy grant // // For more information about Amazon Redshift resource types and constructing // ARNs, go to Specifying Policy Elements: Actions, Effects, Resources, and // Principals (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/redshift-iam-access-control-overview.html#redshift-iam-access-control-specify-actions) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. ResourceType *string `type:"string"` // A tag key or keys for which you want to return all matching resources that // are associated with the specified key or keys. For example, suppose that // you have resources tagged with keys called owner and environment. If you // specify both of these tag keys in the request, Amazon Redshift returns a // response with all resources that have either or both of these tag keys associated // with them. TagKeys []*string `locationNameList:"TagKey" type:"list"` // A tag value or values for which you want to return all matching resources // that are associated with the specified value or values. For example, suppose // that you have resources tagged with values called admin and test. If you // specify both of these tag values in the request, Amazon Redshift returns // a response with all resources that have either or both of these tag values // associated with them. TagValues []*string `locationNameList:"TagValue" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeTagsInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeTagsInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeTagsInput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeTagsInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value. func (s *DescribeTagsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeTagsInput { s.MaxRecords = &v return s } // SetResourceName sets the ResourceName field's value. func (s *DescribeTagsInput) SetResourceName(v string) *DescribeTagsInput { s.ResourceName = &v return s } // SetResourceType sets the ResourceType field's value. func (s *DescribeTagsInput) SetResourceType(v string) *DescribeTagsInput { s.ResourceType = &v return s } // SetTagKeys sets the TagKeys field's value. func (s *DescribeTagsInput) SetTagKeys(v []*string) *DescribeTagsInput { s.TagKeys = v return s } // SetTagValues sets the TagValues field's value. func (s *DescribeTagsInput) SetTagValues(v []*string) *DescribeTagsInput { s.TagValues = v return s } type DescribeTagsOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A value that indicates the starting point for the next set of response records // in a subsequent request. If a value is returned in a response, you can retrieve // the next set of records by providing this returned marker value in the Marker // parameter and retrying the command. If the Marker field is empty, all response // records have been retrieved for the request. Marker *string `type:"string"` // A list of tags with their associated resources. TaggedResources []*TaggedResource `locationNameList:"TaggedResource" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DescribeTagsOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DescribeTagsOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *DescribeTagsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *DescribeTagsOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetTaggedResources sets the TaggedResources field's value. func (s *DescribeTagsOutput) SetTaggedResources(v []*TaggedResource) *DescribeTagsOutput { s.TaggedResources = v return s } type DisableLoggingInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The identifier of the cluster on which logging is to be stopped. // // Example: examplecluster // // ClusterIdentifier is a required field ClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DisableLoggingInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DisableLoggingInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DisableLoggingInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DisableLoggingInput"} if s.ClusterIdentifier == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ClusterIdentifier")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetClusterIdentifier sets the ClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *DisableLoggingInput) SetClusterIdentifier(v string) *DisableLoggingInput { s.ClusterIdentifier = &v return s } type DisableSnapshotCopyInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The unique identifier of the source cluster that you want to disable copying // of snapshots to a destination region. // // Constraints: Must be the valid name of an existing cluster that has cross-region // snapshot copy enabled. // // ClusterIdentifier is a required field ClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DisableSnapshotCopyInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DisableSnapshotCopyInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *DisableSnapshotCopyInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DisableSnapshotCopyInput"} if s.ClusterIdentifier == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ClusterIdentifier")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetClusterIdentifier sets the ClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *DisableSnapshotCopyInput) SetClusterIdentifier(v string) *DisableSnapshotCopyInput { s.ClusterIdentifier = &v return s } type DisableSnapshotCopyOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Describes a cluster. Cluster *Cluster `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s DisableSnapshotCopyOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s DisableSnapshotCopyOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetCluster sets the Cluster field's value. func (s *DisableSnapshotCopyOutput) SetCluster(v *Cluster) *DisableSnapshotCopyOutput { s.Cluster = v return s } // Describes an Amazon EC2 security group. type EC2SecurityGroup struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the EC2 Security Group. EC2SecurityGroupName *string `type:"string"` // The AWS ID of the owner of the EC2 security group specified in the EC2SecurityGroupName // field. EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId *string `type:"string"` // The status of the EC2 security group. Status *string `type:"string"` // The list of tags for the EC2 security group. Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s EC2SecurityGroup) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s EC2SecurityGroup) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetEC2SecurityGroupName sets the EC2SecurityGroupName field's value. func (s *EC2SecurityGroup) SetEC2SecurityGroupName(v string) *EC2SecurityGroup { s.EC2SecurityGroupName = &v return s } // SetEC2SecurityGroupOwnerId sets the EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId field's value. func (s *EC2SecurityGroup) SetEC2SecurityGroupOwnerId(v string) *EC2SecurityGroup { s.EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId = &v return s } // SetStatus sets the Status field's value. func (s *EC2SecurityGroup) SetStatus(v string) *EC2SecurityGroup { s.Status = &v return s } // SetTags sets the Tags field's value. func (s *EC2SecurityGroup) SetTags(v []*Tag) *EC2SecurityGroup { s.Tags = v return s } // Describes the status of the elastic IP (EIP) address. type ElasticIpStatus struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The elastic IP (EIP) address for the cluster. ElasticIp *string `type:"string"` // The status of the elastic IP (EIP) address. Status *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ElasticIpStatus) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ElasticIpStatus) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetElasticIp sets the ElasticIp field's value. func (s *ElasticIpStatus) SetElasticIp(v string) *ElasticIpStatus { s.ElasticIp = &v return s } // SetStatus sets the Status field's value. func (s *ElasticIpStatus) SetStatus(v string) *ElasticIpStatus { s.Status = &v return s } type EnableLoggingInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of an existing S3 bucket where the log files are to be stored. // // Constraints: // // * Must be in the same region as the cluster // // * The cluster must have read bucket and put object permissions // // BucketName is a required field BucketName *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The identifier of the cluster on which logging is to be started. // // Example: examplecluster // // ClusterIdentifier is a required field ClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The prefix applied to the log file names. // // Constraints: // // * Cannot exceed 512 characters // // * Cannot contain spaces( ), double quotes ("), single quotes ('), a backslash // (\), or control characters. The hexadecimal codes for invalid characters // are: // // x00 to x20 // // x22 // // x27 // // x5c // // x7f or larger S3KeyPrefix *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s EnableLoggingInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s EnableLoggingInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *EnableLoggingInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "EnableLoggingInput"} if s.BucketName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("BucketName")) } if s.ClusterIdentifier == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ClusterIdentifier")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetBucketName sets the BucketName field's value. func (s *EnableLoggingInput) SetBucketName(v string) *EnableLoggingInput { s.BucketName = &v return s } // SetClusterIdentifier sets the ClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *EnableLoggingInput) SetClusterIdentifier(v string) *EnableLoggingInput { s.ClusterIdentifier = &v return s } // SetS3KeyPrefix sets the S3KeyPrefix field's value. func (s *EnableLoggingInput) SetS3KeyPrefix(v string) *EnableLoggingInput { s.S3KeyPrefix = &v return s } type EnableSnapshotCopyInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The unique identifier of the source cluster to copy snapshots from. // // Constraints: Must be the valid name of an existing cluster that does not // already have cross-region snapshot copy enabled. // // ClusterIdentifier is a required field ClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The destination AWS Region that you want to copy snapshots to. // // Constraints: Must be the name of a valid AWS Region. For more information, // see Regions and Endpoints (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/rande.html#redshift_region) // in the Amazon Web Services General Reference. // // DestinationRegion is a required field DestinationRegion *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The number of days to retain newly copied snapshots in the destination AWS // Region after they are copied from the source AWS Region. If the value is // -1, the manual snapshot is retained indefinitely. // // The value must be either -1 or an integer between 1 and 3,653. ManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"` // The number of days to retain automated snapshots in the destination region // after they are copied from the source region. // // Default: 7. // // Constraints: Must be at least 1 and no more than 35. RetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"` // The name of the snapshot copy grant to use when snapshots of an AWS KMS-encrypted // cluster are copied to the destination region. SnapshotCopyGrantName *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s EnableSnapshotCopyInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s EnableSnapshotCopyInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *EnableSnapshotCopyInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "EnableSnapshotCopyInput"} if s.ClusterIdentifier == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ClusterIdentifier")) } if s.DestinationRegion == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DestinationRegion")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetClusterIdentifier sets the ClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *EnableSnapshotCopyInput) SetClusterIdentifier(v string) *EnableSnapshotCopyInput { s.ClusterIdentifier = &v return s } // SetDestinationRegion sets the DestinationRegion field's value. func (s *EnableSnapshotCopyInput) SetDestinationRegion(v string) *EnableSnapshotCopyInput { s.DestinationRegion = &v return s } // SetManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod sets the ManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod field's value. func (s *EnableSnapshotCopyInput) SetManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod(v int64) *EnableSnapshotCopyInput { s.ManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod = &v return s } // SetRetentionPeriod sets the RetentionPeriod field's value. func (s *EnableSnapshotCopyInput) SetRetentionPeriod(v int64) *EnableSnapshotCopyInput { s.RetentionPeriod = &v return s } // SetSnapshotCopyGrantName sets the SnapshotCopyGrantName field's value. func (s *EnableSnapshotCopyInput) SetSnapshotCopyGrantName(v string) *EnableSnapshotCopyInput { s.SnapshotCopyGrantName = &v return s } type EnableSnapshotCopyOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Describes a cluster. Cluster *Cluster `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s EnableSnapshotCopyOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s EnableSnapshotCopyOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetCluster sets the Cluster field's value. func (s *EnableSnapshotCopyOutput) SetCluster(v *Cluster) *EnableSnapshotCopyOutput { s.Cluster = v return s } // Describes a connection endpoint. type Endpoint struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The DNS address of the Cluster. Address *string `type:"string"` // The port that the database engine is listening on. Port *int64 `type:"integer"` } // String returns the string representation func (s Endpoint) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s Endpoint) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetAddress sets the Address field's value. func (s *Endpoint) SetAddress(v string) *Endpoint { s.Address = &v return s } // SetPort sets the Port field's value. func (s *Endpoint) SetPort(v int64) *Endpoint { s.Port = &v return s } // Describes an event. type Event struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The date and time of the event. Date *time.Time `type:"timestamp"` // A list of the event categories. // // Values: Configuration, Management, Monitoring, Security EventCategories []*string `locationNameList:"EventCategory" type:"list"` // The identifier of the event. EventId *string `type:"string"` // The text of this event. Message *string `type:"string"` // The severity of the event. // // Values: ERROR, INFO Severity *string `type:"string"` // The identifier for the source of the event. SourceIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // The source type for this event. SourceType *string `type:"string" enum:"SourceType"` } // String returns the string representation func (s Event) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s Event) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetDate sets the Date field's value. func (s *Event) SetDate(v time.Time) *Event { s.Date = &v return s } // SetEventCategories sets the EventCategories field's value. func (s *Event) SetEventCategories(v []*string) *Event { s.EventCategories = v return s } // SetEventId sets the EventId field's value. func (s *Event) SetEventId(v string) *Event { s.EventId = &v return s } // SetMessage sets the Message field's value. func (s *Event) SetMessage(v string) *Event { s.Message = &v return s } // SetSeverity sets the Severity field's value. func (s *Event) SetSeverity(v string) *Event { s.Severity = &v return s } // SetSourceIdentifier sets the SourceIdentifier field's value. func (s *Event) SetSourceIdentifier(v string) *Event { s.SourceIdentifier = &v return s } // SetSourceType sets the SourceType field's value. func (s *Event) SetSourceType(v string) *Event { s.SourceType = &v return s } // Describes event categories. type EventCategoriesMap struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The events in the event category. Events []*EventInfoMap `locationNameList:"EventInfoMap" type:"list"` // The source type, such as cluster or cluster-snapshot, that the returned categories // belong to. SourceType *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s EventCategoriesMap) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s EventCategoriesMap) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetEvents sets the Events field's value. func (s *EventCategoriesMap) SetEvents(v []*EventInfoMap) *EventCategoriesMap { s.Events = v return s } // SetSourceType sets the SourceType field's value. func (s *EventCategoriesMap) SetSourceType(v string) *EventCategoriesMap { s.SourceType = &v return s } // Describes event information. type EventInfoMap struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The category of an Amazon Redshift event. EventCategories []*string `locationNameList:"EventCategory" type:"list"` // The description of an Amazon Redshift event. EventDescription *string `type:"string"` // The identifier of an Amazon Redshift event. EventId *string `type:"string"` // The severity of the event. // // Values: ERROR, INFO Severity *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s EventInfoMap) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s EventInfoMap) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetEventCategories sets the EventCategories field's value. func (s *EventInfoMap) SetEventCategories(v []*string) *EventInfoMap { s.EventCategories = v return s } // SetEventDescription sets the EventDescription field's value. func (s *EventInfoMap) SetEventDescription(v string) *EventInfoMap { s.EventDescription = &v return s } // SetEventId sets the EventId field's value. func (s *EventInfoMap) SetEventId(v string) *EventInfoMap { s.EventId = &v return s } // SetSeverity sets the Severity field's value. func (s *EventInfoMap) SetSeverity(v string) *EventInfoMap { s.Severity = &v return s } // Describes event subscriptions. type EventSubscription struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the Amazon Redshift event notification subscription. CustSubscriptionId *string `type:"string"` // The AWS customer account associated with the Amazon Redshift event notification // subscription. CustomerAwsId *string `type:"string"` // A boolean value indicating whether the subscription is enabled; true indicates // that the subscription is enabled. Enabled *bool `type:"boolean"` // The list of Amazon Redshift event categories specified in the event notification // subscription. // // Values: Configuration, Management, Monitoring, Security EventCategoriesList []*string `locationNameList:"EventCategory" type:"list"` // The event severity specified in the Amazon Redshift event notification subscription. // // Values: ERROR, INFO Severity *string `type:"string"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the Amazon SNS topic used by the event // notification subscription. SnsTopicArn *string `type:"string"` // A list of the sources that publish events to the Amazon Redshift event notification // subscription. SourceIdsList []*string `locationNameList:"SourceId" type:"list"` // The source type of the events returned the Amazon Redshift event notification, // such as cluster, or cluster-snapshot. SourceType *string `type:"string"` // The status of the Amazon Redshift event notification subscription. // // Constraints: // // * Can be one of the following: active | no-permission | topic-not-exist // // * The status "no-permission" indicates that Amazon Redshift no longer // has permission to post to the Amazon SNS topic. The status "topic-not-exist" // indicates that the topic was deleted after the subscription was created. Status *string `type:"string"` // The date and time the Amazon Redshift event notification subscription was // created. SubscriptionCreationTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"` // The list of tags for the event subscription. Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s EventSubscription) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s EventSubscription) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetCustSubscriptionId sets the CustSubscriptionId field's value. func (s *EventSubscription) SetCustSubscriptionId(v string) *EventSubscription { s.CustSubscriptionId = &v return s } // SetCustomerAwsId sets the CustomerAwsId field's value. func (s *EventSubscription) SetCustomerAwsId(v string) *EventSubscription { s.CustomerAwsId = &v return s } // SetEnabled sets the Enabled field's value. func (s *EventSubscription) SetEnabled(v bool) *EventSubscription { s.Enabled = &v return s } // SetEventCategoriesList sets the EventCategoriesList field's value. func (s *EventSubscription) SetEventCategoriesList(v []*string) *EventSubscription { s.EventCategoriesList = v return s } // SetSeverity sets the Severity field's value. func (s *EventSubscription) SetSeverity(v string) *EventSubscription { s.Severity = &v return s } // SetSnsTopicArn sets the SnsTopicArn field's value. func (s *EventSubscription) SetSnsTopicArn(v string) *EventSubscription { s.SnsTopicArn = &v return s } // SetSourceIdsList sets the SourceIdsList field's value. func (s *EventSubscription) SetSourceIdsList(v []*string) *EventSubscription { s.SourceIdsList = v return s } // SetSourceType sets the SourceType field's value. func (s *EventSubscription) SetSourceType(v string) *EventSubscription { s.SourceType = &v return s } // SetStatus sets the Status field's value. func (s *EventSubscription) SetStatus(v string) *EventSubscription { s.Status = &v return s } // SetSubscriptionCreationTime sets the SubscriptionCreationTime field's value. func (s *EventSubscription) SetSubscriptionCreationTime(v time.Time) *EventSubscription { s.SubscriptionCreationTime = &v return s } // SetTags sets the Tags field's value. func (s *EventSubscription) SetTags(v []*Tag) *EventSubscription { s.Tags = v return s } // The request parameters to get cluster credentials. type GetClusterCredentialsInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Create a database user with the name specified for the user named in DbUser // if one does not exist. AutoCreate *bool `type:"boolean"` // The unique identifier of the cluster that contains the database for which // your are requesting credentials. This parameter is case sensitive. // // ClusterIdentifier is a required field ClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // A list of the names of existing database groups that the user named in DbUser // will join for the current session, in addition to any group memberships for // an existing user. If not specified, a new user is added only to PUBLIC. // // Database group name constraints // // * Must be 1 to 64 alphanumeric characters or hyphens // // * Must contain only lowercase letters, numbers, underscore, plus sign, // period (dot), at symbol (@), or hyphen. // // * First character must be a letter. // // * Must not contain a colon ( : ) or slash ( / ). // // * Cannot be a reserved word. A list of reserved words can be found in // Reserved Words (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/dg/r_pg_keywords.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Database Developer Guide. DbGroups []*string `locationNameList:"DbGroup" type:"list"` // The name of a database that DbUser is authorized to log on to. If DbName // is not specified, DbUser can log on to any existing database. // // Constraints: // // * Must be 1 to 64 alphanumeric characters or hyphens // // * Must contain only lowercase letters, numbers, underscore, plus sign, // period (dot), at symbol (@), or hyphen. // // * First character must be a letter. // // * Must not contain a colon ( : ) or slash ( / ). // // * Cannot be a reserved word. A list of reserved words can be found in // Reserved Words (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/dg/r_pg_keywords.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Database Developer Guide. DbName *string `type:"string"` // The name of a database user. If a user name matching DbUser exists in the // database, the temporary user credentials have the same permissions as the // existing user. If DbUser doesn't exist in the database and Autocreate is // True, a new user is created using the value for DbUser with PUBLIC permissions. // If a database user matching the value for DbUser doesn't exist and Autocreate // is False, then the command succeeds but the connection attempt will fail // because the user doesn't exist in the database. // // For more information, see CREATE USER (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/dg/r_CREATE_USER.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Database Developer Guide. // // Constraints: // // * Must be 1 to 64 alphanumeric characters or hyphens. The user name can't // be PUBLIC. // // * Must contain only lowercase letters, numbers, underscore, plus sign, // period (dot), at symbol (@), or hyphen. // // * First character must be a letter. // // * Must not contain a colon ( : ) or slash ( / ). // // * Cannot be a reserved word. A list of reserved words can be found in // Reserved Words (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/dg/r_pg_keywords.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Database Developer Guide. // // DbUser is a required field DbUser *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The number of seconds until the returned temporary password expires. // // Constraint: minimum 900, maximum 3600. // // Default: 900 DurationSeconds *int64 `type:"integer"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetClusterCredentialsInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetClusterCredentialsInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *GetClusterCredentialsInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetClusterCredentialsInput"} if s.ClusterIdentifier == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ClusterIdentifier")) } if s.DbUser == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DbUser")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAutoCreate sets the AutoCreate field's value. func (s *GetClusterCredentialsInput) SetAutoCreate(v bool) *GetClusterCredentialsInput { s.AutoCreate = &v return s } // SetClusterIdentifier sets the ClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *GetClusterCredentialsInput) SetClusterIdentifier(v string) *GetClusterCredentialsInput { s.ClusterIdentifier = &v return s } // SetDbGroups sets the DbGroups field's value. func (s *GetClusterCredentialsInput) SetDbGroups(v []*string) *GetClusterCredentialsInput { s.DbGroups = v return s } // SetDbName sets the DbName field's value. func (s *GetClusterCredentialsInput) SetDbName(v string) *GetClusterCredentialsInput { s.DbName = &v return s } // SetDbUser sets the DbUser field's value. func (s *GetClusterCredentialsInput) SetDbUser(v string) *GetClusterCredentialsInput { s.DbUser = &v return s } // SetDurationSeconds sets the DurationSeconds field's value. func (s *GetClusterCredentialsInput) SetDurationSeconds(v int64) *GetClusterCredentialsInput { s.DurationSeconds = &v return s } // Temporary credentials with authorization to log on to an Amazon Redshift // database. type GetClusterCredentialsOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A temporary password that authorizes the user name returned by DbUser to // log on to the database DbName. DbPassword *string `type:"string" sensitive:"true"` // A database user name that is authorized to log on to the database DbName // using the password DbPassword. If the specified DbUser exists in the database, // the new user name has the same database privileges as the the user named // in DbUser. By default, the user is added to PUBLIC. If the DbGroups parameter // is specifed, DbUser is added to the listed groups for any sessions created // using these credentials. DbUser *string `type:"string"` // The date and time the password in DbPassword expires. Expiration *time.Time `type:"timestamp"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetClusterCredentialsOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetClusterCredentialsOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetDbPassword sets the DbPassword field's value. func (s *GetClusterCredentialsOutput) SetDbPassword(v string) *GetClusterCredentialsOutput { s.DbPassword = &v return s } // SetDbUser sets the DbUser field's value. func (s *GetClusterCredentialsOutput) SetDbUser(v string) *GetClusterCredentialsOutput { s.DbUser = &v return s } // SetExpiration sets the Expiration field's value. func (s *GetClusterCredentialsOutput) SetExpiration(v time.Time) *GetClusterCredentialsOutput { s.Expiration = &v return s } type GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferingsInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A value that indicates the starting point for the next set of ReservedNodeOfferings. Marker *string `type:"string"` // An integer setting the maximum number of ReservedNodeOfferings to retrieve. MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"` // A string representing the node identifier for the DC1 Reserved Node to be // exchanged. // // ReservedNodeId is a required field ReservedNodeId *string `type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferingsInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferingsInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferingsInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferingsInput"} if s.ReservedNodeId == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ReservedNodeId")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferingsInput) SetMarker(v string) *GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferingsInput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value. func (s *GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferingsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferingsInput { s.MaxRecords = &v return s } // SetReservedNodeId sets the ReservedNodeId field's value. func (s *GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferingsInput) SetReservedNodeId(v string) *GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferingsInput { s.ReservedNodeId = &v return s } type GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferingsOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // An optional parameter that specifies the starting point for returning a set // of response records. When the results of a GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferings // request exceed the value specified in MaxRecords, Amazon Redshift returns // a value in the marker field of the response. You can retrieve the next set // of response records by providing the returned marker value in the marker // parameter and retrying the request. Marker *string `type:"string"` // Returns an array of ReservedNodeOffering objects. ReservedNodeOfferings []*ReservedNodeOffering `locationNameList:"ReservedNodeOffering" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferingsOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferingsOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetMarker sets the Marker field's value. func (s *GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferingsOutput) SetMarker(v string) *GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferingsOutput { s.Marker = &v return s } // SetReservedNodeOfferings sets the ReservedNodeOfferings field's value. func (s *GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferingsOutput) SetReservedNodeOfferings(v []*ReservedNodeOffering) *GetReservedNodeExchangeOfferingsOutput { s.ReservedNodeOfferings = v return s } // Returns information about an HSM client certificate. The certificate is stored // in a secure Hardware Storage Module (HSM), and used by the Amazon Redshift // cluster to encrypt data files. type HsmClientCertificate struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The identifier of the HSM client certificate. HsmClientCertificateIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // The public key that the Amazon Redshift cluster will use to connect to the // HSM. You must register the public key in the HSM. HsmClientCertificatePublicKey *string `type:"string"` // The list of tags for the HSM client certificate. Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s HsmClientCertificate) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s HsmClientCertificate) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetHsmClientCertificateIdentifier sets the HsmClientCertificateIdentifier field's value. func (s *HsmClientCertificate) SetHsmClientCertificateIdentifier(v string) *HsmClientCertificate { s.HsmClientCertificateIdentifier = &v return s } // SetHsmClientCertificatePublicKey sets the HsmClientCertificatePublicKey field's value. func (s *HsmClientCertificate) SetHsmClientCertificatePublicKey(v string) *HsmClientCertificate { s.HsmClientCertificatePublicKey = &v return s } // SetTags sets the Tags field's value. func (s *HsmClientCertificate) SetTags(v []*Tag) *HsmClientCertificate { s.Tags = v return s } // Returns information about an HSM configuration, which is an object that describes // to Amazon Redshift clusters the information they require to connect to an // HSM where they can store database encryption keys. type HsmConfiguration struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A text description of the HSM configuration. Description *string `type:"string"` // The name of the Amazon Redshift HSM configuration. HsmConfigurationIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // The IP address that the Amazon Redshift cluster must use to access the HSM. HsmIpAddress *string `type:"string"` // The name of the partition in the HSM where the Amazon Redshift clusters will // store their database encryption keys. HsmPartitionName *string `type:"string"` // The list of tags for the HSM configuration. Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s HsmConfiguration) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s HsmConfiguration) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetDescription sets the Description field's value. func (s *HsmConfiguration) SetDescription(v string) *HsmConfiguration { s.Description = &v return s } // SetHsmConfigurationIdentifier sets the HsmConfigurationIdentifier field's value. func (s *HsmConfiguration) SetHsmConfigurationIdentifier(v string) *HsmConfiguration { s.HsmConfigurationIdentifier = &v return s } // SetHsmIpAddress sets the HsmIpAddress field's value. func (s *HsmConfiguration) SetHsmIpAddress(v string) *HsmConfiguration { s.HsmIpAddress = &v return s } // SetHsmPartitionName sets the HsmPartitionName field's value. func (s *HsmConfiguration) SetHsmPartitionName(v string) *HsmConfiguration { s.HsmPartitionName = &v return s } // SetTags sets the Tags field's value. func (s *HsmConfiguration) SetTags(v []*Tag) *HsmConfiguration { s.Tags = v return s } // Describes the status of changes to HSM settings. type HsmStatus struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Specifies the name of the HSM client certificate the Amazon Redshift cluster // uses to retrieve the data encryption keys stored in an HSM. HsmClientCertificateIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // Specifies the name of the HSM configuration that contains the information // the Amazon Redshift cluster can use to retrieve and store keys in an HSM. HsmConfigurationIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // Reports whether the Amazon Redshift cluster has finished applying any HSM // settings changes specified in a modify cluster command. // // Values: active, applying Status *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s HsmStatus) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s HsmStatus) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetHsmClientCertificateIdentifier sets the HsmClientCertificateIdentifier field's value. func (s *HsmStatus) SetHsmClientCertificateIdentifier(v string) *HsmStatus { s.HsmClientCertificateIdentifier = &v return s } // SetHsmConfigurationIdentifier sets the HsmConfigurationIdentifier field's value. func (s *HsmStatus) SetHsmConfigurationIdentifier(v string) *HsmStatus { s.HsmConfigurationIdentifier = &v return s } // SetStatus sets the Status field's value. func (s *HsmStatus) SetStatus(v string) *HsmStatus { s.Status = &v return s } // Describes an IP range used in a security group. type IPRange struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The IP range in Classless Inter-Domain Routing (CIDR) notation. CIDRIP *string `type:"string"` // The status of the IP range, for example, "authorized". Status *string `type:"string"` // The list of tags for the IP range. Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s IPRange) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s IPRange) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetCIDRIP sets the CIDRIP field's value. func (s *IPRange) SetCIDRIP(v string) *IPRange { s.CIDRIP = &v return s } // SetStatus sets the Status field's value. func (s *IPRange) SetStatus(v string) *IPRange { s.Status = &v return s } // SetTags sets the Tags field's value. func (s *IPRange) SetTags(v []*Tag) *IPRange { s.Tags = v return s } // Describes the status of logging for a cluster. type LoggingStatus struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the S3 bucket where the log files are stored. BucketName *string `type:"string"` // The message indicating that logs failed to be delivered. LastFailureMessage *string `type:"string"` // The last time when logs failed to be delivered. LastFailureTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"` // The last time that logs were delivered. LastSuccessfulDeliveryTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"` // true if logging is on, false if logging is off. LoggingEnabled *bool `type:"boolean"` // The prefix applied to the log file names. S3KeyPrefix *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s LoggingStatus) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s LoggingStatus) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetBucketName sets the BucketName field's value. func (s *LoggingStatus) SetBucketName(v string) *LoggingStatus { s.BucketName = &v return s } // SetLastFailureMessage sets the LastFailureMessage field's value. func (s *LoggingStatus) SetLastFailureMessage(v string) *LoggingStatus { s.LastFailureMessage = &v return s } // SetLastFailureTime sets the LastFailureTime field's value. func (s *LoggingStatus) SetLastFailureTime(v time.Time) *LoggingStatus { s.LastFailureTime = &v return s } // SetLastSuccessfulDeliveryTime sets the LastSuccessfulDeliveryTime field's value. func (s *LoggingStatus) SetLastSuccessfulDeliveryTime(v time.Time) *LoggingStatus { s.LastSuccessfulDeliveryTime = &v return s } // SetLoggingEnabled sets the LoggingEnabled field's value. func (s *LoggingStatus) SetLoggingEnabled(v bool) *LoggingStatus { s.LoggingEnabled = &v return s } // SetS3KeyPrefix sets the S3KeyPrefix field's value. func (s *LoggingStatus) SetS3KeyPrefix(v string) *LoggingStatus { s.S3KeyPrefix = &v return s } // Defines a maintenance track that determines which Amazon Redshift version // to apply during a maintenance window. If the value for MaintenanceTrack is // current, the cluster is updated to the most recently certified maintenance // release. If the value is trailing, the cluster is updated to the previously // certified maintenance release. type MaintenanceTrack struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The version number for the cluster release. DatabaseVersion *string `type:"string"` // The name of the maintenance track. Possible values are current and trailing. MaintenanceTrackName *string `type:"string"` // An array of UpdateTarget objects to update with the maintenance track. UpdateTargets []*UpdateTarget `locationNameList:"UpdateTarget" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s MaintenanceTrack) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s MaintenanceTrack) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetDatabaseVersion sets the DatabaseVersion field's value. func (s *MaintenanceTrack) SetDatabaseVersion(v string) *MaintenanceTrack { s.DatabaseVersion = &v return s } // SetMaintenanceTrackName sets the MaintenanceTrackName field's value. func (s *MaintenanceTrack) SetMaintenanceTrackName(v string) *MaintenanceTrack { s.MaintenanceTrackName = &v return s } // SetUpdateTargets sets the UpdateTargets field's value. func (s *MaintenanceTrack) SetUpdateTargets(v []*UpdateTarget) *MaintenanceTrack { s.UpdateTargets = v return s } type ModifyClusterDbRevisionInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The unique identifier of a cluster whose database revision you want to modify. // // Example: examplecluster // // ClusterIdentifier is a required field ClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The identifier of the database revision. You can retrieve this value from // the response to the DescribeClusterDbRevisions request. // // RevisionTarget is a required field RevisionTarget *string `type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ModifyClusterDbRevisionInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ModifyClusterDbRevisionInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ModifyClusterDbRevisionInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ModifyClusterDbRevisionInput"} if s.ClusterIdentifier == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ClusterIdentifier")) } if s.RevisionTarget == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("RevisionTarget")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetClusterIdentifier sets the ClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterDbRevisionInput) SetClusterIdentifier(v string) *ModifyClusterDbRevisionInput { s.ClusterIdentifier = &v return s } // SetRevisionTarget sets the RevisionTarget field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterDbRevisionInput) SetRevisionTarget(v string) *ModifyClusterDbRevisionInput { s.RevisionTarget = &v return s } type ModifyClusterDbRevisionOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Describes a cluster. Cluster *Cluster `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ModifyClusterDbRevisionOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ModifyClusterDbRevisionOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetCluster sets the Cluster field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterDbRevisionOutput) SetCluster(v *Cluster) *ModifyClusterDbRevisionOutput { s.Cluster = v return s } type ModifyClusterIamRolesInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Zero or more IAM roles to associate with the cluster. The roles must be in // their Amazon Resource Name (ARN) format. You can associate up to 10 IAM roles // with a single cluster in a single request. AddIamRoles []*string `locationNameList:"IamRoleArn" type:"list"` // The unique identifier of the cluster for which you want to associate or disassociate // IAM roles. // // ClusterIdentifier is a required field ClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // Zero or more IAM roles in ARN format to disassociate from the cluster. You // can disassociate up to 10 IAM roles from a single cluster in a single request. RemoveIamRoles []*string `locationNameList:"IamRoleArn" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ModifyClusterIamRolesInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ModifyClusterIamRolesInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ModifyClusterIamRolesInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ModifyClusterIamRolesInput"} if s.ClusterIdentifier == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ClusterIdentifier")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAddIamRoles sets the AddIamRoles field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterIamRolesInput) SetAddIamRoles(v []*string) *ModifyClusterIamRolesInput { s.AddIamRoles = v return s } // SetClusterIdentifier sets the ClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterIamRolesInput) SetClusterIdentifier(v string) *ModifyClusterIamRolesInput { s.ClusterIdentifier = &v return s } // SetRemoveIamRoles sets the RemoveIamRoles field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterIamRolesInput) SetRemoveIamRoles(v []*string) *ModifyClusterIamRolesInput { s.RemoveIamRoles = v return s } type ModifyClusterIamRolesOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Describes a cluster. Cluster *Cluster `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ModifyClusterIamRolesOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ModifyClusterIamRolesOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetCluster sets the Cluster field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterIamRolesOutput) SetCluster(v *Cluster) *ModifyClusterIamRolesOutput { s.Cluster = v return s } type ModifyClusterInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // If true, major version upgrades will be applied automatically to the cluster // during the maintenance window. // // Default: false AllowVersionUpgrade *bool `type:"boolean"` // The number of days that automated snapshots are retained. If the value is // 0, automated snapshots are disabled. Even if automated snapshots are disabled, // you can still create manual snapshots when you want with CreateClusterSnapshot. // // If you decrease the automated snapshot retention period from its current // value, existing automated snapshots that fall outside of the new retention // period will be immediately deleted. // // Default: Uses existing setting. // // Constraints: Must be a value from 0 to 35. AutomatedSnapshotRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"` // The unique identifier of the cluster to be modified. // // Example: examplecluster // // ClusterIdentifier is a required field ClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The name of the cluster parameter group to apply to this cluster. This change // is applied only after the cluster is rebooted. To reboot a cluster use RebootCluster. // // Default: Uses existing setting. // // Constraints: The cluster parameter group must be in the same parameter group // family that matches the cluster version. ClusterParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"` // A list of cluster security groups to be authorized on this cluster. This // change is asynchronously applied as soon as possible. // // Security groups currently associated with the cluster, and not in the list // of groups to apply, will be revoked from the cluster. // // Constraints: // // * Must be 1 to 255 alphanumeric characters or hyphens // // * First character must be a letter // // * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens ClusterSecurityGroups []*string `locationNameList:"ClusterSecurityGroupName" type:"list"` // The new cluster type. // // When you submit your cluster resize request, your existing cluster goes into // a read-only mode. After Amazon Redshift provisions a new cluster based on // your resize requirements, there will be outage for a period while the old // cluster is deleted and your connection is switched to the new cluster. You // can use DescribeResize to track the progress of the resize request. // // Valid Values: multi-node | single-node ClusterType *string `type:"string"` // The new version number of the Amazon Redshift engine to upgrade to. // // For major version upgrades, if a non-default cluster parameter group is currently // in use, a new cluster parameter group in the cluster parameter group family // for the new version must be specified. The new cluster parameter group can // be the default for that cluster parameter group family. For more information // about parameters and parameter groups, go to Amazon Redshift Parameter Groups // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-parameter-groups.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // Example: 1.0 ClusterVersion *string `type:"string"` // The Elastic IP (EIP) address for the cluster. // // Constraints: The cluster must be provisioned in EC2-VPC and publicly-accessible // through an Internet gateway. For more information about provisioning clusters // in EC2-VPC, go to Supported Platforms to Launch Your Cluster (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-clusters.html#cluster-platforms) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. ElasticIp *string `type:"string"` // Indicates whether the cluster is encrypted. If the cluster is encrypted and // you provide a value for the KmsKeyId parameter, we will encrypt the cluster // with the provided KmsKeyId. If you don't provide a KmsKeyId, we will encrypt // with the default key. In the China region we will use legacy encryption if // you specify that the cluster is encrypted. Encrypted *bool `type:"boolean"` // An option that specifies whether to create the cluster with enhanced VPC // routing enabled. To create a cluster that uses enhanced VPC routing, the // cluster must be in a VPC. For more information, see Enhanced VPC Routing // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/enhanced-vpc-routing.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // If this option is true, enhanced VPC routing is enabled. // // Default: false EnhancedVpcRouting *bool `type:"boolean"` // Specifies the name of the HSM client certificate the Amazon Redshift cluster // uses to retrieve the data encryption keys stored in an HSM. HsmClientCertificateIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // Specifies the name of the HSM configuration that contains the information // the Amazon Redshift cluster can use to retrieve and store keys in an HSM. HsmConfigurationIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // The AWS Key Management Service (KMS) key ID of the encryption key that you // want to use to encrypt data in the cluster. KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"` // The name for the maintenance track that you want to assign for the cluster. // This name change is asynchronous. The new track name stays in the PendingModifiedValues // for the cluster until the next maintenance window. When the maintenance track // changes, the cluster is switched to the latest cluster release available // for the maintenance track. At this point, the maintenance track name is applied. MaintenanceTrackName *string `type:"string"` // The default for number of days that a newly created manual snapshot is retained. // If the value is -1, the manual snapshot is retained indefinitely. This value // doesn't retroactively change the retention periods of existing manual snapshots. // // The value must be either -1 or an integer between 1 and 3,653. // // The default value is -1. ManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"` // The new password for the cluster master user. This change is asynchronously // applied as soon as possible. Between the time of the request and the completion // of the request, the MasterUserPassword element exists in the PendingModifiedValues // element of the operation response. // // Operations never return the password, so this operation provides a way to // regain access to the master user account for a cluster if the password is // lost. // // Default: Uses existing setting. // // Constraints: // // * Must be between 8 and 64 characters in length. // // * Must contain at least one uppercase letter. // // * Must contain at least one lowercase letter. // // * Must contain one number. // // * Can be any printable ASCII character (ASCII code 33 to 126) except ' // (single quote), " (double quote), \, /, @, or space. MasterUserPassword *string `type:"string"` // The new identifier for the cluster. // // Constraints: // // * Must contain from 1 to 63 alphanumeric characters or hyphens. // // * Alphabetic characters must be lowercase. // // * First character must be a letter. // // * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens. // // * Must be unique for all clusters within an AWS account. // // Example: examplecluster NewClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // The new node type of the cluster. If you specify a new node type, you must // also specify the number of nodes parameter. // // When you submit your request to resize a cluster, Amazon Redshift sets access // permissions for the cluster to read-only. After Amazon Redshift provisions // a new cluster according to your resize requirements, there will be a temporary // outage while the old cluster is deleted and your connection is switched to // the new cluster. When the new connection is complete, the original access // permissions for the cluster are restored. You can use DescribeResize to track // the progress of the resize request. // // Valid Values: ds2.xlarge | ds2.8xlarge | dc1.large | dc1.8xlarge | dc2.large // | dc2.8xlarge NodeType *string `type:"string"` // The new number of nodes of the cluster. If you specify a new number of nodes, // you must also specify the node type parameter. // // When you submit your request to resize a cluster, Amazon Redshift sets access // permissions for the cluster to read-only. After Amazon Redshift provisions // a new cluster according to your resize requirements, there will be a temporary // outage while the old cluster is deleted and your connection is switched to // the new cluster. When the new connection is complete, the original access // permissions for the cluster are restored. You can use DescribeResize to track // the progress of the resize request. // // Valid Values: Integer greater than 0. NumberOfNodes *int64 `type:"integer"` // The weekly time range (in UTC) during which system maintenance can occur, // if necessary. If system maintenance is necessary during the window, it may // result in an outage. // // This maintenance window change is made immediately. If the new maintenance // window indicates the current time, there must be at least 120 minutes between // the current time and end of the window in order to ensure that pending changes // are applied. // // Default: Uses existing setting. // // Format: ddd:hh24:mi-ddd:hh24:mi, for example wed:07:30-wed:08:00. // // Valid Days: Mon | Tue | Wed | Thu | Fri | Sat | Sun // // Constraints: Must be at least 30 minutes. PreferredMaintenanceWindow *string `type:"string"` // If true, the cluster can be accessed from a public network. Only clusters // in VPCs can be set to be publicly available. PubliclyAccessible *bool `type:"boolean"` // A list of virtual private cloud (VPC) security groups to be associated with // the cluster. This change is asynchronously applied as soon as possible. VpcSecurityGroupIds []*string `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupId" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ModifyClusterInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ModifyClusterInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ModifyClusterInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ModifyClusterInput"} if s.ClusterIdentifier == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ClusterIdentifier")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAllowVersionUpgrade sets the AllowVersionUpgrade field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterInput) SetAllowVersionUpgrade(v bool) *ModifyClusterInput { s.AllowVersionUpgrade = &v return s } // SetAutomatedSnapshotRetentionPeriod sets the AutomatedSnapshotRetentionPeriod field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterInput) SetAutomatedSnapshotRetentionPeriod(v int64) *ModifyClusterInput { s.AutomatedSnapshotRetentionPeriod = &v return s } // SetClusterIdentifier sets the ClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterInput) SetClusterIdentifier(v string) *ModifyClusterInput { s.ClusterIdentifier = &v return s } // SetClusterParameterGroupName sets the ClusterParameterGroupName field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterInput) SetClusterParameterGroupName(v string) *ModifyClusterInput { s.ClusterParameterGroupName = &v return s } // SetClusterSecurityGroups sets the ClusterSecurityGroups field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterInput) SetClusterSecurityGroups(v []*string) *ModifyClusterInput { s.ClusterSecurityGroups = v return s } // SetClusterType sets the ClusterType field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterInput) SetClusterType(v string) *ModifyClusterInput { s.ClusterType = &v return s } // SetClusterVersion sets the ClusterVersion field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterInput) SetClusterVersion(v string) *ModifyClusterInput { s.ClusterVersion = &v return s } // SetElasticIp sets the ElasticIp field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterInput) SetElasticIp(v string) *ModifyClusterInput { s.ElasticIp = &v return s } // SetEncrypted sets the Encrypted field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterInput) SetEncrypted(v bool) *ModifyClusterInput { s.Encrypted = &v return s } // SetEnhancedVpcRouting sets the EnhancedVpcRouting field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterInput) SetEnhancedVpcRouting(v bool) *ModifyClusterInput { s.EnhancedVpcRouting = &v return s } // SetHsmClientCertificateIdentifier sets the HsmClientCertificateIdentifier field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterInput) SetHsmClientCertificateIdentifier(v string) *ModifyClusterInput { s.HsmClientCertificateIdentifier = &v return s } // SetHsmConfigurationIdentifier sets the HsmConfigurationIdentifier field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterInput) SetHsmConfigurationIdentifier(v string) *ModifyClusterInput { s.HsmConfigurationIdentifier = &v return s } // SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterInput) SetKmsKeyId(v string) *ModifyClusterInput { s.KmsKeyId = &v return s } // SetMaintenanceTrackName sets the MaintenanceTrackName field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterInput) SetMaintenanceTrackName(v string) *ModifyClusterInput { s.MaintenanceTrackName = &v return s } // SetManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod sets the ManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterInput) SetManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod(v int64) *ModifyClusterInput { s.ManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod = &v return s } // SetMasterUserPassword sets the MasterUserPassword field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterInput) SetMasterUserPassword(v string) *ModifyClusterInput { s.MasterUserPassword = &v return s } // SetNewClusterIdentifier sets the NewClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterInput) SetNewClusterIdentifier(v string) *ModifyClusterInput { s.NewClusterIdentifier = &v return s } // SetNodeType sets the NodeType field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterInput) SetNodeType(v string) *ModifyClusterInput { s.NodeType = &v return s } // SetNumberOfNodes sets the NumberOfNodes field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterInput) SetNumberOfNodes(v int64) *ModifyClusterInput { s.NumberOfNodes = &v return s } // SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow sets the PreferredMaintenanceWindow field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterInput) SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow(v string) *ModifyClusterInput { s.PreferredMaintenanceWindow = &v return s } // SetPubliclyAccessible sets the PubliclyAccessible field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterInput) SetPubliclyAccessible(v bool) *ModifyClusterInput { s.PubliclyAccessible = &v return s } // SetVpcSecurityGroupIds sets the VpcSecurityGroupIds field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterInput) SetVpcSecurityGroupIds(v []*string) *ModifyClusterInput { s.VpcSecurityGroupIds = v return s } type ModifyClusterMaintenanceInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A unique identifier for the cluster. // // ClusterIdentifier is a required field ClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // A boolean indicating whether to enable the deferred maintenance window. DeferMaintenance *bool `type:"boolean"` // An integer indicating the duration of the maintenance window in days. If // you specify a duration, you can't specify an end time. The duration must // be 14 days or less. DeferMaintenanceDuration *int64 `type:"integer"` // A timestamp indicating end time for the deferred maintenance window. If you // specify an end time, you can't specify a duration. DeferMaintenanceEndTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"` // A unique identifier for the deferred maintenance window. DeferMaintenanceIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // A timestamp indicating the start time for the deferred maintenance window. DeferMaintenanceStartTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ModifyClusterMaintenanceInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ModifyClusterMaintenanceInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ModifyClusterMaintenanceInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ModifyClusterMaintenanceInput"} if s.ClusterIdentifier == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ClusterIdentifier")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetClusterIdentifier sets the ClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterMaintenanceInput) SetClusterIdentifier(v string) *ModifyClusterMaintenanceInput { s.ClusterIdentifier = &v return s } // SetDeferMaintenance sets the DeferMaintenance field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterMaintenanceInput) SetDeferMaintenance(v bool) *ModifyClusterMaintenanceInput { s.DeferMaintenance = &v return s } // SetDeferMaintenanceDuration sets the DeferMaintenanceDuration field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterMaintenanceInput) SetDeferMaintenanceDuration(v int64) *ModifyClusterMaintenanceInput { s.DeferMaintenanceDuration = &v return s } // SetDeferMaintenanceEndTime sets the DeferMaintenanceEndTime field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterMaintenanceInput) SetDeferMaintenanceEndTime(v time.Time) *ModifyClusterMaintenanceInput { s.DeferMaintenanceEndTime = &v return s } // SetDeferMaintenanceIdentifier sets the DeferMaintenanceIdentifier field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterMaintenanceInput) SetDeferMaintenanceIdentifier(v string) *ModifyClusterMaintenanceInput { s.DeferMaintenanceIdentifier = &v return s } // SetDeferMaintenanceStartTime sets the DeferMaintenanceStartTime field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterMaintenanceInput) SetDeferMaintenanceStartTime(v time.Time) *ModifyClusterMaintenanceInput { s.DeferMaintenanceStartTime = &v return s } type ModifyClusterMaintenanceOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Describes a cluster. Cluster *Cluster `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ModifyClusterMaintenanceOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ModifyClusterMaintenanceOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetCluster sets the Cluster field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterMaintenanceOutput) SetCluster(v *Cluster) *ModifyClusterMaintenanceOutput { s.Cluster = v return s } type ModifyClusterOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Describes a cluster. Cluster *Cluster `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ModifyClusterOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ModifyClusterOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetCluster sets the Cluster field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterOutput) SetCluster(v *Cluster) *ModifyClusterOutput { s.Cluster = v return s } type ModifyClusterParameterGroupInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the parameter group to be modified. // // ParameterGroupName is a required field ParameterGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // An array of parameters to be modified. A maximum of 20 parameters can be // modified in a single request. // // For each parameter to be modified, you must supply at least the parameter // name and parameter value; other name-value pairs of the parameter are optional. // // For the workload management (WLM) configuration, you must supply all the // name-value pairs in the wlm_json_configuration parameter. // // Parameters is a required field Parameters []*Parameter `locationNameList:"Parameter" type:"list" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ModifyClusterParameterGroupInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ModifyClusterParameterGroupInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ModifyClusterParameterGroupInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ModifyClusterParameterGroupInput"} if s.ParameterGroupName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ParameterGroupName")) } if s.Parameters == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Parameters")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetParameterGroupName sets the ParameterGroupName field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterParameterGroupInput) SetParameterGroupName(v string) *ModifyClusterParameterGroupInput { s.ParameterGroupName = &v return s } // SetParameters sets the Parameters field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterParameterGroupInput) SetParameters(v []*Parameter) *ModifyClusterParameterGroupInput { s.Parameters = v return s } type ModifyClusterSnapshotInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A Boolean option to override an exception if the retention period has already // passed. Force *bool `type:"boolean"` // The number of days that a manual snapshot is retained. If the value is -1, // the manual snapshot is retained indefinitely. // // If the manual snapshot falls outside of the new retention period, you can // specify the force option to immediately delete the snapshot. // // The value must be either -1 or an integer between 1 and 3,653. ManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"` // The identifier of the snapshot whose setting you want to modify. // // SnapshotIdentifier is a required field SnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ModifyClusterSnapshotInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ModifyClusterSnapshotInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ModifyClusterSnapshotInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ModifyClusterSnapshotInput"} if s.SnapshotIdentifier == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SnapshotIdentifier")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetForce sets the Force field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterSnapshotInput) SetForce(v bool) *ModifyClusterSnapshotInput { s.Force = &v return s } // SetManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod sets the ManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterSnapshotInput) SetManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod(v int64) *ModifyClusterSnapshotInput { s.ManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod = &v return s } // SetSnapshotIdentifier sets the SnapshotIdentifier field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterSnapshotInput) SetSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *ModifyClusterSnapshotInput { s.SnapshotIdentifier = &v return s } type ModifyClusterSnapshotOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Describes a snapshot. Snapshot *Snapshot `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ModifyClusterSnapshotOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ModifyClusterSnapshotOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetSnapshot sets the Snapshot field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterSnapshotOutput) SetSnapshot(v *Snapshot) *ModifyClusterSnapshotOutput { s.Snapshot = v return s } type ModifyClusterSnapshotScheduleInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A unique identifier for the cluster whose snapshot schedule you want to modify. // // ClusterIdentifier is a required field ClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // A boolean to indicate whether to remove the assoiciation between the cluster // and the schedule. DisassociateSchedule *bool `type:"boolean"` // A unique alphanumeric identifier for the schedule that you want to associate // with the cluster. ScheduleIdentifier *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ModifyClusterSnapshotScheduleInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ModifyClusterSnapshotScheduleInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ModifyClusterSnapshotScheduleInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ModifyClusterSnapshotScheduleInput"} if s.ClusterIdentifier == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ClusterIdentifier")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetClusterIdentifier sets the ClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterSnapshotScheduleInput) SetClusterIdentifier(v string) *ModifyClusterSnapshotScheduleInput { s.ClusterIdentifier = &v return s } // SetDisassociateSchedule sets the DisassociateSchedule field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterSnapshotScheduleInput) SetDisassociateSchedule(v bool) *ModifyClusterSnapshotScheduleInput { s.DisassociateSchedule = &v return s } // SetScheduleIdentifier sets the ScheduleIdentifier field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterSnapshotScheduleInput) SetScheduleIdentifier(v string) *ModifyClusterSnapshotScheduleInput { s.ScheduleIdentifier = &v return s } type ModifyClusterSnapshotScheduleOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ModifyClusterSnapshotScheduleOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ModifyClusterSnapshotScheduleOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } type ModifyClusterSubnetGroupInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the subnet group to be modified. // // ClusterSubnetGroupName is a required field ClusterSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // A text description of the subnet group to be modified. Description *string `type:"string"` // An array of VPC subnet IDs. A maximum of 20 subnets can be modified in a // single request. // // SubnetIds is a required field SubnetIds []*string `locationNameList:"SubnetIdentifier" type:"list" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ModifyClusterSubnetGroupInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ModifyClusterSubnetGroupInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ModifyClusterSubnetGroupInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ModifyClusterSubnetGroupInput"} if s.ClusterSubnetGroupName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ClusterSubnetGroupName")) } if s.SubnetIds == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SubnetIds")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetClusterSubnetGroupName sets the ClusterSubnetGroupName field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterSubnetGroupInput) SetClusterSubnetGroupName(v string) *ModifyClusterSubnetGroupInput { s.ClusterSubnetGroupName = &v return s } // SetDescription sets the Description field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterSubnetGroupInput) SetDescription(v string) *ModifyClusterSubnetGroupInput { s.Description = &v return s } // SetSubnetIds sets the SubnetIds field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterSubnetGroupInput) SetSubnetIds(v []*string) *ModifyClusterSubnetGroupInput { s.SubnetIds = v return s } type ModifyClusterSubnetGroupOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Describes a subnet group. ClusterSubnetGroup *ClusterSubnetGroup `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ModifyClusterSubnetGroupOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ModifyClusterSubnetGroupOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetClusterSubnetGroup sets the ClusterSubnetGroup field's value. func (s *ModifyClusterSubnetGroupOutput) SetClusterSubnetGroup(v *ClusterSubnetGroup) *ModifyClusterSubnetGroupOutput { s.ClusterSubnetGroup = v return s } type ModifyEventSubscriptionInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A Boolean value indicating if the subscription is enabled. true indicates // the subscription is enabled Enabled *bool `type:"boolean"` // Specifies the Amazon Redshift event categories to be published by the event // notification subscription. // // Values: configuration, management, monitoring, security EventCategories []*string `locationNameList:"EventCategory" type:"list"` // Specifies the Amazon Redshift event severity to be published by the event // notification subscription. // // Values: ERROR, INFO Severity *string `type:"string"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the SNS topic to be used by the event notification // subscription. SnsTopicArn *string `type:"string"` // A list of one or more identifiers of Amazon Redshift source objects. All // of the objects must be of the same type as was specified in the source type // parameter. The event subscription will return only events generated by the // specified objects. If not specified, then events are returned for all objects // within the source type specified. // // Example: my-cluster-1, my-cluster-2 // // Example: my-snapshot-20131010 SourceIds []*string `locationNameList:"SourceId" type:"list"` // The type of source that will be generating the events. For example, if you // want to be notified of events generated by a cluster, you would set this // parameter to cluster. If this value is not specified, events are returned // for all Amazon Redshift objects in your AWS account. You must specify a source // type in order to specify source IDs. // // Valid values: cluster, cluster-parameter-group, cluster-security-group, and // cluster-snapshot. SourceType *string `type:"string"` // The name of the modified Amazon Redshift event notification subscription. // // SubscriptionName is a required field SubscriptionName *string `type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ModifyEventSubscriptionInput"} if s.SubscriptionName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SubscriptionName")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetEnabled sets the Enabled field's value. func (s *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) SetEnabled(v bool) *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput { s.Enabled = &v return s } // SetEventCategories sets the EventCategories field's value. func (s *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) SetEventCategories(v []*string) *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput { s.EventCategories = v return s } // SetSeverity sets the Severity field's value. func (s *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) SetSeverity(v string) *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput { s.Severity = &v return s } // SetSnsTopicArn sets the SnsTopicArn field's value. func (s *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) SetSnsTopicArn(v string) *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput { s.SnsTopicArn = &v return s } // SetSourceIds sets the SourceIds field's value. func (s *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) SetSourceIds(v []*string) *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput { s.SourceIds = v return s } // SetSourceType sets the SourceType field's value. func (s *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) SetSourceType(v string) *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput { s.SourceType = &v return s } // SetSubscriptionName sets the SubscriptionName field's value. func (s *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) SetSubscriptionName(v string) *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput { s.SubscriptionName = &v return s } type ModifyEventSubscriptionOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Describes event subscriptions. EventSubscription *EventSubscription `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ModifyEventSubscriptionOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ModifyEventSubscriptionOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetEventSubscription sets the EventSubscription field's value. func (s *ModifyEventSubscriptionOutput) SetEventSubscription(v *EventSubscription) *ModifyEventSubscriptionOutput { s.EventSubscription = v return s } type ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriodInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The unique identifier of the cluster for which you want to change the retention // period for either automated or manual snapshots that are copied to a destination // AWS Region. // // Constraints: Must be the valid name of an existing cluster that has cross-region // snapshot copy enabled. // // ClusterIdentifier is a required field ClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // Indicates whether to apply the snapshot retention period to newly copied // manual snapshots instead of automated snapshots. Manual *bool `type:"boolean"` // The number of days to retain automated snapshots in the destination AWS Region // after they are copied from the source AWS Region. // // By default, this only changes the retention period of copied automated snapshots. // // If you decrease the retention period for automated snapshots that are copied // to a destination AWS Region, Amazon Redshift deletes any existing automated // snapshots that were copied to the destination AWS Region and that fall outside // of the new retention period. // // Constraints: Must be at least 1 and no more than 35 for automated snapshots. // // If you specify the manual option, only newly copied manual snapshots will // have the new retention period. // // If you specify the value of -1 newly copied manual snapshots are retained // indefinitely. // // Constraints: The number of days must be either -1 or an integer between 1 // and 3,653 for manual snapshots. // // RetentionPeriod is a required field RetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriodInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriodInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriodInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriodInput"} if s.ClusterIdentifier == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ClusterIdentifier")) } if s.RetentionPeriod == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("RetentionPeriod")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetClusterIdentifier sets the ClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriodInput) SetClusterIdentifier(v string) *ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriodInput { s.ClusterIdentifier = &v return s } // SetManual sets the Manual field's value. func (s *ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriodInput) SetManual(v bool) *ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriodInput { s.Manual = &v return s } // SetRetentionPeriod sets the RetentionPeriod field's value. func (s *ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriodInput) SetRetentionPeriod(v int64) *ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriodInput { s.RetentionPeriod = &v return s } type ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriodOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Describes a cluster. Cluster *Cluster `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriodOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriodOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetCluster sets the Cluster field's value. func (s *ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriodOutput) SetCluster(v *Cluster) *ModifySnapshotCopyRetentionPeriodOutput { s.Cluster = v return s } type ModifySnapshotScheduleInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // An updated list of schedule definitions. A schedule definition is made up // of schedule expressions, for example, "cron(30 12 *)" or "rate(12 hours)". // // ScheduleDefinitions is a required field ScheduleDefinitions []*string `locationNameList:"ScheduleDefinition" type:"list" required:"true"` // A unique alphanumeric identifier of the schedule to modify. // // ScheduleIdentifier is a required field ScheduleIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ModifySnapshotScheduleInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ModifySnapshotScheduleInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ModifySnapshotScheduleInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ModifySnapshotScheduleInput"} if s.ScheduleDefinitions == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ScheduleDefinitions")) } if s.ScheduleIdentifier == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ScheduleIdentifier")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetScheduleDefinitions sets the ScheduleDefinitions field's value. func (s *ModifySnapshotScheduleInput) SetScheduleDefinitions(v []*string) *ModifySnapshotScheduleInput { s.ScheduleDefinitions = v return s } // SetScheduleIdentifier sets the ScheduleIdentifier field's value. func (s *ModifySnapshotScheduleInput) SetScheduleIdentifier(v string) *ModifySnapshotScheduleInput { s.ScheduleIdentifier = &v return s } // Describes a snapshot schedule. You can set a regular interval for creating // snapshots of a cluster. You can also schedule snapshots for specific dates. type ModifySnapshotScheduleOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` AssociatedClusterCount *int64 `type:"integer"` AssociatedClusters []*ClusterAssociatedToSchedule `locationNameList:"ClusterAssociatedToSchedule" type:"list"` NextInvocations []*time.Time `locationNameList:"SnapshotTime" type:"list"` // A list of ScheduleDefinitions ScheduleDefinitions []*string `locationNameList:"ScheduleDefinition" type:"list"` // The description of the schedule. ScheduleDescription *string `type:"string"` // A unique identifier for the schedule. ScheduleIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // An optional set of tags describing the schedule. Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ModifySnapshotScheduleOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ModifySnapshotScheduleOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetAssociatedClusterCount sets the AssociatedClusterCount field's value. func (s *ModifySnapshotScheduleOutput) SetAssociatedClusterCount(v int64) *ModifySnapshotScheduleOutput { s.AssociatedClusterCount = &v return s } // SetAssociatedClusters sets the AssociatedClusters field's value. func (s *ModifySnapshotScheduleOutput) SetAssociatedClusters(v []*ClusterAssociatedToSchedule) *ModifySnapshotScheduleOutput { s.AssociatedClusters = v return s } // SetNextInvocations sets the NextInvocations field's value. func (s *ModifySnapshotScheduleOutput) SetNextInvocations(v []*time.Time) *ModifySnapshotScheduleOutput { s.NextInvocations = v return s } // SetScheduleDefinitions sets the ScheduleDefinitions field's value. func (s *ModifySnapshotScheduleOutput) SetScheduleDefinitions(v []*string) *ModifySnapshotScheduleOutput { s.ScheduleDefinitions = v return s } // SetScheduleDescription sets the ScheduleDescription field's value. func (s *ModifySnapshotScheduleOutput) SetScheduleDescription(v string) *ModifySnapshotScheduleOutput { s.ScheduleDescription = &v return s } // SetScheduleIdentifier sets the ScheduleIdentifier field's value. func (s *ModifySnapshotScheduleOutput) SetScheduleIdentifier(v string) *ModifySnapshotScheduleOutput { s.ScheduleIdentifier = &v return s } // SetTags sets the Tags field's value. func (s *ModifySnapshotScheduleOutput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *ModifySnapshotScheduleOutput { s.Tags = v return s } // Describes an orderable cluster option. type OrderableClusterOption struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A list of availability zones for the orderable cluster. AvailabilityZones []*AvailabilityZone `locationNameList:"AvailabilityZone" type:"list"` // The cluster type, for example multi-node. ClusterType *string `type:"string"` // The version of the orderable cluster. ClusterVersion *string `type:"string"` // The node type for the orderable cluster. NodeType *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s OrderableClusterOption) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s OrderableClusterOption) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetAvailabilityZones sets the AvailabilityZones field's value. func (s *OrderableClusterOption) SetAvailabilityZones(v []*AvailabilityZone) *OrderableClusterOption { s.AvailabilityZones = v return s } // SetClusterType sets the ClusterType field's value. func (s *OrderableClusterOption) SetClusterType(v string) *OrderableClusterOption { s.ClusterType = &v return s } // SetClusterVersion sets the ClusterVersion field's value. func (s *OrderableClusterOption) SetClusterVersion(v string) *OrderableClusterOption { s.ClusterVersion = &v return s } // SetNodeType sets the NodeType field's value. func (s *OrderableClusterOption) SetNodeType(v string) *OrderableClusterOption { s.NodeType = &v return s } // Describes a parameter in a cluster parameter group. type Parameter struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The valid range of values for the parameter. AllowedValues *string `type:"string"` // Specifies how to apply the WLM configuration parameter. Some properties can // be applied dynamically, while other properties require that any associated // clusters be rebooted for the configuration changes to be applied. For more // information about parameters and parameter groups, go to Amazon Redshift // Parameter Groups (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-parameter-groups.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. ApplyType *string `type:"string" enum:"ParameterApplyType"` // The data type of the parameter. DataType *string `type:"string"` // A description of the parameter. Description *string `type:"string"` // If true, the parameter can be modified. Some parameters have security or // operational implications that prevent them from being changed. IsModifiable *bool `type:"boolean"` // The earliest engine version to which the parameter can apply. MinimumEngineVersion *string `type:"string"` // The name of the parameter. ParameterName *string `type:"string"` // The value of the parameter. ParameterValue *string `type:"string"` // The source of the parameter value, such as "engine-default" or "user". Source *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s Parameter) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s Parameter) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetAllowedValues sets the AllowedValues field's value. func (s *Parameter) SetAllowedValues(v string) *Parameter { s.AllowedValues = &v return s } // SetApplyType sets the ApplyType field's value. func (s *Parameter) SetApplyType(v string) *Parameter { s.ApplyType = &v return s } // SetDataType sets the DataType field's value. func (s *Parameter) SetDataType(v string) *Parameter { s.DataType = &v return s } // SetDescription sets the Description field's value. func (s *Parameter) SetDescription(v string) *Parameter { s.Description = &v return s } // SetIsModifiable sets the IsModifiable field's value. func (s *Parameter) SetIsModifiable(v bool) *Parameter { s.IsModifiable = &v return s } // SetMinimumEngineVersion sets the MinimumEngineVersion field's value. func (s *Parameter) SetMinimumEngineVersion(v string) *Parameter { s.MinimumEngineVersion = &v return s } // SetParameterName sets the ParameterName field's value. func (s *Parameter) SetParameterName(v string) *Parameter { s.ParameterName = &v return s } // SetParameterValue sets the ParameterValue field's value. func (s *Parameter) SetParameterValue(v string) *Parameter { s.ParameterValue = &v return s } // SetSource sets the Source field's value. func (s *Parameter) SetSource(v string) *Parameter { s.Source = &v return s } // Describes cluster attributes that are in a pending state. A change to one // or more the attributes was requested and is in progress or will be applied. type PendingModifiedValues struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The pending or in-progress change of the automated snapshot retention period. AutomatedSnapshotRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"` // The pending or in-progress change of the new identifier for the cluster. ClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // The pending or in-progress change of the cluster type. ClusterType *string `type:"string"` // The pending or in-progress change of the service version. ClusterVersion *string `type:"string"` // The encryption type for a cluster. Possible values are: KMS and None. For // the China region the possible values are None, and Legacy. EncryptionType *string `type:"string"` // An option that specifies whether to create the cluster with enhanced VPC // routing enabled. To create a cluster that uses enhanced VPC routing, the // cluster must be in a VPC. For more information, see Enhanced VPC Routing // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/enhanced-vpc-routing.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // If this option is true, enhanced VPC routing is enabled. // // Default: false EnhancedVpcRouting *bool `type:"boolean"` // The name of the maintenance track that the cluster will change to during // the next maintenance window. MaintenanceTrackName *string `type:"string"` // The pending or in-progress change of the master user password for the cluster. MasterUserPassword *string `type:"string"` // The pending or in-progress change of the cluster's node type. NodeType *string `type:"string"` // The pending or in-progress change of the number of nodes in the cluster. NumberOfNodes *int64 `type:"integer"` // The pending or in-progress change of the ability to connect to the cluster // from the public network. PubliclyAccessible *bool `type:"boolean"` } // String returns the string representation func (s PendingModifiedValues) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s PendingModifiedValues) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetAutomatedSnapshotRetentionPeriod sets the AutomatedSnapshotRetentionPeriod field's value. func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetAutomatedSnapshotRetentionPeriod(v int64) *PendingModifiedValues { s.AutomatedSnapshotRetentionPeriod = &v return s } // SetClusterIdentifier sets the ClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetClusterIdentifier(v string) *PendingModifiedValues { s.ClusterIdentifier = &v return s } // SetClusterType sets the ClusterType field's value. func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetClusterType(v string) *PendingModifiedValues { s.ClusterType = &v return s } // SetClusterVersion sets the ClusterVersion field's value. func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetClusterVersion(v string) *PendingModifiedValues { s.ClusterVersion = &v return s } // SetEncryptionType sets the EncryptionType field's value. func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetEncryptionType(v string) *PendingModifiedValues { s.EncryptionType = &v return s } // SetEnhancedVpcRouting sets the EnhancedVpcRouting field's value. func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetEnhancedVpcRouting(v bool) *PendingModifiedValues { s.EnhancedVpcRouting = &v return s } // SetMaintenanceTrackName sets the MaintenanceTrackName field's value. func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetMaintenanceTrackName(v string) *PendingModifiedValues { s.MaintenanceTrackName = &v return s } // SetMasterUserPassword sets the MasterUserPassword field's value. func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetMasterUserPassword(v string) *PendingModifiedValues { s.MasterUserPassword = &v return s } // SetNodeType sets the NodeType field's value. func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetNodeType(v string) *PendingModifiedValues { s.NodeType = &v return s } // SetNumberOfNodes sets the NumberOfNodes field's value. func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetNumberOfNodes(v int64) *PendingModifiedValues { s.NumberOfNodes = &v return s } // SetPubliclyAccessible sets the PubliclyAccessible field's value. func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetPubliclyAccessible(v bool) *PendingModifiedValues { s.PubliclyAccessible = &v return s } type PurchaseReservedNodeOfferingInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The number of reserved nodes that you want to purchase. // // Default: 1 NodeCount *int64 `type:"integer"` // The unique identifier of the reserved node offering you want to purchase. // // ReservedNodeOfferingId is a required field ReservedNodeOfferingId *string `type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s PurchaseReservedNodeOfferingInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s PurchaseReservedNodeOfferingInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *PurchaseReservedNodeOfferingInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PurchaseReservedNodeOfferingInput"} if s.ReservedNodeOfferingId == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ReservedNodeOfferingId")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetNodeCount sets the NodeCount field's value. func (s *PurchaseReservedNodeOfferingInput) SetNodeCount(v int64) *PurchaseReservedNodeOfferingInput { s.NodeCount = &v return s } // SetReservedNodeOfferingId sets the ReservedNodeOfferingId field's value. func (s *PurchaseReservedNodeOfferingInput) SetReservedNodeOfferingId(v string) *PurchaseReservedNodeOfferingInput { s.ReservedNodeOfferingId = &v return s } type PurchaseReservedNodeOfferingOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Describes a reserved node. You can call the DescribeReservedNodeOfferings // API to obtain the available reserved node offerings. ReservedNode *ReservedNode `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s PurchaseReservedNodeOfferingOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s PurchaseReservedNodeOfferingOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetReservedNode sets the ReservedNode field's value. func (s *PurchaseReservedNodeOfferingOutput) SetReservedNode(v *ReservedNode) *PurchaseReservedNodeOfferingOutput { s.ReservedNode = v return s } type RebootClusterInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The cluster identifier. // // ClusterIdentifier is a required field ClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s RebootClusterInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s RebootClusterInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *RebootClusterInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RebootClusterInput"} if s.ClusterIdentifier == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ClusterIdentifier")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetClusterIdentifier sets the ClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *RebootClusterInput) SetClusterIdentifier(v string) *RebootClusterInput { s.ClusterIdentifier = &v return s } type RebootClusterOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Describes a cluster. Cluster *Cluster `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s RebootClusterOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s RebootClusterOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetCluster sets the Cluster field's value. func (s *RebootClusterOutput) SetCluster(v *Cluster) *RebootClusterOutput { s.Cluster = v return s } // Describes a recurring charge. type RecurringCharge struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The amount charged per the period of time specified by the recurring charge // frequency. RecurringChargeAmount *float64 `type:"double"` // The frequency at which the recurring charge amount is applied. RecurringChargeFrequency *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s RecurringCharge) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s RecurringCharge) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetRecurringChargeAmount sets the RecurringChargeAmount field's value. func (s *RecurringCharge) SetRecurringChargeAmount(v float64) *RecurringCharge { s.RecurringChargeAmount = &v return s } // SetRecurringChargeFrequency sets the RecurringChargeFrequency field's value. func (s *RecurringCharge) SetRecurringChargeFrequency(v string) *RecurringCharge { s.RecurringChargeFrequency = &v return s } // Describes a reserved node. You can call the DescribeReservedNodeOfferings // API to obtain the available reserved node offerings. type ReservedNode struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The currency code for the reserved cluster. CurrencyCode *string `type:"string"` // The duration of the node reservation in seconds. Duration *int64 `type:"integer"` // The fixed cost Amazon Redshift charges you for this reserved node. FixedPrice *float64 `type:"double"` // The number of reserved compute nodes. NodeCount *int64 `type:"integer"` // The node type of the reserved node. NodeType *string `type:"string"` // The anticipated utilization of the reserved node, as defined in the reserved // node offering. OfferingType *string `type:"string"` // The recurring charges for the reserved node. RecurringCharges []*RecurringCharge `locationNameList:"RecurringCharge" type:"list"` // The unique identifier for the reservation. ReservedNodeId *string `type:"string"` // The identifier for the reserved node offering. ReservedNodeOfferingId *string `type:"string"` ReservedNodeOfferingType *string `type:"string" enum:"ReservedNodeOfferingType"` // The time the reservation started. You purchase a reserved node offering for // a duration. This is the start time of that duration. StartTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"` // The state of the reserved compute node. // // Possible Values: // // * pending-payment-This reserved node has recently been purchased, and // the sale has been approved, but payment has not yet been confirmed. // // * active-This reserved node is owned by the caller and is available for // use. // // * payment-failed-Payment failed for the purchase attempt. // // * retired-The reserved node is no longer available. // // * exchanging-The owner is exchanging the reserved node for another reserved // node. State *string `type:"string"` // The hourly rate Amazon Redshift charges you for this reserved node. UsagePrice *float64 `type:"double"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ReservedNode) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ReservedNode) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetCurrencyCode sets the CurrencyCode field's value. func (s *ReservedNode) SetCurrencyCode(v string) *ReservedNode { s.CurrencyCode = &v return s } // SetDuration sets the Duration field's value. func (s *ReservedNode) SetDuration(v int64) *ReservedNode { s.Duration = &v return s } // SetFixedPrice sets the FixedPrice field's value. func (s *ReservedNode) SetFixedPrice(v float64) *ReservedNode { s.FixedPrice = &v return s } // SetNodeCount sets the NodeCount field's value. func (s *ReservedNode) SetNodeCount(v int64) *ReservedNode { s.NodeCount = &v return s } // SetNodeType sets the NodeType field's value. func (s *ReservedNode) SetNodeType(v string) *ReservedNode { s.NodeType = &v return s } // SetOfferingType sets the OfferingType field's value. func (s *ReservedNode) SetOfferingType(v string) *ReservedNode { s.OfferingType = &v return s } // SetRecurringCharges sets the RecurringCharges field's value. func (s *ReservedNode) SetRecurringCharges(v []*RecurringCharge) *ReservedNode { s.RecurringCharges = v return s } // SetReservedNodeId sets the ReservedNodeId field's value. func (s *ReservedNode) SetReservedNodeId(v string) *ReservedNode { s.ReservedNodeId = &v return s } // SetReservedNodeOfferingId sets the ReservedNodeOfferingId field's value. func (s *ReservedNode) SetReservedNodeOfferingId(v string) *ReservedNode { s.ReservedNodeOfferingId = &v return s } // SetReservedNodeOfferingType sets the ReservedNodeOfferingType field's value. func (s *ReservedNode) SetReservedNodeOfferingType(v string) *ReservedNode { s.ReservedNodeOfferingType = &v return s } // SetStartTime sets the StartTime field's value. func (s *ReservedNode) SetStartTime(v time.Time) *ReservedNode { s.StartTime = &v return s } // SetState sets the State field's value. func (s *ReservedNode) SetState(v string) *ReservedNode { s.State = &v return s } // SetUsagePrice sets the UsagePrice field's value. func (s *ReservedNode) SetUsagePrice(v float64) *ReservedNode { s.UsagePrice = &v return s } // Describes a reserved node offering. type ReservedNodeOffering struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The currency code for the compute nodes offering. CurrencyCode *string `type:"string"` // The duration, in seconds, for which the offering will reserve the node. Duration *int64 `type:"integer"` // The upfront fixed charge you will pay to purchase the specific reserved node // offering. FixedPrice *float64 `type:"double"` // The node type offered by the reserved node offering. NodeType *string `type:"string"` // The anticipated utilization of the reserved node, as defined in the reserved // node offering. OfferingType *string `type:"string"` // The charge to your account regardless of whether you are creating any clusters // using the node offering. Recurring charges are only in effect for heavy-utilization // reserved nodes. RecurringCharges []*RecurringCharge `locationNameList:"RecurringCharge" type:"list"` // The offering identifier. ReservedNodeOfferingId *string `type:"string"` ReservedNodeOfferingType *string `type:"string" enum:"ReservedNodeOfferingType"` // The rate you are charged for each hour the cluster that is using the offering // is running. UsagePrice *float64 `type:"double"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ReservedNodeOffering) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ReservedNodeOffering) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetCurrencyCode sets the CurrencyCode field's value. func (s *ReservedNodeOffering) SetCurrencyCode(v string) *ReservedNodeOffering { s.CurrencyCode = &v return s } // SetDuration sets the Duration field's value. func (s *ReservedNodeOffering) SetDuration(v int64) *ReservedNodeOffering { s.Duration = &v return s } // SetFixedPrice sets the FixedPrice field's value. func (s *ReservedNodeOffering) SetFixedPrice(v float64) *ReservedNodeOffering { s.FixedPrice = &v return s } // SetNodeType sets the NodeType field's value. func (s *ReservedNodeOffering) SetNodeType(v string) *ReservedNodeOffering { s.NodeType = &v return s } // SetOfferingType sets the OfferingType field's value. func (s *ReservedNodeOffering) SetOfferingType(v string) *ReservedNodeOffering { s.OfferingType = &v return s } // SetRecurringCharges sets the RecurringCharges field's value. func (s *ReservedNodeOffering) SetRecurringCharges(v []*RecurringCharge) *ReservedNodeOffering { s.RecurringCharges = v return s } // SetReservedNodeOfferingId sets the ReservedNodeOfferingId field's value. func (s *ReservedNodeOffering) SetReservedNodeOfferingId(v string) *ReservedNodeOffering { s.ReservedNodeOfferingId = &v return s } // SetReservedNodeOfferingType sets the ReservedNodeOfferingType field's value. func (s *ReservedNodeOffering) SetReservedNodeOfferingType(v string) *ReservedNodeOffering { s.ReservedNodeOfferingType = &v return s } // SetUsagePrice sets the UsagePrice field's value. func (s *ReservedNodeOffering) SetUsagePrice(v float64) *ReservedNodeOffering { s.UsagePrice = &v return s } type ResetClusterParameterGroupInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The name of the cluster parameter group to be reset. // // ParameterGroupName is a required field ParameterGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // An array of names of parameters to be reset. If ResetAllParameters option // is not used, then at least one parameter name must be supplied. // // Constraints: A maximum of 20 parameters can be reset in a single request. Parameters []*Parameter `locationNameList:"Parameter" type:"list"` // If true, all parameters in the specified parameter group will be reset to // their default values. // // Default: true ResetAllParameters *bool `type:"boolean"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ResetClusterParameterGroupInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ResetClusterParameterGroupInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ResetClusterParameterGroupInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ResetClusterParameterGroupInput"} if s.ParameterGroupName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ParameterGroupName")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetParameterGroupName sets the ParameterGroupName field's value. func (s *ResetClusterParameterGroupInput) SetParameterGroupName(v string) *ResetClusterParameterGroupInput { s.ParameterGroupName = &v return s } // SetParameters sets the Parameters field's value. func (s *ResetClusterParameterGroupInput) SetParameters(v []*Parameter) *ResetClusterParameterGroupInput { s.Parameters = v return s } // SetResetAllParameters sets the ResetAllParameters field's value. func (s *ResetClusterParameterGroupInput) SetResetAllParameters(v bool) *ResetClusterParameterGroupInput { s.ResetAllParameters = &v return s } type ResizeClusterInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A boolean value indicating whether the resize operation is using the classic // resize process. If you don't provide this parameter or set the value to false, // the resize type is elastic. Classic *bool `type:"boolean"` // The unique identifier for the cluster to resize. // // ClusterIdentifier is a required field ClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The new cluster type for the specified cluster. ClusterType *string `type:"string"` // The new node type for the nodes you are adding. NodeType *string `type:"string"` // The new number of nodes for the cluster. // // NumberOfNodes is a required field NumberOfNodes *int64 `type:"integer" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ResizeClusterInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ResizeClusterInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *ResizeClusterInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ResizeClusterInput"} if s.ClusterIdentifier == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ClusterIdentifier")) } if s.NumberOfNodes == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("NumberOfNodes")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetClassic sets the Classic field's value. func (s *ResizeClusterInput) SetClassic(v bool) *ResizeClusterInput { s.Classic = &v return s } // SetClusterIdentifier sets the ClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *ResizeClusterInput) SetClusterIdentifier(v string) *ResizeClusterInput { s.ClusterIdentifier = &v return s } // SetClusterType sets the ClusterType field's value. func (s *ResizeClusterInput) SetClusterType(v string) *ResizeClusterInput { s.ClusterType = &v return s } // SetNodeType sets the NodeType field's value. func (s *ResizeClusterInput) SetNodeType(v string) *ResizeClusterInput { s.NodeType = &v return s } // SetNumberOfNodes sets the NumberOfNodes field's value. func (s *ResizeClusterInput) SetNumberOfNodes(v int64) *ResizeClusterInput { s.NumberOfNodes = &v return s } type ResizeClusterOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Describes a cluster. Cluster *Cluster `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ResizeClusterOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ResizeClusterOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetCluster sets the Cluster field's value. func (s *ResizeClusterOutput) SetCluster(v *Cluster) *ResizeClusterOutput { s.Cluster = v return s } // Describes a resize operation. type ResizeInfo struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A boolean value indicating if the resize operation can be cancelled. AllowCancelResize *bool `type:"boolean"` // Returns the value ClassicResize. ResizeType *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s ResizeInfo) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s ResizeInfo) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetAllowCancelResize sets the AllowCancelResize field's value. func (s *ResizeInfo) SetAllowCancelResize(v bool) *ResizeInfo { s.AllowCancelResize = &v return s } // SetResizeType sets the ResizeType field's value. func (s *ResizeInfo) SetResizeType(v string) *ResizeInfo { s.ResizeType = &v return s } type RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Reserved. AdditionalInfo *string `type:"string"` // If true, major version upgrades can be applied during the maintenance window // to the Amazon Redshift engine that is running on the cluster. // // Default: true AllowVersionUpgrade *bool `type:"boolean"` // The number of days that automated snapshots are retained. If the value is // 0, automated snapshots are disabled. Even if automated snapshots are disabled, // you can still create manual snapshots when you want with CreateClusterSnapshot. // // Default: The value selected for the cluster from which the snapshot was taken. // // Constraints: Must be a value from 0 to 35. AutomatedSnapshotRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"` // The Amazon EC2 Availability Zone in which to restore the cluster. // // Default: A random, system-chosen Availability Zone. // // Example: us-east-1a AvailabilityZone *string `type:"string"` // The identifier of the cluster that will be created from restoring the snapshot. // // Constraints: // // * Must contain from 1 to 63 alphanumeric characters or hyphens. // // * Alphabetic characters must be lowercase. // // * First character must be a letter. // // * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens. // // * Must be unique for all clusters within an AWS account. // // ClusterIdentifier is a required field ClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The name of the parameter group to be associated with this cluster. // // Default: The default Amazon Redshift cluster parameter group. For information // about the default parameter group, go to Working with Amazon Redshift Parameter // Groups (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-parameter-groups.html). // // Constraints: // // * Must be 1 to 255 alphanumeric characters or hyphens. // // * First character must be a letter. // // * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens. ClusterParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"` // A list of security groups to be associated with this cluster. // // Default: The default cluster security group for Amazon Redshift. // // Cluster security groups only apply to clusters outside of VPCs. ClusterSecurityGroups []*string `locationNameList:"ClusterSecurityGroupName" type:"list"` // The name of the subnet group where you want to cluster restored. // // A snapshot of cluster in VPC can be restored only in VPC. Therefore, you // must provide subnet group name where you want the cluster restored. ClusterSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"` // The elastic IP (EIP) address for the cluster. ElasticIp *string `type:"string"` // An option that specifies whether to create the cluster with enhanced VPC // routing enabled. To create a cluster that uses enhanced VPC routing, the // cluster must be in a VPC. For more information, see Enhanced VPC Routing // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/enhanced-vpc-routing.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // If this option is true, enhanced VPC routing is enabled. // // Default: false EnhancedVpcRouting *bool `type:"boolean"` // Specifies the name of the HSM client certificate the Amazon Redshift cluster // uses to retrieve the data encryption keys stored in an HSM. HsmClientCertificateIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // Specifies the name of the HSM configuration that contains the information // the Amazon Redshift cluster can use to retrieve and store keys in an HSM. HsmConfigurationIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // A list of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) roles that can be used // by the cluster to access other AWS services. You must supply the IAM roles // in their Amazon Resource Name (ARN) format. You can supply up to 10 IAM roles // in a single request. // // A cluster can have up to 10 IAM roles associated at any time. IamRoles []*string `locationNameList:"IamRoleArn" type:"list"` // The AWS Key Management Service (KMS) key ID of the encryption key that you // want to use to encrypt data in the cluster that you restore from a shared // snapshot. KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"` // The name of the maintenance track for the restored cluster. When you take // a snapshot, the snapshot inherits the MaintenanceTrack value from the cluster. // The snapshot might be on a different track than the cluster that was the // source for the snapshot. For example, suppose that you take a snapshot of // a cluster that is on the current track and then change the cluster to be // on the trailing track. In this case, the snapshot and the source cluster // are on different tracks. MaintenanceTrackName *string `type:"string"` ManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"` // The node type that the restored cluster will be provisioned with. // // Default: The node type of the cluster from which the snapshot was taken. // You can modify this if you are using any DS node type. In that case, you // can choose to restore into another DS node type of the same size. For example, // you can restore ds1.8xlarge into ds2.8xlarge, or ds1.xlarge into ds2.xlarge. // If you have a DC instance type, you must restore into that same instance // type and size. In other words, you can only restore a dc1.large instance // type into another dc1.large instance type or dc2.large instance type. You // can't restore dc1.8xlarge to dc2.8xlarge. First restore to a dc1.8xlareg // cluster, then resize to a dc2.8large cluster. For more information about // node types, see About Clusters and Nodes (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-clusters.html#rs-about-clusters-and-nodes) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. NodeType *string `type:"string"` // The AWS customer account used to create or copy the snapshot. Required if // you are restoring a snapshot you do not own, optional if you own the snapshot. OwnerAccount *string `type:"string"` // The port number on which the cluster accepts connections. // // Default: The same port as the original cluster. // // Constraints: Must be between 1115 and 65535. Port *int64 `type:"integer"` // The weekly time range (in UTC) during which automated cluster maintenance // can occur. // // Format: ddd:hh24:mi-ddd:hh24:mi // // Default: The value selected for the cluster from which the snapshot was taken. // For more information about the time blocks for each region, see Maintenance // Windows (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-clusters.html#rs-maintenance-windows) // in Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // Valid Days: Mon | Tue | Wed | Thu | Fri | Sat | Sun // // Constraints: Minimum 30-minute window. PreferredMaintenanceWindow *string `type:"string"` // If true, the cluster can be accessed from a public network. PubliclyAccessible *bool `type:"boolean"` // The name of the cluster the source snapshot was created from. This parameter // is required if your IAM user has a policy containing a snapshot resource // element that specifies anything other than * for the cluster name. SnapshotClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // The name of the snapshot from which to create the new cluster. This parameter // isn't case sensitive. // // Example: my-snapshot-id // // SnapshotIdentifier is a required field SnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // A unique identifier for the snapshot schedule. SnapshotScheduleIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // A list of Virtual Private Cloud (VPC) security groups to be associated with // the cluster. // // Default: The default VPC security group is associated with the cluster. // // VPC security groups only apply to clusters in VPCs. VpcSecurityGroupIds []*string `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupId" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput"} if s.ClusterIdentifier == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ClusterIdentifier")) } if s.SnapshotIdentifier == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SnapshotIdentifier")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAdditionalInfo sets the AdditionalInfo field's value. func (s *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput) SetAdditionalInfo(v string) *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput { s.AdditionalInfo = &v return s } // SetAllowVersionUpgrade sets the AllowVersionUpgrade field's value. func (s *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput) SetAllowVersionUpgrade(v bool) *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput { s.AllowVersionUpgrade = &v return s } // SetAutomatedSnapshotRetentionPeriod sets the AutomatedSnapshotRetentionPeriod field's value. func (s *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput) SetAutomatedSnapshotRetentionPeriod(v int64) *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput { s.AutomatedSnapshotRetentionPeriod = &v return s } // SetAvailabilityZone sets the AvailabilityZone field's value. func (s *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput) SetAvailabilityZone(v string) *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput { s.AvailabilityZone = &v return s } // SetClusterIdentifier sets the ClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput) SetClusterIdentifier(v string) *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput { s.ClusterIdentifier = &v return s } // SetClusterParameterGroupName sets the ClusterParameterGroupName field's value. func (s *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput) SetClusterParameterGroupName(v string) *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput { s.ClusterParameterGroupName = &v return s } // SetClusterSecurityGroups sets the ClusterSecurityGroups field's value. func (s *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput) SetClusterSecurityGroups(v []*string) *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput { s.ClusterSecurityGroups = v return s } // SetClusterSubnetGroupName sets the ClusterSubnetGroupName field's value. func (s *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput) SetClusterSubnetGroupName(v string) *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput { s.ClusterSubnetGroupName = &v return s } // SetElasticIp sets the ElasticIp field's value. func (s *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput) SetElasticIp(v string) *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput { s.ElasticIp = &v return s } // SetEnhancedVpcRouting sets the EnhancedVpcRouting field's value. func (s *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput) SetEnhancedVpcRouting(v bool) *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput { s.EnhancedVpcRouting = &v return s } // SetHsmClientCertificateIdentifier sets the HsmClientCertificateIdentifier field's value. func (s *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput) SetHsmClientCertificateIdentifier(v string) *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput { s.HsmClientCertificateIdentifier = &v return s } // SetHsmConfigurationIdentifier sets the HsmConfigurationIdentifier field's value. func (s *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput) SetHsmConfigurationIdentifier(v string) *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput { s.HsmConfigurationIdentifier = &v return s } // SetIamRoles sets the IamRoles field's value. func (s *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput) SetIamRoles(v []*string) *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput { s.IamRoles = v return s } // SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value. func (s *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput) SetKmsKeyId(v string) *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput { s.KmsKeyId = &v return s } // SetMaintenanceTrackName sets the MaintenanceTrackName field's value. func (s *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput) SetMaintenanceTrackName(v string) *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput { s.MaintenanceTrackName = &v return s } // SetManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod sets the ManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod field's value. func (s *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput) SetManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod(v int64) *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput { s.ManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod = &v return s } // SetNodeType sets the NodeType field's value. func (s *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput) SetNodeType(v string) *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput { s.NodeType = &v return s } // SetOwnerAccount sets the OwnerAccount field's value. func (s *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput) SetOwnerAccount(v string) *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput { s.OwnerAccount = &v return s } // SetPort sets the Port field's value. func (s *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput) SetPort(v int64) *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput { s.Port = &v return s } // SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow sets the PreferredMaintenanceWindow field's value. func (s *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput) SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow(v string) *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput { s.PreferredMaintenanceWindow = &v return s } // SetPubliclyAccessible sets the PubliclyAccessible field's value. func (s *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput) SetPubliclyAccessible(v bool) *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput { s.PubliclyAccessible = &v return s } // SetSnapshotClusterIdentifier sets the SnapshotClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput) SetSnapshotClusterIdentifier(v string) *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput { s.SnapshotClusterIdentifier = &v return s } // SetSnapshotIdentifier sets the SnapshotIdentifier field's value. func (s *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput) SetSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput { s.SnapshotIdentifier = &v return s } // SetSnapshotScheduleIdentifier sets the SnapshotScheduleIdentifier field's value. func (s *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput) SetSnapshotScheduleIdentifier(v string) *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput { s.SnapshotScheduleIdentifier = &v return s } // SetVpcSecurityGroupIds sets the VpcSecurityGroupIds field's value. func (s *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput) SetVpcSecurityGroupIds(v []*string) *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotInput { s.VpcSecurityGroupIds = v return s } type RestoreFromClusterSnapshotOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Describes a cluster. Cluster *Cluster `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s RestoreFromClusterSnapshotOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s RestoreFromClusterSnapshotOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetCluster sets the Cluster field's value. func (s *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotOutput) SetCluster(v *Cluster) *RestoreFromClusterSnapshotOutput { s.Cluster = v return s } // Describes the status of a cluster restore action. Returns null if the cluster // was not created by restoring a snapshot. type RestoreStatus struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The number of megabytes per second being transferred from the backup storage. // Returns the average rate for a completed backup. CurrentRestoreRateInMegaBytesPerSecond *float64 `type:"double"` // The amount of time an in-progress restore has been running, or the amount // of time it took a completed restore to finish. ElapsedTimeInSeconds *int64 `type:"long"` // The estimate of the time remaining before the restore will complete. Returns // 0 for a completed restore. EstimatedTimeToCompletionInSeconds *int64 `type:"long"` // The number of megabytes that have been transferred from snapshot storage. ProgressInMegaBytes *int64 `type:"long"` // The size of the set of snapshot data used to restore the cluster. SnapshotSizeInMegaBytes *int64 `type:"long"` // The status of the restore action. Returns starting, restoring, completed, // or failed. Status *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s RestoreStatus) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s RestoreStatus) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetCurrentRestoreRateInMegaBytesPerSecond sets the CurrentRestoreRateInMegaBytesPerSecond field's value. func (s *RestoreStatus) SetCurrentRestoreRateInMegaBytesPerSecond(v float64) *RestoreStatus { s.CurrentRestoreRateInMegaBytesPerSecond = &v return s } // SetElapsedTimeInSeconds sets the ElapsedTimeInSeconds field's value. func (s *RestoreStatus) SetElapsedTimeInSeconds(v int64) *RestoreStatus { s.ElapsedTimeInSeconds = &v return s } // SetEstimatedTimeToCompletionInSeconds sets the EstimatedTimeToCompletionInSeconds field's value. func (s *RestoreStatus) SetEstimatedTimeToCompletionInSeconds(v int64) *RestoreStatus { s.EstimatedTimeToCompletionInSeconds = &v return s } // SetProgressInMegaBytes sets the ProgressInMegaBytes field's value. func (s *RestoreStatus) SetProgressInMegaBytes(v int64) *RestoreStatus { s.ProgressInMegaBytes = &v return s } // SetSnapshotSizeInMegaBytes sets the SnapshotSizeInMegaBytes field's value. func (s *RestoreStatus) SetSnapshotSizeInMegaBytes(v int64) *RestoreStatus { s.SnapshotSizeInMegaBytes = &v return s } // SetStatus sets the Status field's value. func (s *RestoreStatus) SetStatus(v string) *RestoreStatus { s.Status = &v return s } type RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The identifier of the Amazon Redshift cluster to restore the table to. // // ClusterIdentifier is a required field ClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The name of the table to create as a result of the current request. // // NewTableName is a required field NewTableName *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The identifier of the snapshot to restore the table from. This snapshot must // have been created from the Amazon Redshift cluster specified by the ClusterIdentifier // parameter. // // SnapshotIdentifier is a required field SnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The name of the source database that contains the table to restore from. // // SourceDatabaseName is a required field SourceDatabaseName *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The name of the source schema that contains the table to restore from. If // you do not specify a SourceSchemaName value, the default is public. SourceSchemaName *string `type:"string"` // The name of the source table to restore from. // // SourceTableName is a required field SourceTableName *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The name of the database to restore the table to. TargetDatabaseName *string `type:"string"` // The name of the schema to restore the table to. TargetSchemaName *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotInput"} if s.ClusterIdentifier == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ClusterIdentifier")) } if s.NewTableName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("NewTableName")) } if s.SnapshotIdentifier == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SnapshotIdentifier")) } if s.SourceDatabaseName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SourceDatabaseName")) } if s.SourceTableName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SourceTableName")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetClusterIdentifier sets the ClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotInput) SetClusterIdentifier(v string) *RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotInput { s.ClusterIdentifier = &v return s } // SetNewTableName sets the NewTableName field's value. func (s *RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotInput) SetNewTableName(v string) *RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotInput { s.NewTableName = &v return s } // SetSnapshotIdentifier sets the SnapshotIdentifier field's value. func (s *RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotInput) SetSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotInput { s.SnapshotIdentifier = &v return s } // SetSourceDatabaseName sets the SourceDatabaseName field's value. func (s *RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotInput) SetSourceDatabaseName(v string) *RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotInput { s.SourceDatabaseName = &v return s } // SetSourceSchemaName sets the SourceSchemaName field's value. func (s *RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotInput) SetSourceSchemaName(v string) *RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotInput { s.SourceSchemaName = &v return s } // SetSourceTableName sets the SourceTableName field's value. func (s *RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotInput) SetSourceTableName(v string) *RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotInput { s.SourceTableName = &v return s } // SetTargetDatabaseName sets the TargetDatabaseName field's value. func (s *RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotInput) SetTargetDatabaseName(v string) *RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotInput { s.TargetDatabaseName = &v return s } // SetTargetSchemaName sets the TargetSchemaName field's value. func (s *RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotInput) SetTargetSchemaName(v string) *RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotInput { s.TargetSchemaName = &v return s } type RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Describes the status of a RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshot operation. TableRestoreStatus *TableRestoreStatus `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetTableRestoreStatus sets the TableRestoreStatus field's value. func (s *RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotOutput) SetTableRestoreStatus(v *TableRestoreStatus) *RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshotOutput { s.TableRestoreStatus = v return s } // Describes a RevisionTarget. type RevisionTarget struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A unique string that identifies the version to update the cluster to. You // can use this value in ModifyClusterDbRevision. DatabaseRevision *string `type:"string"` // The date on which the database revision was released. DatabaseRevisionReleaseDate *time.Time `type:"timestamp"` // A string that describes the changes and features that will be applied to // the cluster when it is updated to the corresponding ClusterDbRevision. Description *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s RevisionTarget) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s RevisionTarget) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetDatabaseRevision sets the DatabaseRevision field's value. func (s *RevisionTarget) SetDatabaseRevision(v string) *RevisionTarget { s.DatabaseRevision = &v return s } // SetDatabaseRevisionReleaseDate sets the DatabaseRevisionReleaseDate field's value. func (s *RevisionTarget) SetDatabaseRevisionReleaseDate(v time.Time) *RevisionTarget { s.DatabaseRevisionReleaseDate = &v return s } // SetDescription sets the Description field's value. func (s *RevisionTarget) SetDescription(v string) *RevisionTarget { s.Description = &v return s } type RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngressInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The IP range for which to revoke access. This range must be a valid Classless // Inter-Domain Routing (CIDR) block of IP addresses. If CIDRIP is specified, // EC2SecurityGroupName and EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId cannot be provided. CIDRIP *string `type:"string"` // The name of the security Group from which to revoke the ingress rule. // // ClusterSecurityGroupName is a required field ClusterSecurityGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The name of the EC2 Security Group whose access is to be revoked. If EC2SecurityGroupName // is specified, EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId must also be provided and CIDRIP cannot // be provided. EC2SecurityGroupName *string `type:"string"` // The AWS account number of the owner of the security group specified in the // EC2SecurityGroupName parameter. The AWS access key ID is not an acceptable // value. If EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId is specified, EC2SecurityGroupName must // also be provided. and CIDRIP cannot be provided. // // Example: 111122223333 EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngressInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngressInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngressInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngressInput"} if s.ClusterSecurityGroupName == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ClusterSecurityGroupName")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetCIDRIP sets the CIDRIP field's value. func (s *RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngressInput) SetCIDRIP(v string) *RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngressInput { s.CIDRIP = &v return s } // SetClusterSecurityGroupName sets the ClusterSecurityGroupName field's value. func (s *RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngressInput) SetClusterSecurityGroupName(v string) *RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngressInput { s.ClusterSecurityGroupName = &v return s } // SetEC2SecurityGroupName sets the EC2SecurityGroupName field's value. func (s *RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngressInput) SetEC2SecurityGroupName(v string) *RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngressInput { s.EC2SecurityGroupName = &v return s } // SetEC2SecurityGroupOwnerId sets the EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId field's value. func (s *RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngressInput) SetEC2SecurityGroupOwnerId(v string) *RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngressInput { s.EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId = &v return s } type RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngressOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Describes a security group. ClusterSecurityGroup *ClusterSecurityGroup `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngressOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngressOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetClusterSecurityGroup sets the ClusterSecurityGroup field's value. func (s *RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngressOutput) SetClusterSecurityGroup(v *ClusterSecurityGroup) *RevokeClusterSecurityGroupIngressOutput { s.ClusterSecurityGroup = v return s } type RevokeSnapshotAccessInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The identifier of the AWS customer account that can no longer restore the // specified snapshot. // // AccountWithRestoreAccess is a required field AccountWithRestoreAccess *string `type:"string" required:"true"` // The identifier of the cluster the snapshot was created from. This parameter // is required if your IAM user has a policy containing a snapshot resource // element that specifies anything other than * for the cluster name. SnapshotClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // The identifier of the snapshot that the account can no longer access. // // SnapshotIdentifier is a required field SnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s RevokeSnapshotAccessInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s RevokeSnapshotAccessInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *RevokeSnapshotAccessInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RevokeSnapshotAccessInput"} if s.AccountWithRestoreAccess == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("AccountWithRestoreAccess")) } if s.SnapshotIdentifier == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SnapshotIdentifier")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAccountWithRestoreAccess sets the AccountWithRestoreAccess field's value. func (s *RevokeSnapshotAccessInput) SetAccountWithRestoreAccess(v string) *RevokeSnapshotAccessInput { s.AccountWithRestoreAccess = &v return s } // SetSnapshotClusterIdentifier sets the SnapshotClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *RevokeSnapshotAccessInput) SetSnapshotClusterIdentifier(v string) *RevokeSnapshotAccessInput { s.SnapshotClusterIdentifier = &v return s } // SetSnapshotIdentifier sets the SnapshotIdentifier field's value. func (s *RevokeSnapshotAccessInput) SetSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *RevokeSnapshotAccessInput { s.SnapshotIdentifier = &v return s } type RevokeSnapshotAccessOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Describes a snapshot. Snapshot *Snapshot `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s RevokeSnapshotAccessOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s RevokeSnapshotAccessOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetSnapshot sets the Snapshot field's value. func (s *RevokeSnapshotAccessOutput) SetSnapshot(v *Snapshot) *RevokeSnapshotAccessOutput { s.Snapshot = v return s } type RotateEncryptionKeyInput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The unique identifier of the cluster that you want to rotate the encryption // keys for. // // Constraints: Must be the name of valid cluster that has encryption enabled. // // ClusterIdentifier is a required field ClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"` } // String returns the string representation func (s RotateEncryptionKeyInput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s RotateEncryptionKeyInput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *RotateEncryptionKeyInput) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RotateEncryptionKeyInput"} if s.ClusterIdentifier == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ClusterIdentifier")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetClusterIdentifier sets the ClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *RotateEncryptionKeyInput) SetClusterIdentifier(v string) *RotateEncryptionKeyInput { s.ClusterIdentifier = &v return s } type RotateEncryptionKeyOutput struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Describes a cluster. Cluster *Cluster `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s RotateEncryptionKeyOutput) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s RotateEncryptionKeyOutput) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetCluster sets the Cluster field's value. func (s *RotateEncryptionKeyOutput) SetCluster(v *Cluster) *RotateEncryptionKeyOutput { s.Cluster = v return s } // Describes a snapshot. type Snapshot struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A list of the AWS customer accounts authorized to restore the snapshot. Returns // null if no accounts are authorized. Visible only to the snapshot owner. AccountsWithRestoreAccess []*AccountWithRestoreAccess `locationNameList:"AccountWithRestoreAccess" type:"list"` // The size of the incremental backup. ActualIncrementalBackupSizeInMegaBytes *float64 `type:"double"` // The Availability Zone in which the cluster was created. AvailabilityZone *string `type:"string"` // The number of megabytes that have been transferred to the snapshot backup. BackupProgressInMegaBytes *float64 `type:"double"` // The time (UTC) when the cluster was originally created. ClusterCreateTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"` // The identifier of the cluster for which the snapshot was taken. ClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // The version ID of the Amazon Redshift engine that is running on the cluster. ClusterVersion *string `type:"string"` // The number of megabytes per second being transferred to the snapshot backup. // Returns 0 for a completed backup. CurrentBackupRateInMegaBytesPerSecond *float64 `type:"double"` // The name of the database that was created when the cluster was created. DBName *string `type:"string"` // The amount of time an in-progress snapshot backup has been running, or the // amount of time it took a completed backup to finish. ElapsedTimeInSeconds *int64 `type:"long"` // If true, the data in the snapshot is encrypted at rest. Encrypted *bool `type:"boolean"` // A boolean that indicates whether the snapshot data is encrypted using the // HSM keys of the source cluster. true indicates that the data is encrypted // using HSM keys. EncryptedWithHSM *bool `type:"boolean"` // An option that specifies whether to create the cluster with enhanced VPC // routing enabled. To create a cluster that uses enhanced VPC routing, the // cluster must be in a VPC. For more information, see Enhanced VPC Routing // (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/enhanced-vpc-routing.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. // // If this option is true, enhanced VPC routing is enabled. // // Default: false EnhancedVpcRouting *bool `type:"boolean"` // The estimate of the time remaining before the snapshot backup will complete. // Returns 0 for a completed backup. EstimatedSecondsToCompletion *int64 `type:"long"` // The AWS Key Management Service (KMS) key ID of the encryption key that was // used to encrypt data in the cluster from which the snapshot was taken. KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"` // The name of the maintenance track for the snapshot. MaintenanceTrackName *string `type:"string"` // The number of days until a manual snapshot will pass its retention period. ManualSnapshotRemainingDays *int64 `type:"integer"` // The number of days that a manual snapshot is retained. If the value is -1, // the manual snapshot is retained indefinitely. // // The value must be either -1 or an integer between 1 and 3,653. ManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"` // The master user name for the cluster. MasterUsername *string `type:"string"` // The node type of the nodes in the cluster. NodeType *string `type:"string"` // The number of nodes in the cluster. NumberOfNodes *int64 `type:"integer"` // For manual snapshots, the AWS customer account used to create or copy the // snapshot. For automatic snapshots, the owner of the cluster. The owner can // perform all snapshot actions, such as sharing a manual snapshot. OwnerAccount *string `type:"string"` // The port that the cluster is listening on. Port *int64 `type:"integer"` // The list of node types that this cluster snapshot is able to restore into. RestorableNodeTypes []*string `locationNameList:"NodeType" type:"list"` // The time (in UTC format) when Amazon Redshift began the snapshot. A snapshot // contains a copy of the cluster data as of this exact time. SnapshotCreateTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"` // The snapshot identifier that is provided in the request. SnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // A timestamp representing the start of the retention period for the snapshot. SnapshotRetentionStartTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"` // The snapshot type. Snapshots created using CreateClusterSnapshot and CopyClusterSnapshot // are of type "manual". SnapshotType *string `type:"string"` // The source region from which the snapshot was copied. SourceRegion *string `type:"string"` // The snapshot status. The value of the status depends on the API operation // used: // // * CreateClusterSnapshot and CopyClusterSnapshot returns status as "creating". // // // * DescribeClusterSnapshots returns status as "creating", "available", // "final snapshot", or "failed". // // * DeleteClusterSnapshot returns status as "deleted". Status *string `type:"string"` // The list of tags for the cluster snapshot. Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"` // The size of the complete set of backup data that would be used to restore // the cluster. TotalBackupSizeInMegaBytes *float64 `type:"double"` // The VPC identifier of the cluster if the snapshot is from a cluster in a // VPC. Otherwise, this field is not in the output. VpcId *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s Snapshot) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s Snapshot) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetAccountsWithRestoreAccess sets the AccountsWithRestoreAccess field's value. func (s *Snapshot) SetAccountsWithRestoreAccess(v []*AccountWithRestoreAccess) *Snapshot { s.AccountsWithRestoreAccess = v return s } // SetActualIncrementalBackupSizeInMegaBytes sets the ActualIncrementalBackupSizeInMegaBytes field's value. func (s *Snapshot) SetActualIncrementalBackupSizeInMegaBytes(v float64) *Snapshot { s.ActualIncrementalBackupSizeInMegaBytes = &v return s } // SetAvailabilityZone sets the AvailabilityZone field's value. func (s *Snapshot) SetAvailabilityZone(v string) *Snapshot { s.AvailabilityZone = &v return s } // SetBackupProgressInMegaBytes sets the BackupProgressInMegaBytes field's value. func (s *Snapshot) SetBackupProgressInMegaBytes(v float64) *Snapshot { s.BackupProgressInMegaBytes = &v return s } // SetClusterCreateTime sets the ClusterCreateTime field's value. func (s *Snapshot) SetClusterCreateTime(v time.Time) *Snapshot { s.ClusterCreateTime = &v return s } // SetClusterIdentifier sets the ClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *Snapshot) SetClusterIdentifier(v string) *Snapshot { s.ClusterIdentifier = &v return s } // SetClusterVersion sets the ClusterVersion field's value. func (s *Snapshot) SetClusterVersion(v string) *Snapshot { s.ClusterVersion = &v return s } // SetCurrentBackupRateInMegaBytesPerSecond sets the CurrentBackupRateInMegaBytesPerSecond field's value. func (s *Snapshot) SetCurrentBackupRateInMegaBytesPerSecond(v float64) *Snapshot { s.CurrentBackupRateInMegaBytesPerSecond = &v return s } // SetDBName sets the DBName field's value. func (s *Snapshot) SetDBName(v string) *Snapshot { s.DBName = &v return s } // SetElapsedTimeInSeconds sets the ElapsedTimeInSeconds field's value. func (s *Snapshot) SetElapsedTimeInSeconds(v int64) *Snapshot { s.ElapsedTimeInSeconds = &v return s } // SetEncrypted sets the Encrypted field's value. func (s *Snapshot) SetEncrypted(v bool) *Snapshot { s.Encrypted = &v return s } // SetEncryptedWithHSM sets the EncryptedWithHSM field's value. func (s *Snapshot) SetEncryptedWithHSM(v bool) *Snapshot { s.EncryptedWithHSM = &v return s } // SetEnhancedVpcRouting sets the EnhancedVpcRouting field's value. func (s *Snapshot) SetEnhancedVpcRouting(v bool) *Snapshot { s.EnhancedVpcRouting = &v return s } // SetEstimatedSecondsToCompletion sets the EstimatedSecondsToCompletion field's value. func (s *Snapshot) SetEstimatedSecondsToCompletion(v int64) *Snapshot { s.EstimatedSecondsToCompletion = &v return s } // SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value. func (s *Snapshot) SetKmsKeyId(v string) *Snapshot { s.KmsKeyId = &v return s } // SetMaintenanceTrackName sets the MaintenanceTrackName field's value. func (s *Snapshot) SetMaintenanceTrackName(v string) *Snapshot { s.MaintenanceTrackName = &v return s } // SetManualSnapshotRemainingDays sets the ManualSnapshotRemainingDays field's value. func (s *Snapshot) SetManualSnapshotRemainingDays(v int64) *Snapshot { s.ManualSnapshotRemainingDays = &v return s } // SetManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod sets the ManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod field's value. func (s *Snapshot) SetManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod(v int64) *Snapshot { s.ManualSnapshotRetentionPeriod = &v return s } // SetMasterUsername sets the MasterUsername field's value. func (s *Snapshot) SetMasterUsername(v string) *Snapshot { s.MasterUsername = &v return s } // SetNodeType sets the NodeType field's value. func (s *Snapshot) SetNodeType(v string) *Snapshot { s.NodeType = &v return s } // SetNumberOfNodes sets the NumberOfNodes field's value. func (s *Snapshot) SetNumberOfNodes(v int64) *Snapshot { s.NumberOfNodes = &v return s } // SetOwnerAccount sets the OwnerAccount field's value. func (s *Snapshot) SetOwnerAccount(v string) *Snapshot { s.OwnerAccount = &v return s } // SetPort sets the Port field's value. func (s *Snapshot) SetPort(v int64) *Snapshot { s.Port = &v return s } // SetRestorableNodeTypes sets the RestorableNodeTypes field's value. func (s *Snapshot) SetRestorableNodeTypes(v []*string) *Snapshot { s.RestorableNodeTypes = v return s } // SetSnapshotCreateTime sets the SnapshotCreateTime field's value. func (s *Snapshot) SetSnapshotCreateTime(v time.Time) *Snapshot { s.SnapshotCreateTime = &v return s } // SetSnapshotIdentifier sets the SnapshotIdentifier field's value. func (s *Snapshot) SetSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *Snapshot { s.SnapshotIdentifier = &v return s } // SetSnapshotRetentionStartTime sets the SnapshotRetentionStartTime field's value. func (s *Snapshot) SetSnapshotRetentionStartTime(v time.Time) *Snapshot { s.SnapshotRetentionStartTime = &v return s } // SetSnapshotType sets the SnapshotType field's value. func (s *Snapshot) SetSnapshotType(v string) *Snapshot { s.SnapshotType = &v return s } // SetSourceRegion sets the SourceRegion field's value. func (s *Snapshot) SetSourceRegion(v string) *Snapshot { s.SourceRegion = &v return s } // SetStatus sets the Status field's value. func (s *Snapshot) SetStatus(v string) *Snapshot { s.Status = &v return s } // SetTags sets the Tags field's value. func (s *Snapshot) SetTags(v []*Tag) *Snapshot { s.Tags = v return s } // SetTotalBackupSizeInMegaBytes sets the TotalBackupSizeInMegaBytes field's value. func (s *Snapshot) SetTotalBackupSizeInMegaBytes(v float64) *Snapshot { s.TotalBackupSizeInMegaBytes = &v return s } // SetVpcId sets the VpcId field's value. func (s *Snapshot) SetVpcId(v string) *Snapshot { s.VpcId = &v return s } // The snapshot copy grant that grants Amazon Redshift permission to encrypt // copied snapshots with the specified customer master key (CMK) from AWS KMS // in the destination region. // // For more information about managing snapshot copy grants, go to Amazon Redshift // Database Encryption (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/working-with-db-encryption.html) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. type SnapshotCopyGrant struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The unique identifier of the customer master key (CMK) in AWS KMS to which // Amazon Redshift is granted permission. KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"` // The name of the snapshot copy grant. SnapshotCopyGrantName *string `type:"string"` // A list of tag instances. Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s SnapshotCopyGrant) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s SnapshotCopyGrant) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value. func (s *SnapshotCopyGrant) SetKmsKeyId(v string) *SnapshotCopyGrant { s.KmsKeyId = &v return s } // SetSnapshotCopyGrantName sets the SnapshotCopyGrantName field's value. func (s *SnapshotCopyGrant) SetSnapshotCopyGrantName(v string) *SnapshotCopyGrant { s.SnapshotCopyGrantName = &v return s } // SetTags sets the Tags field's value. func (s *SnapshotCopyGrant) SetTags(v []*Tag) *SnapshotCopyGrant { s.Tags = v return s } // Describes the errors returned by a snapshot. type SnapshotErrorMessage struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The failure code for the error. FailureCode *string `type:"string"` // The text message describing the error. FailureReason *string `type:"string"` // A unique identifier for the cluster. SnapshotClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // A unique identifier for the snapshot returning the error. SnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s SnapshotErrorMessage) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s SnapshotErrorMessage) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetFailureCode sets the FailureCode field's value. func (s *SnapshotErrorMessage) SetFailureCode(v string) *SnapshotErrorMessage { s.FailureCode = &v return s } // SetFailureReason sets the FailureReason field's value. func (s *SnapshotErrorMessage) SetFailureReason(v string) *SnapshotErrorMessage { s.FailureReason = &v return s } // SetSnapshotClusterIdentifier sets the SnapshotClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *SnapshotErrorMessage) SetSnapshotClusterIdentifier(v string) *SnapshotErrorMessage { s.SnapshotClusterIdentifier = &v return s } // SetSnapshotIdentifier sets the SnapshotIdentifier field's value. func (s *SnapshotErrorMessage) SetSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *SnapshotErrorMessage { s.SnapshotIdentifier = &v return s } // Describes a snapshot schedule. You can set a regular interval for creating // snapshots of a cluster. You can also schedule snapshots for specific dates. type SnapshotSchedule struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` AssociatedClusterCount *int64 `type:"integer"` AssociatedClusters []*ClusterAssociatedToSchedule `locationNameList:"ClusterAssociatedToSchedule" type:"list"` NextInvocations []*time.Time `locationNameList:"SnapshotTime" type:"list"` // A list of ScheduleDefinitions ScheduleDefinitions []*string `locationNameList:"ScheduleDefinition" type:"list"` // The description of the schedule. ScheduleDescription *string `type:"string"` // A unique identifier for the schedule. ScheduleIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // An optional set of tags describing the schedule. Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s SnapshotSchedule) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s SnapshotSchedule) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetAssociatedClusterCount sets the AssociatedClusterCount field's value. func (s *SnapshotSchedule) SetAssociatedClusterCount(v int64) *SnapshotSchedule { s.AssociatedClusterCount = &v return s } // SetAssociatedClusters sets the AssociatedClusters field's value. func (s *SnapshotSchedule) SetAssociatedClusters(v []*ClusterAssociatedToSchedule) *SnapshotSchedule { s.AssociatedClusters = v return s } // SetNextInvocations sets the NextInvocations field's value. func (s *SnapshotSchedule) SetNextInvocations(v []*time.Time) *SnapshotSchedule { s.NextInvocations = v return s } // SetScheduleDefinitions sets the ScheduleDefinitions field's value. func (s *SnapshotSchedule) SetScheduleDefinitions(v []*string) *SnapshotSchedule { s.ScheduleDefinitions = v return s } // SetScheduleDescription sets the ScheduleDescription field's value. func (s *SnapshotSchedule) SetScheduleDescription(v string) *SnapshotSchedule { s.ScheduleDescription = &v return s } // SetScheduleIdentifier sets the ScheduleIdentifier field's value. func (s *SnapshotSchedule) SetScheduleIdentifier(v string) *SnapshotSchedule { s.ScheduleIdentifier = &v return s } // SetTags sets the Tags field's value. func (s *SnapshotSchedule) SetTags(v []*Tag) *SnapshotSchedule { s.Tags = v return s } // Describes a sorting entity type SnapshotSortingEntity struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The category for sorting the snapshots. // // Attribute is a required field Attribute *string `type:"string" required:"true" enum:"SnapshotAttributeToSortBy"` // The order for listing the attributes. SortOrder *string `type:"string" enum:"SortByOrder"` } // String returns the string representation func (s SnapshotSortingEntity) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s SnapshotSortingEntity) GoString() string { return s.String() } // Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid. func (s *SnapshotSortingEntity) Validate() error { invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "SnapshotSortingEntity"} if s.Attribute == nil { invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Attribute")) } if invalidParams.Len() > 0 { return invalidParams } return nil } // SetAttribute sets the Attribute field's value. func (s *SnapshotSortingEntity) SetAttribute(v string) *SnapshotSortingEntity { s.Attribute = &v return s } // SetSortOrder sets the SortOrder field's value. func (s *SnapshotSortingEntity) SetSortOrder(v string) *SnapshotSortingEntity { s.SortOrder = &v return s } // Describes a subnet. type Subnet struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // Describes an availability zone. SubnetAvailabilityZone *AvailabilityZone `type:"structure"` // The identifier of the subnet. SubnetIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // The status of the subnet. SubnetStatus *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s Subnet) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s Subnet) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetSubnetAvailabilityZone sets the SubnetAvailabilityZone field's value. func (s *Subnet) SetSubnetAvailabilityZone(v *AvailabilityZone) *Subnet { s.SubnetAvailabilityZone = v return s } // SetSubnetIdentifier sets the SubnetIdentifier field's value. func (s *Subnet) SetSubnetIdentifier(v string) *Subnet { s.SubnetIdentifier = &v return s } // SetSubnetStatus sets the SubnetStatus field's value. func (s *Subnet) SetSubnetStatus(v string) *Subnet { s.SubnetStatus = &v return s } // Describes the operations that are allowed on a maintenance track. type SupportedOperation struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // A list of the supported operations. OperationName *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s SupportedOperation) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s SupportedOperation) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetOperationName sets the OperationName field's value. func (s *SupportedOperation) SetOperationName(v string) *SupportedOperation { s.OperationName = &v return s } // A list of supported platforms for orderable clusters. type SupportedPlatform struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` Name *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s SupportedPlatform) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s SupportedPlatform) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetName sets the Name field's value. func (s *SupportedPlatform) SetName(v string) *SupportedPlatform { s.Name = &v return s } // Describes the status of a RestoreTableFromClusterSnapshot operation. type TableRestoreStatus struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The identifier of the Amazon Redshift cluster that the table is being restored // to. ClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // A description of the status of the table restore request. Status values include // SUCCEEDED, FAILED, CANCELED, PENDING, IN_PROGRESS. Message *string `type:"string"` // The name of the table to create as a result of the table restore request. NewTableName *string `type:"string"` // The amount of data restored to the new table so far, in megabytes (MB). ProgressInMegaBytes *int64 `type:"long"` // The time that the table restore request was made, in Universal Coordinated // Time (UTC). RequestTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp"` // The identifier of the snapshot that the table is being restored from. SnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string"` // The name of the source database that contains the table being restored. SourceDatabaseName *string `type:"string"` // The name of the source schema that contains the table being restored. SourceSchemaName *string `type:"string"` // The name of the source table being restored. SourceTableName *string `type:"string"` // A value that describes the current state of the table restore request. // // Valid Values: SUCCEEDED, FAILED, CANCELED, PENDING, IN_PROGRESS Status *string `type:"string" enum:"TableRestoreStatusType"` // The unique identifier for the table restore request. TableRestoreRequestId *string `type:"string"` // The name of the database to restore the table to. TargetDatabaseName *string `type:"string"` // The name of the schema to restore the table to. TargetSchemaName *string `type:"string"` // The total amount of data to restore to the new table, in megabytes (MB). TotalDataInMegaBytes *int64 `type:"long"` } // String returns the string representation func (s TableRestoreStatus) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s TableRestoreStatus) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetClusterIdentifier sets the ClusterIdentifier field's value. func (s *TableRestoreStatus) SetClusterIdentifier(v string) *TableRestoreStatus { s.ClusterIdentifier = &v return s } // SetMessage sets the Message field's value. func (s *TableRestoreStatus) SetMessage(v string) *TableRestoreStatus { s.Message = &v return s } // SetNewTableName sets the NewTableName field's value. func (s *TableRestoreStatus) SetNewTableName(v string) *TableRestoreStatus { s.NewTableName = &v return s } // SetProgressInMegaBytes sets the ProgressInMegaBytes field's value. func (s *TableRestoreStatus) SetProgressInMegaBytes(v int64) *TableRestoreStatus { s.ProgressInMegaBytes = &v return s } // SetRequestTime sets the RequestTime field's value. func (s *TableRestoreStatus) SetRequestTime(v time.Time) *TableRestoreStatus { s.RequestTime = &v return s } // SetSnapshotIdentifier sets the SnapshotIdentifier field's value. func (s *TableRestoreStatus) SetSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *TableRestoreStatus { s.SnapshotIdentifier = &v return s } // SetSourceDatabaseName sets the SourceDatabaseName field's value. func (s *TableRestoreStatus) SetSourceDatabaseName(v string) *TableRestoreStatus { s.SourceDatabaseName = &v return s } // SetSourceSchemaName sets the SourceSchemaName field's value. func (s *TableRestoreStatus) SetSourceSchemaName(v string) *TableRestoreStatus { s.SourceSchemaName = &v return s } // SetSourceTableName sets the SourceTableName field's value. func (s *TableRestoreStatus) SetSourceTableName(v string) *TableRestoreStatus { s.SourceTableName = &v return s } // SetStatus sets the Status field's value. func (s *TableRestoreStatus) SetStatus(v string) *TableRestoreStatus { s.Status = &v return s } // SetTableRestoreRequestId sets the TableRestoreRequestId field's value. func (s *TableRestoreStatus) SetTableRestoreRequestId(v string) *TableRestoreStatus { s.TableRestoreRequestId = &v return s } // SetTargetDatabaseName sets the TargetDatabaseName field's value. func (s *TableRestoreStatus) SetTargetDatabaseName(v string) *TableRestoreStatus { s.TargetDatabaseName = &v return s } // SetTargetSchemaName sets the TargetSchemaName field's value. func (s *TableRestoreStatus) SetTargetSchemaName(v string) *TableRestoreStatus { s.TargetSchemaName = &v return s } // SetTotalDataInMegaBytes sets the TotalDataInMegaBytes field's value. func (s *TableRestoreStatus) SetTotalDataInMegaBytes(v int64) *TableRestoreStatus { s.TotalDataInMegaBytes = &v return s } // A tag consisting of a name/value pair for a resource. type Tag struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The key, or name, for the resource tag. Key *string `type:"string"` // The value for the resource tag. Value *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s Tag) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s Tag) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetKey sets the Key field's value. func (s *Tag) SetKey(v string) *Tag { s.Key = &v return s } // SetValue sets the Value field's value. func (s *Tag) SetValue(v string) *Tag { s.Value = &v return s } // A tag and its associated resource. type TaggedResource struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) with which the tag is associated, for example: // arn:aws:redshift:us-east-1:123456789:cluster:t1. ResourceName *string `type:"string"` // The type of resource with which the tag is associated. Valid resource types // are: // // * Cluster // // * CIDR/IP // // * EC2 security group // // * Snapshot // // * Cluster security group // // * Subnet group // // * HSM connection // // * HSM certificate // // * Parameter group // // For more information about Amazon Redshift resource types and constructing // ARNs, go to Constructing an Amazon Redshift Amazon Resource Name (ARN) (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/redshift/latest/mgmt/redshift-iam-access-control-overview.html#redshift-iam-access-control-specify-actions) // in the Amazon Redshift Cluster Management Guide. ResourceType *string `type:"string"` // The tag for the resource. Tag *Tag `type:"structure"` } // String returns the string representation func (s TaggedResource) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s TaggedResource) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetResourceName sets the ResourceName field's value. func (s *TaggedResource) SetResourceName(v string) *TaggedResource { s.ResourceName = &v return s } // SetResourceType sets the ResourceType field's value. func (s *TaggedResource) SetResourceType(v string) *TaggedResource { s.ResourceType = &v return s } // SetTag sets the Tag field's value. func (s *TaggedResource) SetTag(v *Tag) *TaggedResource { s.Tag = v return s } // A maintenance track that you can switch the current track to. type UpdateTarget struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The cluster version for the new maintenance track. DatabaseVersion *string `type:"string"` // The name of the new maintenance track. MaintenanceTrackName *string `type:"string"` // A list of operations supported by the maintenance track. SupportedOperations []*SupportedOperation `locationNameList:"SupportedOperation" type:"list"` } // String returns the string representation func (s UpdateTarget) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s UpdateTarget) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetDatabaseVersion sets the DatabaseVersion field's value. func (s *UpdateTarget) SetDatabaseVersion(v string) *UpdateTarget { s.DatabaseVersion = &v return s } // SetMaintenanceTrackName sets the MaintenanceTrackName field's value. func (s *UpdateTarget) SetMaintenanceTrackName(v string) *UpdateTarget { s.MaintenanceTrackName = &v return s } // SetSupportedOperations sets the SupportedOperations field's value. func (s *UpdateTarget) SetSupportedOperations(v []*SupportedOperation) *UpdateTarget { s.SupportedOperations = v return s } // Describes the members of a VPC security group. type VpcSecurityGroupMembership struct { _ struct{} `type:"structure"` // The status of the VPC security group. Status *string `type:"string"` // The identifier of the VPC security group. VpcSecurityGroupId *string `type:"string"` } // String returns the string representation func (s VpcSecurityGroupMembership) String() string { return awsutil.Prettify(s) } // GoString returns the string representation func (s VpcSecurityGroupMembership) GoString() string { return s.String() } // SetStatus sets the Status field's value. func (s *VpcSecurityGroupMembership) SetStatus(v string) *VpcSecurityGroupMembership { s.Status = &v return s } // SetVpcSecurityGroupId sets the VpcSecurityGroupId field's value. func (s *VpcSecurityGroupMembership) SetVpcSecurityGroupId(v string) *VpcSecurityGroupMembership { s.VpcSecurityGroupId = &v return s } const ( // ParameterApplyTypeStatic is a ParameterApplyType enum value ParameterApplyTypeStatic = "static" // ParameterApplyTypeDynamic is a ParameterApplyType enum value ParameterApplyTypeDynamic = "dynamic" ) const ( // ReservedNodeOfferingTypeRegular is a ReservedNodeOfferingType enum value ReservedNodeOfferingTypeRegular = "Regular" // ReservedNodeOfferingTypeUpgradable is a ReservedNodeOfferingType enum value ReservedNodeOfferingTypeUpgradable = "Upgradable" ) const ( // ScheduleStateModifying is a ScheduleState enum value ScheduleStateModifying = "MODIFYING" // ScheduleStateActive is a ScheduleState enum value ScheduleStateActive = "ACTIVE" // ScheduleStateFailed is a ScheduleState enum value ScheduleStateFailed = "FAILED" ) const ( // SnapshotAttributeToSortBySourceType is a SnapshotAttributeToSortBy enum value SnapshotAttributeToSortBySourceType = "SOURCE_TYPE" // SnapshotAttributeToSortByTotalSize is a SnapshotAttributeToSortBy enum value SnapshotAttributeToSortByTotalSize = "TOTAL_SIZE" // SnapshotAttributeToSortByCreateTime is a SnapshotAttributeToSortBy enum value SnapshotAttributeToSortByCreateTime = "CREATE_TIME" ) const ( // SortByOrderAsc is a SortByOrder enum value SortByOrderAsc = "ASC" // SortByOrderDesc is a SortByOrder enum value SortByOrderDesc = "DESC" ) const ( // SourceTypeCluster is a SourceType enum value SourceTypeCluster = "cluster" // SourceTypeClusterParameterGroup is a SourceType enum value SourceTypeClusterParameterGroup = "cluster-parameter-group" // SourceTypeClusterSecurityGroup is a SourceType enum value SourceTypeClusterSecurityGroup = "cluster-security-group" // SourceTypeClusterSnapshot is a SourceType enum value SourceTypeClusterSnapshot = "cluster-snapshot" ) const ( // TableRestoreStatusTypePending is a TableRestoreStatusType enum value TableRestoreStatusTypePending = "PENDING" // TableRestoreStatusTypeInProgress is a TableRestoreStatusType enum value TableRestoreStatusTypeInProgress = "IN_PROGRESS" // TableRestoreStatusTypeSucceeded is a TableRestoreStatusType enum value TableRestoreStatusTypeSucceeded = "SUCCEEDED" // TableRestoreStatusTypeFailed is a TableRestoreStatusType enum value TableRestoreStatusTypeFailed = "FAILED" // TableRestoreStatusTypeCanceled is a TableRestoreStatusType enum value TableRestoreStatusTypeCanceled = "CANCELED" )